about summary refs log tree commit diff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorUlrich Drepper <drepper@redhat.com>2004-03-14 21:12:06 +0000
committerUlrich Drepper <drepper@redhat.com>2004-03-14 21:12:06 +0000
commitccadf7b5346a3e21c692dfcbfcf38a63433bc36a (patch)
treea1e826af3345eee581925387513b1b6c76629c31
parent3bc9b83f49805969b7d139b52ef6b003e5136354 (diff)
downloadglibc-ccadf7b5346a3e21c692dfcbfcf38a63433bc36a.tar.gz
glibc-ccadf7b5346a3e21c692dfcbfcf38a63433bc36a.tar.xz
glibc-ccadf7b5346a3e21c692dfcbfcf38a63433bc36a.zip
Update.
2004-03-14  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@redhat.com>

	Make the non-_l functions wrappers around the _l functions.
	* include/monetary.h: Declare __vstrmon_l.
	* include/string.h: Add libc_hidden_proto for __strcoll_l and
	__strxfrm_l.
	* include/time.h: Define ptime_locale_status.  Declare
	__strptime_internal.
	* include/wchar.h: Add libc_hidden_proto for __wcscoll_l and
	__wcsxfrm_l.
	* stdlib/strfmon.c: Move the code to strfmon_l.c.  Add little
	wrapper around __vstrfmon_l.
	* stdlib/strfmon_l.c: Add real implementation.  Split into new
	function __vstrfmon_l to allow calling it from strfmon.
	* stdlib/strtod.c: Move real code to strtod_l.c and add wrapper.
	* stdlib/strtod_l.c: Add real implementation.
	* stdlib/strtof.c: Adjust to changed strtod.c.
	* stdlib/strtof_l.c: Include strtod_l.c now.
	* stdlib/strtold.c: New file.
	* stdlib/strtold_l.c: Removed.
	* string/strcoll.c: Move real code to strcoll_l.c: Add wrapper.
	* string/strcoll_l.c: Add real implementation.
	* string/strxfrm.c: Move real code to strxfrm_l.c: Add wrapper.
	* string/strxfrm_l.c: Add real implementation.
	* sysdeps/generic/strtol.c: Move real implementation to strtol_l.c.
	Add wrappers.
	* sysdeps/generic/strtol_l.c: Add real implementation.
	* sysdeps/generic/strtold.c: Removed.
	* sysdeps/generic/strtold_l.c: New file.
	* sysdeps/generic/strtoll_l.c: Include strtol_l.c now.  Adjust
	#defines.
	* sysdeps/generic/strtoul_l.c: Likewise.
	* sysdeps/generic/strtoull_l.c: Likewise.
	* sysdeps/generic/wcstol_l.c: Likewise.
	* sysdeps/generic/wcstoll_l.c: Likewise.
	* sysdeps/generic/wcstoul_l.c: Likewise.
	* sysdeps/generic/wcstoull_l.c: Likewise.
	* sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-128/strtold.c: Removed.
	* sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-128/strtold_l.c: New file.
	* sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-96/strtold.c: Removed.
	* sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-96/strtold_l.c: New file.
	* sysdeps/m68k/strtold.c: Removed.
	* sysdeps/m68k/strtold_l.c: New file.
	* time/strftime.c: Move real code to strftime_l.c.  Add wrapper.
	* time/strftime_l.c: Add real implementation.
	* time/strptime.c: Move real code to strptime_l.c.  Add wrapper.
	* time/strptime_l.c: Add real implementation.
	* time/wcsftime.c: Simplify since only wrappers are defined in
	strftime.c.
	* time/wcsftime_l.c: Include strftime_l.c.
	* wcsmbs/wcscoll.c: Simplify since the file is not used by wcscoll_l.c
	anymore.
	* wcsmbs/wcscoll_l.c: Include strcoll_l.c.
	* wcsmbs/wcsxfrm.c: Simplify since the file is not used by wcsxfrm_l.c
	anymore.
	* wcsmbs/wcsxfrm_l.c: Include strxfrm_l.c.
	* wcsmbs/wcstod.c: Prepare to include new strtod.c.
	* wcsmbs/wcstod_l.c: Include strtod_l.c.
	* wcsmbs/wcstof.c: Prepare to include new strtof.c.
	* wcsmbs/wcstof_l.c: Include strtof_l.c.
	* wcsmbs/wcstold.c: Prepare to include new strtold.c.
	* wcsmbs/wcstold_l.c: Include strtold_l.c.

	* locale/uselocale.c: Use _NL_CURRENT_LOCALE instead of __libc_tsd_get.

	* sysdeps/generic/strcasecmp.c: Optimize a bit.  It's better to get
	a reference to the current locale and then use the _l functions.
	* sysdeps/generic/strncase.c: Likewise.
-rw-r--r--ChangeLog69
-rw-r--r--include/monetary.h4
-rw-r--r--include/string.h2
-rw-r--r--include/time.h13
-rw-r--r--include/wchar.h3
-rw-r--r--locale/uselocale.c4
-rw-r--r--stdlib/strfmon.c632
-rw-r--r--stdlib/strfmon_l.c636
-rw-r--r--stdlib/strtod.c1560
-rw-r--r--stdlib/strtod_l.c1551
-rw-r--r--stdlib/strtof.c37
-rw-r--r--stdlib/strtof_l.c28
-rw-r--r--stdlib/strtold.c35
-rw-r--r--stdlib/strtold_l.c53
-rw-r--r--string/strcoll.c528
-rw-r--r--string/strcoll_l.c514
-rw-r--r--string/strxfrm.c444
-rw-r--r--string/strxfrm_l.c429
-rw-r--r--sysdeps/generic/strtol.c533
-rw-r--r--sysdeps/generic/strtol_l.c493
-rw-r--r--sysdeps/generic/strtold_l.c (renamed from sysdeps/generic/strtold.c)18
-rw-r--r--sysdeps/generic/strtoll_l.c8
-rw-r--r--sysdeps/generic/strtoul_l.c8
-rw-r--r--sysdeps/generic/strtoull_l.c9
-rw-r--r--sysdeps/generic/wcstol_l.c8
-rw-r--r--sysdeps/generic/wcstoll_l.c8
-rw-r--r--sysdeps/generic/wcstoul_l.c8
-rw-r--r--sysdeps/generic/wcstoull_l.c8
-rw-r--r--sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-128/strtold_l.c (renamed from sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-128/strtold.c)26
-rw-r--r--sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-96/strtold_l.c (renamed from sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-96/strtold.c)26
-rw-r--r--sysdeps/m68k/strtold.c2
-rw-r--r--sysdeps/m68k/strtold_l.c2
-rw-r--r--time/strftime.c1421
-rw-r--r--time/strftime_l.c1426
-rw-r--r--time/strptime.c1066
-rw-r--r--time/strptime_l.c1052
-rw-r--r--time/wcsftime.c32
-rw-r--r--time/wcsftime_l.c8
-rw-r--r--wcsmbs/wcscoll.c15
-rw-r--r--wcsmbs/wcscoll_l.c19
-rw-r--r--wcsmbs/wcstod.c8
-rw-r--r--wcsmbs/wcstod_l.c10
-rw-r--r--wcsmbs/wcstof.c29
-rw-r--r--wcsmbs/wcstof_l.c12
-rw-r--r--wcsmbs/wcstold.c48
-rw-r--r--wcsmbs/wcstold_l.c32
-rw-r--r--wcsmbs/wcsxfrm.c17
-rw-r--r--wcsmbs/wcsxfrm_l.c19
48 files changed, 6501 insertions, 6412 deletions
diff --git a/ChangeLog b/ChangeLog
index 372a32262b..3e41a14db2 100644
--- a/ChangeLog
+++ b/ChangeLog
@@ -1,3 +1,72 @@
+2004-03-14  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@redhat.com>
+
+	Make the non-_l functions wrappers around the _l functions.
+	* include/monetary.h: Declare __vstrmon_l.
+	* include/string.h: Add libc_hidden_proto for __strcoll_l and
+	__strxfrm_l.
+	* include/time.h: Define ptime_locale_status.  Declare
+	__strptime_internal.
+	* include/wchar.h: Add libc_hidden_proto for __wcscoll_l and
+	__wcsxfrm_l.
+	* stdlib/strfmon.c: Move the code to strfmon_l.c.  Add little
+	wrapper around __vstrfmon_l.
+	* stdlib/strfmon_l.c: Add real implementation.  Split into new
+	function __vstrfmon_l to allow calling it from strfmon.
+	* stdlib/strtod.c: Move real code to strtod_l.c and add wrapper.
+	* stdlib/strtod_l.c: Add real implementation.
+	* stdlib/strtof.c: Adjust to changed strtod.c.
+	* stdlib/strtof_l.c: Include strtod_l.c now.
+	* stdlib/strtold.c: New file.
+	* stdlib/strtold_l.c: Removed.
+	* string/strcoll.c: Move real code to strcoll_l.c: Add wrapper.
+	* string/strcoll_l.c: Add real implementation.
+	* string/strxfrm.c: Move real code to strxfrm_l.c: Add wrapper.
+	* string/strxfrm_l.c: Add real implementation.
+	* sysdeps/generic/strtol.c: Move real implementation to strtol_l.c.
+	Add wrappers.
+	* sysdeps/generic/strtol_l.c: Add real implementation.
+	* sysdeps/generic/strtold.c: Removed.
+	* sysdeps/generic/strtold_l.c: New file.
+	* sysdeps/generic/strtoll_l.c: Include strtol_l.c now.  Adjust
+	#defines.
+	* sysdeps/generic/strtoul_l.c: Likewise.
+	* sysdeps/generic/strtoull_l.c: Likewise.
+	* sysdeps/generic/wcstol_l.c: Likewise.
+	* sysdeps/generic/wcstoll_l.c: Likewise.
+	* sysdeps/generic/wcstoul_l.c: Likewise.
+	* sysdeps/generic/wcstoull_l.c: Likewise.
+	* sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-128/strtold.c: Removed.
+	* sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-128/strtold_l.c: New file.
+	* sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-96/strtold.c: Removed.
+	* sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-96/strtold_l.c: New file.
+	* sysdeps/m68k/strtold.c: Removed.
+	* sysdeps/m68k/strtold_l.c: New file.
+	* time/strftime.c: Move real code to strftime_l.c.  Add wrapper.
+	* time/strftime_l.c: Add real implementation.
+	* time/strptime.c: Move real code to strptime_l.c.  Add wrapper.
+	* time/strptime_l.c: Add real implementation.
+	* time/wcsftime.c: Simplify since only wrappers are defined in
+	strftime.c.
+	* time/wcsftime_l.c: Include strftime_l.c.
+	* wcsmbs/wcscoll.c: Simplify since the file is not used by wcscoll_l.c
+	anymore.
+	* wcsmbs/wcscoll_l.c: Include strcoll_l.c.
+	* wcsmbs/wcsxfrm.c: Simplify since the file is not used by wcsxfrm_l.c
+	anymore.
+	* wcsmbs/wcsxfrm_l.c: Include strxfrm_l.c.
+	* wcsmbs/wcstod.c: Prepare to include new strtod.c.
+	* wcsmbs/wcstod_l.c: Include strtod_l.c.
+	* wcsmbs/wcstof.c: Prepare to include new strtof.c.
+	* wcsmbs/wcstof_l.c: Include strtof_l.c.
+	* wcsmbs/wcstold.c: Prepare to include new strtold.c.
+	* wcsmbs/wcstold_l.c: Include strtold_l.c.
+
+	* locale/uselocale.c: Use _NL_CURRENT_LOCALE instead of __libc_tsd_get.
+
+	* sysdeps/generic/strcasecmp.c: Optimize a bit.  It's better to get
+	a reference to the current locale and then use the _l functions.
+	* sysdeps/generic/strncase.c: Likewise.
+
 2004-03-11  Jeroen Dekkers  <jeroen@dekkers.cx>
 
 	* cppflags-iterator.mk: Change libof-$(cpp-src) to
diff --git a/include/monetary.h b/include/monetary.h
index 4735dc6c8a..98b3dbf294 100644
--- a/include/monetary.h
+++ b/include/monetary.h
@@ -1 +1,5 @@
 #include <stdlib/monetary.h>
+#include <stdarg.h>
+
+extern ssize_t __vstrfmon_l (char *s, size_t maxsize, __locale_t loc,
+			     const char *format, va_list ap);
diff --git a/include/string.h b/include/string.h
index 041590b1db..42d9362dfc 100644
--- a/include/string.h
+++ b/include/string.h
@@ -78,6 +78,8 @@ libc_hidden_proto (__strerror_r)
 libc_hidden_proto (__strverscmp)
 libc_hidden_proto (basename)
 libc_hidden_proto (strcoll)
+libc_hidden_proto (__strcoll_l)
+libc_hidden_proto (__strxfrm_l)
 
 libc_hidden_builtin_proto (memchr)
 libc_hidden_builtin_proto (memcpy)
diff --git a/include/time.h b/include/time.h
index 87e0f08f8d..5a95be5a4e 100644
--- a/include/time.h
+++ b/include/time.h
@@ -3,6 +3,7 @@
 # include <time/time.h>
 #else
 # include <time/time.h>
+# include <xlocale.h>
 
 extern __typeof (strftime_l) __strftime_l;
 libc_hidden_proto (__strftime_l)
@@ -84,6 +85,18 @@ extern int __getdate_r (__const char *__string, struct tm *__resbufp);
 extern int __getclktck (void);
 
 
+/* strptime support.  */
+/* Status of lookup: do we use the locale data or the raw data?  */
+enum ptime_locale_status { not, loc, raw };
+
+extern char * __strptime_internal (const char *rp, const char *fmt,
+				   struct tm *tm,
+				   enum ptime_locale_status *decided,
+				   int era_cnt, __locale_t loc)
+     internal_function;
+
+
+
 /* Use in the clock_* functions.  Size of the field representing the
    actual clock ID.  */
 #ifndef _ISOMAC
diff --git a/include/wchar.h b/include/wchar.h
index f69463f57a..73bd4a8fef 100644
--- a/include/wchar.h
+++ b/include/wchar.h
@@ -29,6 +29,9 @@ libc_hidden_proto (__wcstoull_internal)
 libc_hidden_proto (__wcscasecmp_l)
 libc_hidden_proto (__wcsncasecmp_l)
 
+libc_hidden_proto (__wcscoll_l)
+libc_hidden_proto (__wcsxfrm_l)
+
 libc_hidden_proto (fputws_unlocked)
 libc_hidden_proto (putwc_unlocked)
 libc_hidden_proto (putwc)
diff --git a/locale/uselocale.c b/locale/uselocale.c
index e2f38c10ba..4e63dabd8e 100644
--- a/locale/uselocale.c
+++ b/locale/uselocale.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* uselocale -- fetch and set the current per-thread locale
-   Copyright (C) 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
 
    The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
@@ -29,7 +29,7 @@
 locale_t
 __uselocale (locale_t newloc)
 {
-  locale_t oldloc = __libc_tsd_get (LOCALE);
+  locale_t oldloc = _NL_CURRENT_LOCALE;
 
   if (newloc != NULL)
     {
diff --git a/stdlib/strfmon.c b/stdlib/strfmon.c
index b17dc9823c..b11f95c9ac 100644
--- a/stdlib/strfmon.c
+++ b/stdlib/strfmon.c
@@ -19,645 +19,21 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#include <ctype.h>
-#include <errno.h>
-#include <langinfo.h>
-#include <locale.h>
 #include <monetary.h>
-#ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
-# include "../libio/libioP.h"
-# include "../libio/strfile.h"
-#endif
-#include <printf.h>
 #include <stdarg.h>
-#include <stdio.h>
-#include <string.h>
-#include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
+#include <locale/localeinfo.h>
 
 
-#define out_char(Ch)							      \
-  do {									      \
-    if (dest >= s + maxsize - 1)					      \
-      {									      \
-	__set_errno (E2BIG);						      \
-	va_end (ap);							      \
-	return -1;							      \
-      }									      \
-    *dest++ = (Ch);							      \
-  } while (0)
-
-#define out_string(String)						      \
-  do {									      \
-    const char *_s = (String);						      \
-    while (*_s)								      \
-      out_char (*_s++);							      \
-  } while (0)
-
-#define out_nstring(String, N)						      \
-  do {									      \
-    int _n = (N);							      \
-    const char *_s = (String);						      \
-    while (_n-- > 0)							      \
-      out_char (*_s++);							      \
-  } while (0)
-
-#define to_digit(Ch) ((Ch) - '0')
-
-
-/* We use this code also for the extended locale handling where the
-   function gets as an additional argument the locale which has to be
-   used.  To access the values we have to redefine the _NL_CURRENT
-   macro.  */
-#ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-# undef _NL_CURRENT
-# define _NL_CURRENT(category, item) \
-  (current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (item)].string)
-#endif
-
-extern int __printf_fp (FILE *, const struct printf_info *,
-			const void *const *);
-libc_hidden_proto (__printf_fp)
-/* This function determines the number of digit groups in the output.
-   The definition is in printf_fp.c.  */
-extern unsigned int __guess_grouping (unsigned int intdig_max,
-				      const char *grouping, wchar_t sepchar);
-
-
-/* We have to overcome some problems with this implementation.  On the
-   one hand the strfmon() function is specified in XPG4 and of course
-   it has to follow this.  But on the other hand POSIX.2 specifies
-   some information in the LC_MONETARY category which should be used,
-   too.  Some of the information contradicts the information which can
-   be specified in format string.  */
-#ifndef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
 ssize_t
 strfmon (char *s, size_t maxsize, const char *format, ...)
-#else
-ssize_t
-__strfmon_l (char *s, size_t maxsize, __locale_t loc, const char *format, ...)
-#endif
 {
-#ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-  struct locale_data *current = loc->__locales[LC_MONETARY];
-#endif
-#ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
-  _IO_strfile f;
-# ifdef _IO_MTSAFE_IO
-  _IO_lock_t lock;
-# endif
-#else
-  FILE f;
-#endif
-  struct printf_info info;
-  va_list ap;			/* Scan through the varargs.  */
-  char *dest;			/* Pointer so copy the output.  */
-  const char *fmt;		/* Pointer that walks through format.  */
+  va_list ap;
 
   va_start (ap, format);
 
-  dest = s;
-  fmt = format;
-
-  /* Loop through the format-string.  */
-  while (*fmt != '\0')
-    {
-      /* The floating-point value to output.  */
-      union
-      {
-	double dbl;
-	__long_double_t ldbl;
-      }
-      fpnum;
-      int int_format;
-      int print_curr_symbol;
-      int left_prec;
-      int left_pad;
-      int right_prec;
-      int group;
-      char pad;
-      int is_long_double;
-      int p_sign_posn;
-      int n_sign_posn;
-      int sign_posn;
-      int other_sign_posn;
-      int left;
-      int is_negative;
-      int sep_by_space;
-      int other_sep_by_space;
-      int cs_precedes;
-      int other_cs_precedes;
-      const char *sign_string;
-      const char *other_sign_string;
-      int done;
-      const char *currency_symbol;
-      size_t currency_symbol_len;
-      int width;
-      char *startp;
-      const void *ptr;
-      char space_char;
-
-      /* Process all character which do not introduce a format
-	 specification.  */
-      if (*fmt != '%')
-	{
-	  out_char (*fmt++);
-	  continue;
-	}
-
-      /* "%%" means a single '%' character.  */
-      if (fmt[1] == '%')
-	{
-	  out_char (*++fmt);
-	  ++fmt;
-	  continue;
-	}
-
-      /* Defaults for formatting.  */
-      int_format = 0;			/* Use international curr. symbol */
-      print_curr_symbol = 1;		/* Print the currency symbol.  */
-      left_prec = -1;			/* No left precision specified.  */
-      right_prec = -1;			/* No right precision specified.  */
-      group = 1;			/* Print digits grouped.  */
-      pad = ' ';			/* Fill character is <SP>.  */
-      is_long_double = 0;		/* Double argument by default.  */
-      p_sign_posn = -1;			/* This indicates whether the */
-      n_sign_posn = -1;			/* '(' flag is given.  */
-      width = -1;			/* No width specified so far.  */
-      left = 0;				/* Right justified by default.  */
-
-      /* Parse group characters.  */
-      while (1)
-	{
-	  switch (*++fmt)
-	    {
-	    case '=':			/* Set fill character.  */
-	      pad = *++fmt;
-	      if (pad == '\0')
-		{
-		  /* Premature EOS.  */
-		  __set_errno (EINVAL);
-		  va_end (ap);
-		  return -1;
-		}
-	      continue;
-	    case '^':			/* Don't group digits.  */
-	      group = 0;
-	      continue;
-	    case '+':			/* Use +/- for sign of number.  */
-	      if (n_sign_posn != -1)
-		{
-		  __set_errno (EINVAL);
-		  va_end (ap);
-		  return -1;
-		}
-	      p_sign_posn = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, P_SIGN_POSN);
-	      n_sign_posn = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, N_SIGN_POSN);
-	      continue;
-	    case '(':			/* Use ( ) for negative sign.  */
-	      if (n_sign_posn != -1)
-		{
-		  __set_errno (EINVAL);
-		  va_end (ap);
-		  return -1;
-		}
-	      p_sign_posn = 0;
-	      n_sign_posn = 0;
-	      continue;
-	    case '!':			/* Don't print the currency symbol.  */
-	      print_curr_symbol = 0;
-	      continue;
-	    case '-':			/* Print left justified.  */
-	      left = 1;
-	      continue;
-	    default:
-	      /* Will stop the loop.  */;
-	    }
-	  break;
-	}
-
-      if (isdigit (*fmt))
-	{
-	  /* Parse field width.  */
-	  width = to_digit (*fmt);
-
-	  while (isdigit (*++fmt))
-	    {
-	      width *= 10;
-	      width += to_digit (*fmt);
-	    }
-
-	  /* If we don't have enough room for the demanded width we
-	     can stop now and return an error.  */
-	  if (dest + width >= s + maxsize)
-	    {
-	      __set_errno (E2BIG);
-	      va_end (ap);
-	      return -1;
-	    }
-	}
-
-      /* Recognize left precision.  */
-      if (*fmt == '#')
-	{
-	  if (!isdigit (*++fmt))
-	    {
-	      __set_errno (EINVAL);
-	      va_end (ap);
-	      return -1;
-	    }
-	  left_prec = to_digit (*fmt);
-
-	  while (isdigit (*++fmt))
-	    {
-	      left_prec *= 10;
-	      left_prec += to_digit (*fmt);
-	    }
-	}
-
-      /* Recognize right precision.  */
-      if (*fmt == '.')
-	{
-	  if (!isdigit (*++fmt))
-	    {
-	      __set_errno (EINVAL);
-	      va_end (ap);
-	      return -1;
-	    }
-	  right_prec = to_digit (*fmt);
-
-	  while (isdigit (*++fmt))
-	    {
-	      right_prec *= 10;
-	      right_prec += to_digit (*fmt);
-	    }
-	}
-
-      /* Handle modifier.  This is an extension.  */
-      if (*fmt == 'L')
-	{
-	  ++fmt;
-	  is_long_double = 1;
-	}
-
-      /* Handle format specifier.  */
-      char int_symbol[4];
-      switch (*fmt++)
-	{
-	case 'i': {		/* Use international currency symbol.  */
-	  const char *int_curr_symbol;
-
-	  int_curr_symbol = _NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, INT_CURR_SYMBOL);
-	  strncpy(int_symbol, int_curr_symbol, 3);
-	  int_symbol[3] = '\0';
-
-	  currency_symbol_len = 3;
-	  currency_symbol = &int_symbol[0];
-	  space_char = int_curr_symbol[3];
-	  int_format = 1;
-	  break;
-	}
-	case 'n':		/* Use national currency symbol.  */
-	  currency_symbol = _NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, CURRENCY_SYMBOL);
-	  currency_symbol_len = strlen (currency_symbol);
-	  space_char = ' ';
-	  int_format = 0;
-	  break;
-	default:		/* Any unrecognized format is an error.  */
-	  __set_errno (EINVAL);
-	  va_end (ap);
-	  return -1;
-	}
-
-      /* If not specified by the format string now find the values for
-	 the format specification.  */
-      if (p_sign_posn == -1)
-	p_sign_posn = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_P_SIGN_POSN : P_SIGN_POSN);
-      if (n_sign_posn == -1)
-	n_sign_posn = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_N_SIGN_POSN : N_SIGN_POSN);
-
-      if (right_prec == -1)
-	{
-	  right_prec = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_FRAC_DIGITS : FRAC_DIGITS);
-
-	  if (right_prec == CHAR_MAX)
-	    right_prec = 2;
-	}
-
-      /* If we have to print the digits grouped determine how many
-	 extra characters this means.  */
-      if (group && left_prec != -1)
-	left_prec += __guess_grouping (left_prec,
-				       _NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, MON_GROUPING),
-				       *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY,
-						     MON_THOUSANDS_SEP));
-
-      /* Now it's time to get the value.  */
-      if (is_long_double == 1)
-	{
-	  fpnum.ldbl = va_arg (ap, long double);
-	  is_negative = fpnum.ldbl < 0;
-	  if (is_negative)
-	    fpnum.ldbl = -fpnum.ldbl;
-	}
-      else
-	{
-	  fpnum.dbl = va_arg (ap, double);
-	  is_negative = fpnum.dbl < 0;
-	  if (is_negative)
-	    fpnum.dbl = -fpnum.dbl;
-	}
-
-      /* We now know the sign of the value and can determine the format.  */
-      if (is_negative)
-	{
-	  sign_string = _NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, NEGATIVE_SIGN);
-	  /* If the locale does not specify a character for the
-	     negative sign we use a '-'.  */
-	  if (*sign_string == '\0')
-	    sign_string = (const char *) "-";
-	  cs_precedes = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_N_CS_PRECEDES : N_CS_PRECEDES);
-	  sep_by_space = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_N_SEP_BY_SPACE : N_SEP_BY_SPACE);
-	  sign_posn = n_sign_posn;
-
-	  other_sign_string = _NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, POSITIVE_SIGN);
-	  other_cs_precedes = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_P_CS_PRECEDES : P_CS_PRECEDES);
-	  other_sep_by_space = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_P_SEP_BY_SPACE : P_SEP_BY_SPACE);
-	  other_sign_posn = p_sign_posn;
-	}
-      else
-	{
-	  sign_string = _NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, POSITIVE_SIGN);
-	  cs_precedes = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_P_CS_PRECEDES : P_CS_PRECEDES);
-	  sep_by_space = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_P_SEP_BY_SPACE : P_SEP_BY_SPACE);
-	  sign_posn = p_sign_posn;
-
-	  other_sign_string = _NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, NEGATIVE_SIGN);
-	  if (*other_sign_string == '\0')
-	    other_sign_string = (const char *) "-";
-	  other_cs_precedes = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_N_CS_PRECEDES : N_CS_PRECEDES);
-	  other_sep_by_space = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_N_SEP_BY_SPACE : N_SEP_BY_SPACE);
-	  other_sign_posn = n_sign_posn;
-	}
-
-      /* Set default values for unspecified information.  */
-      if (cs_precedes != 0)
-	cs_precedes = 1;
-      if (other_cs_precedes != 0)
-	other_cs_precedes = 1;
-      if (sep_by_space == CHAR_MAX)
-	sep_by_space = 0;
-      if (other_sep_by_space == CHAR_MAX)
-	other_sep_by_space = 0;
-      if (sign_posn == CHAR_MAX)
-	sign_posn = 1;
-      if (other_sign_posn == CHAR_MAX)
-	other_sign_posn = 1;
-
-      /* Check for degenerate cases */
-      if (sep_by_space == 2)
-	{
-	  if (sign_posn == 0 ||
-	      (sign_posn == 1 && !cs_precedes) ||
-	      (sign_posn == 2 && cs_precedes))
-	    /* sign and symbol are not adjacent, so no separator */
-	    sep_by_space = 0;
-	}
-      if (other_sep_by_space == 2)
-	{
-	  if (other_sign_posn == 0 ||
-	      (other_sign_posn == 1 && !other_cs_precedes) ||
-	      (other_sign_posn == 2 && other_cs_precedes))
-	    /* sign and symbol are not adjacent, so no separator */
-	    other_sep_by_space = 0;
-	}
-
-      /* Set the left precision and padding needed for alignment */
-      if (left_prec == -1)
-	{
-	  left_prec = 0;
-	  left_pad = 0;
-	}
-      else
-	{
-	  /* Set left_pad to number of spaces needed to align positive
-	     and negative formats */
-
-	  int left_bytes = 0;
-	  int other_left_bytes = 0;
-
-	  /* Work out number of bytes for currency string and separator
-	     preceding the value */
-	  if (cs_precedes)
-	    {
-	      left_bytes += currency_symbol_len;
-	      if (sep_by_space != 0)
-		++left_bytes;
-	    }
-
-	  if (other_cs_precedes)
-	    {
-	      other_left_bytes += currency_symbol_len;
-	      if (other_sep_by_space != 0)
-		++other_left_bytes;
-	    }
-
-	  /* Work out number of bytes for the sign (or left parenthesis)
-	     preceding the value */
-	  if (sign_posn == 0 && is_negative)
-	    ++left_bytes;
-	  else if (sign_posn == 1)
-	    left_bytes += strlen (sign_string);
-	  else if (cs_precedes && (sign_posn == 3 || sign_posn == 4))
-	    left_bytes += strlen (sign_string);
-
-	  if (other_sign_posn == 0 && !is_negative)
-	    ++other_left_bytes;
-	  else if (other_sign_posn == 1)
-	    other_left_bytes += strlen (other_sign_string);
-	  else if (other_cs_precedes &&
-		   (other_sign_posn == 3 || other_sign_posn == 4))
-	    other_left_bytes += strlen (other_sign_string);
-
-	  /* Compare the number of bytes preceding the value for
-	     each format, and set the padding accordingly */
-	  if (other_left_bytes > left_bytes)
-	    left_pad = other_left_bytes - left_bytes;
-	  else
-	    left_pad = 0;
-	}
-
-      /* Perhaps we'll someday make these things configurable so
-	 better start using symbolic names now.  */
-#define left_paren '('
-#define right_paren ')'
-
-      startp = dest;		/* Remember start so we can compute length.  */
-
-      while (left_pad-- > 0)
-	out_char (' ');
-
-      if (sign_posn == 0 && is_negative)
-	out_char (left_paren);
-
-      if (cs_precedes)
-	{
-	  if (sign_posn != 0 && sign_posn != 2 && sign_posn != 4
-	      && sign_posn != 5)
-	    {
-	      out_string (sign_string);
-	      if (sep_by_space == 2)
-		out_char (' ');
-	    }
-
-	  if (print_curr_symbol)
-	    {
-	      out_string (currency_symbol);
-
-	      if (sign_posn == 4)
-		{
-		  if (sep_by_space == 2)
-		    out_char (space_char);
-		  out_string (sign_string);
-		  if (sep_by_space == 1)
-		    /* POSIX.2 and SUS are not clear on this case, but C99
-		       says a space follows the adjacent-symbol-and-sign */
-		    out_char (' ');
-		}
-	      else
-		if (sep_by_space == 1)
-		  out_char (space_char);
-	    }
-	}
-      else
-	if (sign_posn != 0 && sign_posn != 2 && sign_posn != 3
-	    && sign_posn != 4 && sign_posn != 5)
-	  out_string (sign_string);
-
-      /* Print the number.  */
-#ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
-# ifdef _IO_MTSAFE_IO
-      f._sbf._f._lock = &lock;
-# endif
-      INTUSE(_IO_init) ((_IO_FILE *) &f, 0);
-      _IO_JUMPS ((struct _IO_FILE_plus *) &f) = &_IO_str_jumps;
-      INTUSE(_IO_str_init_static) ((_IO_strfile *) &f, dest,
-				   (s + maxsize) - dest, dest);
-#else
-      memset ((void *) &f, 0, sizeof (f));
-      f.__magic = _IOMAGIC;
-      f.__mode.__write = 1;
-      /* The buffer size is one less than MAXLEN
-	 so we have space for the null terminator.  */
-      f.__bufp = f.__buffer = (char *) dest;
-      f.__bufsize = (s + maxsize) - dest;
-      f.__put_limit = f.__buffer + f.__bufsize;
-      f.__get_limit = f.__buffer;
-      /* After the buffer is full (MAXLEN characters have been written),
-	 any more characters written will go to the bit bucket.  */
-      f.__room_funcs = __default_room_functions;
-      f.__io_funcs.__write = NULL;
-      f.__seen = 1;
-#endif
-      /* We clear the last available byte so we can find out whether
-	 the numeric representation is too long.  */
-      s[maxsize - 1] = '\0';
-
-      info.prec = right_prec;
-      info.width = left_prec + (right_prec ? (right_prec + 1) : 0);
-      info.spec = 'f';
-      info.is_long_double = is_long_double;
-      info.is_short = 0;
-      info.is_long = 0;
-      info.alt = 0;
-      info.space = 0;
-      info.left = 0;
-      info.showsign = 0;
-      info.group = group;
-      info.pad = pad;
-      info.extra = 1;		/* This means use values from LC_MONETARY.  */
-      info.wide = 0;
-
-      ptr = &fpnum;
-      done = __printf_fp ((FILE *) &f, &info, &ptr);
-      if (done < 0)
-	{
-	  va_end (ap);
-	  return -1;
-	}
-
-      if (s[maxsize - 1] != '\0')
-	{
-	  __set_errno (E2BIG);
-	  return -1;
-	}
-
-      dest += done;
-
-      if (!cs_precedes)
-	{
-	  if (sign_posn == 3)
-	    {
-	      if (sep_by_space == 1)
-		out_char (' ');
-	      out_string (sign_string);
-	    }
-
-	  if (print_curr_symbol)
-	    {
-	      if ((sign_posn == 3 && sep_by_space == 2)
-		  || (sign_posn == 4 && sep_by_space == 1)
-		  || (sign_posn == 2 && sep_by_space == 1)
-		  || (sign_posn == 1 && sep_by_space == 1)
-		  || (sign_posn == 0 && sep_by_space == 1))
-		out_char (space_char);
-	      out_nstring (currency_symbol, currency_symbol_len);
-	      if (sign_posn == 4)
-		{
-		  if (sep_by_space == 2)
-		    out_char (' ');
-		  out_string (sign_string);
-		}
-	    }
-	}
-
-      if (sign_posn == 2)
-	{
-	  if (sep_by_space == 2)
-	    out_char (' ');
-	  out_string (sign_string);
-	}
-
-      if (sign_posn == 0 && is_negative)
-	out_char (right_paren);
-
-      /* Now test whether the output width is filled.  */
-      if (dest - startp < width)
-	{
-	  if (left)
-	    /* We simply have to fill using spaces.  */
-	    do
-	      out_char (' ');
-	    while (dest - startp < width);
-	  else
-	    {
-	      int dist = width - (dest - startp);
-	      char *cp;
-	      for (cp = dest - 1; cp >= startp; --cp)
-		cp[dist] = cp[0];
-
-	      dest += dist;
-
-	      do
-		startp[--dist] = ' ';
-	      while (dist > 0);
-	    }
-	}
-    }
-
-  /* Terminate the string.  */
-  *dest = '\0';
+  ssize_t res = __vstrfmon_l (s, maxsize, _NL_CURRENT_LOCALE, format, ap);
 
   va_end (ap);
 
-  return dest - s;
+  return res;
 }
diff --git a/stdlib/strfmon_l.c b/stdlib/strfmon_l.c
index b0c82a337e..90076afc45 100644
--- a/stdlib/strfmon_l.c
+++ b/stdlib/strfmon_l.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Formatting a monetary value according to the given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1996.
 
@@ -18,7 +18,637 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
-#include <strfmon.c>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <langinfo.h>
+#include <locale.h>
+#include <monetary.h>
+#ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
+# include "../libio/libioP.h"
+# include "../libio/strfile.h"
+#endif
+#include <printf.h>
+#include <stdarg.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
 
+
+#define out_char(Ch)							      \
+  do {									      \
+    if (dest >= s + maxsize - 1)					      \
+      {									      \
+	__set_errno (E2BIG);						      \
+	va_end (ap);							      \
+	return -1;							      \
+      }									      \
+    *dest++ = (Ch);							      \
+  } while (0)
+
+#define out_string(String)						      \
+  do {									      \
+    const char *_s = (String);						      \
+    while (*_s)								      \
+      out_char (*_s++);							      \
+  } while (0)
+
+#define out_nstring(String, N)						      \
+  do {									      \
+    int _n = (N);							      \
+    const char *_s = (String);						      \
+    while (_n-- > 0)							      \
+      out_char (*_s++);							      \
+  } while (0)
+
+#define to_digit(Ch) ((Ch) - '0')
+
+
+/* We use this code also for the extended locale handling where the
+   function gets as an additional argument the locale which has to be
+   used.  To access the values we have to redefine the _NL_CURRENT
+   macro.  */
+#undef _NL_CURRENT
+#define _NL_CURRENT(category, item) \
+  (current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (item)].string)
+
+extern int __printf_fp (FILE *, const struct printf_info *,
+			const void *const *);
+libc_hidden_proto (__printf_fp)
+/* This function determines the number of digit groups in the output.
+   The definition is in printf_fp.c.  */
+extern unsigned int __guess_grouping (unsigned int intdig_max,
+				      const char *grouping, wchar_t sepchar);
+
+
+/* We have to overcome some problems with this implementation.  On the
+   one hand the strfmon() function is specified in XPG4 and of course
+   it has to follow this.  But on the other hand POSIX.2 specifies
+   some information in the LC_MONETARY category which should be used,
+   too.  Some of the information contradicts the information which can
+   be specified in format string.  */
+ssize_t
+__vstrfmon_l (char *s, size_t maxsize, __locale_t loc, const char *format,
+	      va_list ap)
+{
+  struct locale_data *current = loc->__locales[LC_MONETARY];
+#ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
+  _IO_strfile f;
+# ifdef _IO_MTSAFE_IO
+  _IO_lock_t lock;
+# endif
+#else
+  FILE f;
+#endif
+  struct printf_info info;
+  char *dest;			/* Pointer so copy the output.  */
+  const char *fmt;		/* Pointer that walks through format.  */
+
+  dest = s;
+  fmt = format;
+
+  /* Loop through the format-string.  */
+  while (*fmt != '\0')
+    {
+      /* The floating-point value to output.  */
+      union
+      {
+	double dbl;
+	__long_double_t ldbl;
+      }
+      fpnum;
+      int int_format;
+      int print_curr_symbol;
+      int left_prec;
+      int left_pad;
+      int right_prec;
+      int group;
+      char pad;
+      int is_long_double;
+      int p_sign_posn;
+      int n_sign_posn;
+      int sign_posn;
+      int other_sign_posn;
+      int left;
+      int is_negative;
+      int sep_by_space;
+      int other_sep_by_space;
+      int cs_precedes;
+      int other_cs_precedes;
+      const char *sign_string;
+      const char *other_sign_string;
+      int done;
+      const char *currency_symbol;
+      size_t currency_symbol_len;
+      int width;
+      char *startp;
+      const void *ptr;
+      char space_char;
+
+      /* Process all character which do not introduce a format
+	 specification.  */
+      if (*fmt != '%')
+	{
+	  out_char (*fmt++);
+	  continue;
+	}
+
+      /* "%%" means a single '%' character.  */
+      if (fmt[1] == '%')
+	{
+	  out_char (*++fmt);
+	  ++fmt;
+	  continue;
+	}
+
+      /* Defaults for formatting.  */
+      int_format = 0;			/* Use international curr. symbol */
+      print_curr_symbol = 1;		/* Print the currency symbol.  */
+      left_prec = -1;			/* No left precision specified.  */
+      right_prec = -1;			/* No right precision specified.  */
+      group = 1;			/* Print digits grouped.  */
+      pad = ' ';			/* Fill character is <SP>.  */
+      is_long_double = 0;		/* Double argument by default.  */
+      p_sign_posn = -1;			/* This indicates whether the */
+      n_sign_posn = -1;			/* '(' flag is given.  */
+      width = -1;			/* No width specified so far.  */
+      left = 0;				/* Right justified by default.  */
+
+      /* Parse group characters.  */
+      while (1)
+	{
+	  switch (*++fmt)
+	    {
+	    case '=':			/* Set fill character.  */
+	      pad = *++fmt;
+	      if (pad == '\0')
+		{
+		  /* Premature EOS.  */
+		  __set_errno (EINVAL);
+		  return -1;
+		}
+	      continue;
+	    case '^':			/* Don't group digits.  */
+	      group = 0;
+	      continue;
+	    case '+':			/* Use +/- for sign of number.  */
+	      if (n_sign_posn != -1)
+		{
+		  __set_errno (EINVAL);
+		  return -1;
+		}
+	      p_sign_posn = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, P_SIGN_POSN);
+	      n_sign_posn = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, N_SIGN_POSN);
+	      continue;
+	    case '(':			/* Use ( ) for negative sign.  */
+	      if (n_sign_posn != -1)
+		{
+		  __set_errno (EINVAL);
+		  return -1;
+		}
+	      p_sign_posn = 0;
+	      n_sign_posn = 0;
+	      continue;
+	    case '!':			/* Don't print the currency symbol.  */
+	      print_curr_symbol = 0;
+	      continue;
+	    case '-':			/* Print left justified.  */
+	      left = 1;
+	      continue;
+	    default:
+	      /* Will stop the loop.  */;
+	    }
+	  break;
+	}
+
+      if (isdigit (*fmt))
+	{
+	  /* Parse field width.  */
+	  width = to_digit (*fmt);
+
+	  while (isdigit (*++fmt))
+	    {
+	      width *= 10;
+	      width += to_digit (*fmt);
+	    }
+
+	  /* If we don't have enough room for the demanded width we
+	     can stop now and return an error.  */
+	  if (dest + width >= s + maxsize)
+	    {
+	      __set_errno (E2BIG);
+	      return -1;
+	    }
+	}
+
+      /* Recognize left precision.  */
+      if (*fmt == '#')
+	{
+	  if (!isdigit (*++fmt))
+	    {
+	      __set_errno (EINVAL);
+	      return -1;
+	    }
+	  left_prec = to_digit (*fmt);
+
+	  while (isdigit (*++fmt))
+	    {
+	      left_prec *= 10;
+	      left_prec += to_digit (*fmt);
+	    }
+	}
+
+      /* Recognize right precision.  */
+      if (*fmt == '.')
+	{
+	  if (!isdigit (*++fmt))
+	    {
+	      __set_errno (EINVAL);
+	      return -1;
+	    }
+	  right_prec = to_digit (*fmt);
+
+	  while (isdigit (*++fmt))
+	    {
+	      right_prec *= 10;
+	      right_prec += to_digit (*fmt);
+	    }
+	}
+
+      /* Handle modifier.  This is an extension.  */
+      if (*fmt == 'L')
+	{
+	  ++fmt;
+	  is_long_double = 1;
+	}
+
+      /* Handle format specifier.  */
+      char int_symbol[4];
+      switch (*fmt++)
+	{
+	case 'i': {		/* Use international currency symbol.  */
+	  const char *int_curr_symbol;
+
+	  int_curr_symbol = _NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, INT_CURR_SYMBOL);
+	  strncpy(int_symbol, int_curr_symbol, 3);
+	  int_symbol[3] = '\0';
+
+	  currency_symbol_len = 3;
+	  currency_symbol = &int_symbol[0];
+	  space_char = int_curr_symbol[3];
+	  int_format = 1;
+	  break;
+	}
+	case 'n':		/* Use national currency symbol.  */
+	  currency_symbol = _NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, CURRENCY_SYMBOL);
+	  currency_symbol_len = strlen (currency_symbol);
+	  space_char = ' ';
+	  int_format = 0;
+	  break;
+	default:		/* Any unrecognized format is an error.  */
+	  __set_errno (EINVAL);
+	  return -1;
+	}
+
+      /* If not specified by the format string now find the values for
+	 the format specification.  */
+      if (p_sign_posn == -1)
+	p_sign_posn = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_P_SIGN_POSN : P_SIGN_POSN);
+      if (n_sign_posn == -1)
+	n_sign_posn = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_N_SIGN_POSN : N_SIGN_POSN);
+
+      if (right_prec == -1)
+	{
+	  right_prec = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_FRAC_DIGITS : FRAC_DIGITS);
+
+	  if (right_prec == CHAR_MAX)
+	    right_prec = 2;
+	}
+
+      /* If we have to print the digits grouped determine how many
+	 extra characters this means.  */
+      if (group && left_prec != -1)
+	left_prec += __guess_grouping (left_prec,
+				       _NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, MON_GROUPING),
+				       *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY,
+						     MON_THOUSANDS_SEP));
+
+      /* Now it's time to get the value.  */
+      if (is_long_double == 1)
+	{
+	  fpnum.ldbl = va_arg (ap, long double);
+	  is_negative = fpnum.ldbl < 0;
+	  if (is_negative)
+	    fpnum.ldbl = -fpnum.ldbl;
+	}
+      else
+	{
+	  fpnum.dbl = va_arg (ap, double);
+	  is_negative = fpnum.dbl < 0;
+	  if (is_negative)
+	    fpnum.dbl = -fpnum.dbl;
+	}
+
+      /* We now know the sign of the value and can determine the format.  */
+      if (is_negative)
+	{
+	  sign_string = _NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, NEGATIVE_SIGN);
+	  /* If the locale does not specify a character for the
+	     negative sign we use a '-'.  */
+	  if (*sign_string == '\0')
+	    sign_string = (const char *) "-";
+	  cs_precedes = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_N_CS_PRECEDES : N_CS_PRECEDES);
+	  sep_by_space = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_N_SEP_BY_SPACE : N_SEP_BY_SPACE);
+	  sign_posn = n_sign_posn;
+
+	  other_sign_string = _NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, POSITIVE_SIGN);
+	  other_cs_precedes = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_P_CS_PRECEDES : P_CS_PRECEDES);
+	  other_sep_by_space = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_P_SEP_BY_SPACE : P_SEP_BY_SPACE);
+	  other_sign_posn = p_sign_posn;
+	}
+      else
+	{
+	  sign_string = _NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, POSITIVE_SIGN);
+	  cs_precedes = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_P_CS_PRECEDES : P_CS_PRECEDES);
+	  sep_by_space = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_P_SEP_BY_SPACE : P_SEP_BY_SPACE);
+	  sign_posn = p_sign_posn;
+
+	  other_sign_string = _NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, NEGATIVE_SIGN);
+	  if (*other_sign_string == '\0')
+	    other_sign_string = (const char *) "-";
+	  other_cs_precedes = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_N_CS_PRECEDES : N_CS_PRECEDES);
+	  other_sep_by_space = *_NL_CURRENT (LC_MONETARY, int_format ? INT_N_SEP_BY_SPACE : N_SEP_BY_SPACE);
+	  other_sign_posn = n_sign_posn;
+	}
+
+      /* Set default values for unspecified information.  */
+      if (cs_precedes != 0)
+	cs_precedes = 1;
+      if (other_cs_precedes != 0)
+	other_cs_precedes = 1;
+      if (sep_by_space == CHAR_MAX)
+	sep_by_space = 0;
+      if (other_sep_by_space == CHAR_MAX)
+	other_sep_by_space = 0;
+      if (sign_posn == CHAR_MAX)
+	sign_posn = 1;
+      if (other_sign_posn == CHAR_MAX)
+	other_sign_posn = 1;
+
+      /* Check for degenerate cases */
+      if (sep_by_space == 2)
+	{
+	  if (sign_posn == 0 ||
+	      (sign_posn == 1 && !cs_precedes) ||
+	      (sign_posn == 2 && cs_precedes))
+	    /* sign and symbol are not adjacent, so no separator */
+	    sep_by_space = 0;
+	}
+      if (other_sep_by_space == 2)
+	{
+	  if (other_sign_posn == 0 ||
+	      (other_sign_posn == 1 && !other_cs_precedes) ||
+	      (other_sign_posn == 2 && other_cs_precedes))
+	    /* sign and symbol are not adjacent, so no separator */
+	    other_sep_by_space = 0;
+	}
+
+      /* Set the left precision and padding needed for alignment */
+      if (left_prec == -1)
+	{
+	  left_prec = 0;
+	  left_pad = 0;
+	}
+      else
+	{
+	  /* Set left_pad to number of spaces needed to align positive
+	     and negative formats */
+
+	  int left_bytes = 0;
+	  int other_left_bytes = 0;
+
+	  /* Work out number of bytes for currency string and separator
+	     preceding the value */
+	  if (cs_precedes)
+	    {
+	      left_bytes += currency_symbol_len;
+	      if (sep_by_space != 0)
+		++left_bytes;
+	    }
+
+	  if (other_cs_precedes)
+	    {
+	      other_left_bytes += currency_symbol_len;
+	      if (other_sep_by_space != 0)
+		++other_left_bytes;
+	    }
+
+	  /* Work out number of bytes for the sign (or left parenthesis)
+	     preceding the value */
+	  if (sign_posn == 0 && is_negative)
+	    ++left_bytes;
+	  else if (sign_posn == 1)
+	    left_bytes += strlen (sign_string);
+	  else if (cs_precedes && (sign_posn == 3 || sign_posn == 4))
+	    left_bytes += strlen (sign_string);
+
+	  if (other_sign_posn == 0 && !is_negative)
+	    ++other_left_bytes;
+	  else if (other_sign_posn == 1)
+	    other_left_bytes += strlen (other_sign_string);
+	  else if (other_cs_precedes &&
+		   (other_sign_posn == 3 || other_sign_posn == 4))
+	    other_left_bytes += strlen (other_sign_string);
+
+	  /* Compare the number of bytes preceding the value for
+	     each format, and set the padding accordingly */
+	  if (other_left_bytes > left_bytes)
+	    left_pad = other_left_bytes - left_bytes;
+	  else
+	    left_pad = 0;
+	}
+
+      /* Perhaps we'll someday make these things configurable so
+	 better start using symbolic names now.  */
+#define left_paren '('
+#define right_paren ')'
+
+      startp = dest;		/* Remember start so we can compute length.  */
+
+      while (left_pad-- > 0)
+	out_char (' ');
+
+      if (sign_posn == 0 && is_negative)
+	out_char (left_paren);
+
+      if (cs_precedes)
+	{
+	  if (sign_posn != 0 && sign_posn != 2 && sign_posn != 4
+	      && sign_posn != 5)
+	    {
+	      out_string (sign_string);
+	      if (sep_by_space == 2)
+		out_char (' ');
+	    }
+
+	  if (print_curr_symbol)
+	    {
+	      out_string (currency_symbol);
+
+	      if (sign_posn == 4)
+		{
+		  if (sep_by_space == 2)
+		    out_char (space_char);
+		  out_string (sign_string);
+		  if (sep_by_space == 1)
+		    /* POSIX.2 and SUS are not clear on this case, but C99
+		       says a space follows the adjacent-symbol-and-sign */
+		    out_char (' ');
+		}
+	      else
+		if (sep_by_space == 1)
+		  out_char (space_char);
+	    }
+	}
+      else
+	if (sign_posn != 0 && sign_posn != 2 && sign_posn != 3
+	    && sign_posn != 4 && sign_posn != 5)
+	  out_string (sign_string);
+
+      /* Print the number.  */
+#ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
+# ifdef _IO_MTSAFE_IO
+      f._sbf._f._lock = &lock;
+# endif
+      INTUSE(_IO_init) ((_IO_FILE *) &f, 0);
+      _IO_JUMPS ((struct _IO_FILE_plus *) &f) = &_IO_str_jumps;
+      INTUSE(_IO_str_init_static) ((_IO_strfile *) &f, dest,
+				   (s + maxsize) - dest, dest);
+#else
+      memset ((void *) &f, 0, sizeof (f));
+      f.__magic = _IOMAGIC;
+      f.__mode.__write = 1;
+      /* The buffer size is one less than MAXLEN
+	 so we have space for the null terminator.  */
+      f.__bufp = f.__buffer = (char *) dest;
+      f.__bufsize = (s + maxsize) - dest;
+      f.__put_limit = f.__buffer + f.__bufsize;
+      f.__get_limit = f.__buffer;
+      /* After the buffer is full (MAXLEN characters have been written),
+	 any more characters written will go to the bit bucket.  */
+      f.__room_funcs = __default_room_functions;
+      f.__io_funcs.__write = NULL;
+      f.__seen = 1;
+#endif
+      /* We clear the last available byte so we can find out whether
+	 the numeric representation is too long.  */
+      s[maxsize - 1] = '\0';
+
+      info.prec = right_prec;
+      info.width = left_prec + (right_prec ? (right_prec + 1) : 0);
+      info.spec = 'f';
+      info.is_long_double = is_long_double;
+      info.is_short = 0;
+      info.is_long = 0;
+      info.alt = 0;
+      info.space = 0;
+      info.left = 0;
+      info.showsign = 0;
+      info.group = group;
+      info.pad = pad;
+      info.extra = 1;		/* This means use values from LC_MONETARY.  */
+      info.wide = 0;
+
+      ptr = &fpnum;
+      done = __printf_fp ((FILE *) &f, &info, &ptr);
+      if (done < 0)
+	return -1;
+
+      if (s[maxsize - 1] != '\0')
+	{
+	  __set_errno (E2BIG);
+	  return -1;
+	}
+
+      dest += done;
+
+      if (!cs_precedes)
+	{
+	  if (sign_posn == 3)
+	    {
+	      if (sep_by_space == 1)
+		out_char (' ');
+	      out_string (sign_string);
+	    }
+
+	  if (print_curr_symbol)
+	    {
+	      if ((sign_posn == 3 && sep_by_space == 2)
+		  || (sign_posn == 4 && sep_by_space == 1)
+		  || (sign_posn == 2 && sep_by_space == 1)
+		  || (sign_posn == 1 && sep_by_space == 1)
+		  || (sign_posn == 0 && sep_by_space == 1))
+		out_char (space_char);
+	      out_nstring (currency_symbol, currency_symbol_len);
+	      if (sign_posn == 4)
+		{
+		  if (sep_by_space == 2)
+		    out_char (' ');
+		  out_string (sign_string);
+		}
+	    }
+	}
+
+      if (sign_posn == 2)
+	{
+	  if (sep_by_space == 2)
+	    out_char (' ');
+	  out_string (sign_string);
+	}
+
+      if (sign_posn == 0 && is_negative)
+	out_char (right_paren);
+
+      /* Now test whether the output width is filled.  */
+      if (dest - startp < width)
+	{
+	  if (left)
+	    /* We simply have to fill using spaces.  */
+	    do
+	      out_char (' ');
+	    while (dest - startp < width);
+	  else
+	    {
+	      int dist = width - (dest - startp);
+	      char *cp;
+	      for (cp = dest - 1; cp >= startp; --cp)
+		cp[dist] = cp[0];
+
+	      dest += dist;
+
+	      do
+		startp[--dist] = ' ';
+	      while (dist > 0);
+	    }
+	}
+    }
+
+  /* Terminate the string.  */
+  *dest = '\0';
+
+  return dest - s;
+}
+
+ssize_t
+__strfmon_l (char *s, size_t maxsize, __locale_t loc, const char *format, ...)
+{
+  va_list ap;
+
+  va_start (ap, format);
+
+  ssize_t res = __vstrfmon_l (s, maxsize, loc, format, ap);
+
+  va_end (ap);
+
+  return res;
+}
 weak_alias (__strfmon_l, strfmon_l)
diff --git a/stdlib/strtod.c b/stdlib/strtod.c
index 63d7a4d5bb..1d4e4a4c29 100644
--- a/stdlib/strtod.c
+++ b/stdlib/strtod.c
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
 /* Read decimal floating point numbers.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
-   Copyright (C) 1995-2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1995-2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.org>, 1995.
 
    The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
@@ -18,1579 +18,53 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-/* Configuration part.  These macros are defined by `strtold.c',
-   `strtof.c', `wcstod.c', `wcstold.c', and `wcstof.c' to produce the
-   `long double' and `float' versions of the reader.  */
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <wchar.h>
+#include <locale/localeinfo.h>
+
+
 #ifndef FLOAT
-# define FLOAT		double
-# define FLT		DBL
+# define FLOAT double
 # ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-#  ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#   define STRTOF	__wcstod_l
-#  else
-#   define STRTOF	wcstod
-#  endif
+#  define STRTOF wcstod
+#  define STRTOF_L __wcstod_l
 # else
-#  ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#   define STRTOF	__strtod_l
-#  else
-#   define STRTOF	strtod
-#  endif
+#  define STRTOF strtod
+#  define STRTOF_L __strtod_l
 # endif
-# define MPN2FLOAT	__mpn_construct_double
-# define FLOAT_HUGE_VAL	HUGE_VAL
-# define SET_MANTISSA(flt, mant) \
-  do { union ieee754_double u;						      \
-       u.d = (flt);							      \
-       if ((mant & 0xfffffffffffffULL) == 0)				      \
-	 mant = 0x8000000000000ULL;					      \
-       u.ieee.mantissa0 = ((mant) >> 32) & 0xfffff;			      \
-       u.ieee.mantissa1 = (mant) & 0xffffffff;				      \
-       (flt) = u.d;							      \
-  } while (0)
-#endif
-/* End of configuration part.  */
-
-#include <ctype.h>
-#include <errno.h>
-#include <float.h>
-#include <ieee754.h>
-#include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
-#include <locale.h>
-#include <math.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
-#include <string.h>
-
-/* The gmp headers need some configuration frobs.  */
-#define HAVE_ALLOCA 1
-
-/* Include gmp-mparam.h first, such that definitions of _SHORT_LIMB
-   and _LONG_LONG_LIMB in it can take effect into gmp.h.  */
-#include <gmp-mparam.h>
-#include <gmp.h>
-#include <gmp-impl.h>
-#include <longlong.h>
-#include "fpioconst.h"
-
-#define NDEBUG 1
-#include <assert.h>
-
-
-/* We use this code also for the extended locale handling where the
-   function gets as an additional argument the locale which has to be
-   used.  To access the values we have to redefine the _NL_CURRENT
-   macro.  */
-#ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-# undef _NL_CURRENT
-# define _NL_CURRENT(category, item) \
-  (current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (item)].string)
-# define LOCALE_PARAM , loc
-# define LOCALE_PARAM_DECL __locale_t loc;
-#else
-# define LOCALE_PARAM
-# define LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
-#endif
-
-#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_WCHAR_H
-# include <wchar.h>
 #endif
 
 #ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
 # include <wctype.h>
 # define STRING_TYPE wchar_t
-# define CHAR_TYPE wint_t
-# define L_(Ch) L##Ch
-# ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#  define ISSPACE(Ch) __iswspace_l ((Ch), loc)
-#  define ISDIGIT(Ch) __iswdigit_l ((Ch), loc)
-#  define ISXDIGIT(Ch) __iswxdigit_l ((Ch), loc)
-#  define TOLOWER(Ch) __towlower_l ((Ch), loc)
-#  define STRNCASECMP(S1, S2, N) __wcsncasecmp_l ((S1), (S2), (N), loc)
-#  define STRTOULL(S, E, B) ____wcstoull_l_internal ((S), (E), (B), 0, loc)
-# else
-#  define ISSPACE(Ch) iswspace (Ch)
-#  define ISDIGIT(Ch) iswdigit (Ch)
-#  define ISXDIGIT(Ch) iswxdigit (Ch)
-#  define TOLOWER(Ch) towlower (Ch)
-#  define STRNCASECMP(S1, S2, N) __wcsncasecmp ((S1), (S2), (N))
-#  define STRTOULL(S, E, B) __wcstoull_internal ((S), (E), (B), 0)
-# endif
 #else
 # define STRING_TYPE char
-# define CHAR_TYPE char
-# define L_(Ch) Ch
-# ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#  define ISSPACE(Ch) __isspace_l ((Ch), loc)
-#  define ISDIGIT(Ch) __isdigit_l ((Ch), loc)
-#  define ISXDIGIT(Ch) __isxdigit_l ((Ch), loc)
-#  define TOLOWER(Ch) __tolower_l ((Ch), loc)
-#  define STRNCASECMP(S1, S2, N) __strncasecmp_l ((S1), (S2), (N), loc)
-#  define STRTOULL(S, E, B) ____strtoull_l_internal ((S), (E), (B), 0, loc)
-# else
-#  define ISSPACE(Ch) isspace (Ch)
-#  define ISDIGIT(Ch) isdigit (Ch)
-#  define ISXDIGIT(Ch) isxdigit (Ch)
-#  define TOLOWER(Ch) tolower (Ch)
-#  define STRNCASECMP(S1, S2, N) __strncasecmp ((S1), (S2), (N))
-#  define STRTOULL(S, E, B) __strtoull_internal ((S), (E), 0, (B))
-# endif
-#endif
-
-
-/* Constants we need from float.h; select the set for the FLOAT precision.  */
-#define MANT_DIG	PASTE(FLT,_MANT_DIG)
-#define	DIG		PASTE(FLT,_DIG)
-#define	MAX_EXP		PASTE(FLT,_MAX_EXP)
-#define	MIN_EXP		PASTE(FLT,_MIN_EXP)
-#define MAX_10_EXP	PASTE(FLT,_MAX_10_EXP)
-#define MIN_10_EXP	PASTE(FLT,_MIN_10_EXP)
-
-/* Extra macros required to get FLT expanded before the pasting.  */
-#define PASTE(a,b)	PASTE1(a,b)
-#define PASTE1(a,b)	a##b
-
-/* Function to construct a floating point number from an MP integer
-   containing the fraction bits, a base 2 exponent, and a sign flag.  */
-extern FLOAT MPN2FLOAT (mp_srcptr mpn, int exponent, int negative);
-
-/* Definitions according to limb size used.  */
-#if	BITS_PER_MP_LIMB == 32
-#  define MAX_DIG_PER_LIMB	9
-#  define MAX_FAC_PER_LIMB	1000000000UL
-#elif	BITS_PER_MP_LIMB == 64
-#  define MAX_DIG_PER_LIMB	19
-#  define MAX_FAC_PER_LIMB	10000000000000000000ULL
-#else
-#  error "mp_limb_t size " BITS_PER_MP_LIMB "not accounted for"
 #endif
 
-
-/* Local data structure.  */
-static const mp_limb_t _tens_in_limb[MAX_DIG_PER_LIMB + 1] =
-{    0,                   10,                   100,
-     1000,                10000,                100000L,
-     1000000L,            10000000L,            100000000L,
-     1000000000L
-#if BITS_PER_MP_LIMB > 32
-	        ,	  10000000000ULL,       100000000000ULL,
-     1000000000000ULL,    10000000000000ULL,    100000000000000ULL,
-     1000000000000000ULL, 10000000000000000ULL, 100000000000000000ULL,
-     1000000000000000000ULL, 10000000000000000000ULL
-#endif
-#if BITS_PER_MP_LIMB > 64
-  #error "Need to expand tens_in_limb table to" MAX_DIG_PER_LIMB
-#endif
-};
-
-#ifndef	howmany
-#define	howmany(x,y)		(((x)+((y)-1))/(y))
-#endif
-#define SWAP(x, y)		({ typeof(x) _tmp = x; x = y; y = _tmp; })
-
-#define NDIG			(MAX_10_EXP - MIN_10_EXP + 2 * MANT_DIG)
-#define HEXNDIG			((MAX_EXP - MIN_EXP + 7) / 8 + 2 * MANT_DIG)
-#define	RETURN_LIMB_SIZE		howmany (MANT_DIG, BITS_PER_MP_LIMB)
-
-#define RETURN(val,end)							      \
-    do { if (endptr != NULL) *endptr = (STRING_TYPE *) (end);		      \
-	 return val; } while (0)
-
-/* Maximum size necessary for mpn integers to hold floating point numbers.  */
-#define	MPNSIZE		(howmany (MAX_EXP + 2 * MANT_DIG, BITS_PER_MP_LIMB) \
-			 + 2)
-/* Declare an mpn integer variable that big.  */
-#define	MPN_VAR(name)	mp_limb_t name[MPNSIZE]; mp_size_t name##size
-/* Copy an mpn integer value.  */
-#define MPN_ASSIGN(dst, src) \
-	memcpy (dst, src, (dst##size = src##size) * sizeof (mp_limb_t))
-
-
-/* Return a floating point number of the needed type according to the given
-   multi-precision number after possible rounding.  */
-static FLOAT
-round_and_return (mp_limb_t *retval, int exponent, int negative,
-		  mp_limb_t round_limb, mp_size_t round_bit, int more_bits)
-{
-  if (exponent < MIN_EXP - 1)
-    {
-      mp_size_t shift = MIN_EXP - 1 - exponent;
-
-      if (shift > MANT_DIG)
-	{
-	  __set_errno (EDOM);
-	  return 0.0;
-	}
-
-      more_bits |= (round_limb & ((((mp_limb_t) 1) << round_bit) - 1)) != 0;
-      if (shift == MANT_DIG)
-	/* This is a special case to handle the very seldom case where
-	   the mantissa will be empty after the shift.  */
-	{
-	  int i;
-
-	  round_limb = retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - 1];
-	  round_bit = (MANT_DIG - 1) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
-	  for (i = 0; i < RETURN_LIMB_SIZE; ++i)
-	    more_bits |= retval[i] != 0;
-	  MPN_ZERO (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE);
-	}
-      else if (shift >= BITS_PER_MP_LIMB)
-	{
-	  int i;
-
-	  round_limb = retval[(shift - 1) / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB];
-	  round_bit = (shift - 1) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
-	  for (i = 0; i < (shift - 1) / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB; ++i)
-	    more_bits |= retval[i] != 0;
-	  more_bits |= ((round_limb & ((((mp_limb_t) 1) << round_bit) - 1))
-			!= 0);
-
-	  (void) __mpn_rshift (retval, &retval[shift / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB],
-                               RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - (shift / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB),
-                               shift % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB);
-          MPN_ZERO (&retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - (shift / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB)],
-                    shift / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB);
-	}
-      else if (shift > 0)
-	{
-          round_limb = retval[0];
-          round_bit = shift - 1;
-	  (void) __mpn_rshift (retval, retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE, shift);
-	}
-      /* This is a hook for the m68k long double format, where the
-	 exponent bias is the same for normalized and denormalized
-	 numbers.  */
-#ifndef DENORM_EXP
-# define DENORM_EXP (MIN_EXP - 2)
-#endif
-      exponent = DENORM_EXP;
-    }
-
-  if ((round_limb & (((mp_limb_t) 1) << round_bit)) != 0
-      && (more_bits || (retval[0] & 1) != 0
-          || (round_limb & ((((mp_limb_t) 1) << round_bit) - 1)) != 0))
-    {
-      mp_limb_t cy = __mpn_add_1 (retval, retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE, 1);
-
-      if (((MANT_DIG % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB) == 0 && cy) ||
-          ((MANT_DIG % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB) != 0 &&
-           (retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - 1]
-            & (((mp_limb_t) 1) << (MANT_DIG % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB))) != 0))
-	{
-	  ++exponent;
-	  (void) __mpn_rshift (retval, retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE, 1);
-	  retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - 1]
-	    |= ((mp_limb_t) 1) << ((MANT_DIG - 1) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB);
-	}
-      else if (exponent == DENORM_EXP
-	       && (retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - 1]
-		   & (((mp_limb_t) 1) << ((MANT_DIG - 1) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB)))
-	       != 0)
-	  /* The number was denormalized but now normalized.  */
-	exponent = MIN_EXP - 1;
-    }
-
-  if (exponent > MAX_EXP)
-    return negative ? -FLOAT_HUGE_VAL : FLOAT_HUGE_VAL;
-
-  return MPN2FLOAT (retval, exponent, negative);
-}
-
-
-/* Read a multi-precision integer starting at STR with exactly DIGCNT digits
-   into N.  Return the size of the number limbs in NSIZE at the first
-   character od the string that is not part of the integer as the function
-   value.  If the EXPONENT is small enough to be taken as an additional
-   factor for the resulting number (see code) multiply by it.  */
-static const STRING_TYPE *
-str_to_mpn (const STRING_TYPE *str, int digcnt, mp_limb_t *n, mp_size_t *nsize,
-	    int *exponent
-#ifndef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-	    , const char *decimal, size_t decimal_len, const char *thousands
-#endif
-
-	    )
-{
-  /* Number of digits for actual limb.  */
-  int cnt = 0;
-  mp_limb_t low = 0;
-  mp_limb_t start;
-
-  *nsize = 0;
-  assert (digcnt > 0);
-  do
-    {
-      if (cnt == MAX_DIG_PER_LIMB)
-	{
-	  if (*nsize == 0)
-	    {
-	      n[0] = low;
-	      *nsize = 1;
-	    }
-	  else
-	    {
-	      mp_limb_t cy;
-	      cy = __mpn_mul_1 (n, n, *nsize, MAX_FAC_PER_LIMB);
-	      cy += __mpn_add_1 (n, n, *nsize, low);
-	      if (cy != 0)
-		{
-		  n[*nsize] = cy;
-		  ++(*nsize);
-		}
-	    }
-	  cnt = 0;
-	  low = 0;
-	}
-
-      /* There might be thousands separators or radix characters in
-	 the string.  But these all can be ignored because we know the
-	 format of the number is correct and we have an exact number
-	 of characters to read.  */
-#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-      if (*str < L'0' || *str > L'9')
-	++str;
-#else
-      if (*str < '0' || *str > '9')
-	{
-	  int inner = 0;
-	  if (thousands != NULL && *str == *thousands
-	      && ({ for (inner = 1; thousands[inner] != '\0'; ++inner)
-		      if (thousands[inner] != str[inner])
-			break;
-		    thousands[inner] == '\0'; }))
-	    str += inner;
-	  else
-	    str += decimal_len;
-	}
-#endif
-      low = low * 10 + *str++ - L_('0');
-      ++cnt;
-    }
-  while (--digcnt > 0);
-
-  if (*exponent > 0 && cnt + *exponent <= MAX_DIG_PER_LIMB)
-    {
-      low *= _tens_in_limb[*exponent];
-      start = _tens_in_limb[cnt + *exponent];
-      *exponent = 0;
-    }
-  else
-    start = _tens_in_limb[cnt];
-
-  if (*nsize == 0)
-    {
-      n[0] = low;
-      *nsize = 1;
-    }
-  else
-    {
-      mp_limb_t cy;
-      cy = __mpn_mul_1 (n, n, *nsize, start);
-      cy += __mpn_add_1 (n, n, *nsize, low);
-      if (cy != 0)
-	n[(*nsize)++] = cy;
-    }
-
-  return str;
-}
-
-
-/* Shift {PTR, SIZE} COUNT bits to the left, and fill the vacated bits
-   with the COUNT most significant bits of LIMB.
-
-   Tege doesn't like this function so I have to write it here myself. :)
-   --drepper */
-static inline void
-__attribute ((always_inline))
-__mpn_lshift_1 (mp_limb_t *ptr, mp_size_t size, unsigned int count,
-		mp_limb_t limb)
-{
-  if (__builtin_constant_p (count) && count == BITS_PER_MP_LIMB)
-    {
-      /* Optimize the case of shifting by exactly a word:
-	 just copy words, with no actual bit-shifting.  */
-      mp_size_t i;
-      for (i = size - 1; i > 0; --i)
-	ptr[i] = ptr[i - 1];
-      ptr[0] = limb;
-    }
-  else
-    {
-      (void) __mpn_lshift (ptr, ptr, size, count);
-      ptr[0] |= limb >> (BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - count);
-    }
-}
-
-
 #define INTERNAL(x) INTERNAL1(x)
 #define INTERNAL1(x) __##x##_internal
 
-/* This file defines a function to check for correct grouping.  */
-#include "grouping.h"
 
-
-/* Return a floating point number with the value of the given string NPTR.
-   Set *ENDPTR to the character after the last used one.  If the number is
-   smaller than the smallest representable number, set `errno' to ERANGE and
-   return 0.0.  If the number is too big to be represented, set `errno' to
-   ERANGE and return HUGE_VAL with the appropriate sign.  */
 FLOAT
-INTERNAL (STRTOF) (nptr, endptr, group LOCALE_PARAM)
+INTERNAL (STRTOF) (nptr, endptr, group)
      const STRING_TYPE *nptr;
      STRING_TYPE **endptr;
      int group;
-     LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
 {
-  int negative;			/* The sign of the number.  */
-  MPN_VAR (num);		/* MP representation of the number.  */
-  int exponent;			/* Exponent of the number.  */
-
-  /* Numbers starting `0X' or `0x' have to be processed with base 16.  */
-  int base = 10;
-
-  /* When we have to compute fractional digits we form a fraction with a
-     second multi-precision number (and we sometimes need a second for
-     temporary results).  */
-  MPN_VAR (den);
-
-  /* Representation for the return value.  */
-  mp_limb_t retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE];
-  /* Number of bits currently in result value.  */
-  int bits;
-
-  /* Running pointer after the last character processed in the string.  */
-  const STRING_TYPE *cp, *tp;
-  /* Start of significant part of the number.  */
-  const STRING_TYPE *startp, *start_of_digits;
-  /* Points at the character following the integer and fractional digits.  */
-  const STRING_TYPE *expp;
-  /* Total number of digit and number of digits in integer part.  */
-  int dig_no, int_no, lead_zero;
-  /* Contains the last character read.  */
-  CHAR_TYPE c;
-
-/* We should get wint_t from <stddef.h>, but not all GCC versions define it
-   there.  So define it ourselves if it remains undefined.  */
-#ifndef _WINT_T
-  typedef unsigned int wint_t;
-#endif
-  /* The radix character of the current locale.  */
-#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-  wchar_t decimal;
-#else
-  const char *decimal;
-  size_t decimal_len;
-#endif
-  /* The thousands character of the current locale.  */
-#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-  wchar_t thousands = L'\0';
-#else
-  const char *thousands = NULL;
-#endif
-  /* The numeric grouping specification of the current locale,
-     in the format described in <locale.h>.  */
-  const char *grouping;
-  /* Used in several places.  */
-  int cnt;
-
-#ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-  struct locale_data *current = loc->__locales[LC_NUMERIC];
-#endif
-
-  if (group)
-    {
-      grouping = _NL_CURRENT (LC_NUMERIC, GROUPING);
-      if (*grouping <= 0 || *grouping == CHAR_MAX)
-	grouping = NULL;
-      else
-	{
-	  /* Figure out the thousands separator character.  */
-#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-	  thousands = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_NUMERIC,
-					_NL_NUMERIC_THOUSANDS_SEP_WC);
-	  if (thousands == L'\0')
-	    grouping = NULL;
-#else
-	  thousands = _NL_CURRENT (LC_NUMERIC, THOUSANDS_SEP);
-	  if (*thousands == '\0')
-	    {
-	      thousands = NULL;
-	      grouping = NULL;
-	    }
-#endif
-	}
-    }
-  else
-    grouping = NULL;
-
-  /* Find the locale's decimal point character.  */
-#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-  decimal = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_NUMERIC, _NL_NUMERIC_DECIMAL_POINT_WC);
-  assert (decimal != L'\0');
-# define decimal_len 1
-#else
-  decimal = _NL_CURRENT (LC_NUMERIC, DECIMAL_POINT);
-  decimal_len = strlen (decimal);
-  assert (decimal_len > 0);
-#endif
-
-  /* Prepare number representation.  */
-  exponent = 0;
-  negative = 0;
-  bits = 0;
-
-  /* Parse string to get maximal legal prefix.  We need the number of
-     characters of the integer part, the fractional part and the exponent.  */
-  cp = nptr - 1;
-  /* Ignore leading white space.  */
-  do
-    c = *++cp;
-  while (ISSPACE (c));
-
-  /* Get sign of the result.  */
-  if (c == L_('-'))
-    {
-      negative = 1;
-      c = *++cp;
-    }
-  else if (c == L_('+'))
-    c = *++cp;
-
-  /* Return 0.0 if no legal string is found.
-     No character is used even if a sign was found.  */
-#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-  if (c == (wint_t) decimal
-      && (wint_t) cp[1] >= L'0' && (wint_t) cp[1] <= L'9')
-    {
-      /* We accept it.  This funny construct is here only to indent
-	 the code directly.  */
-    }
-#else
-  for (cnt = 0; decimal[cnt] != '\0'; ++cnt)
-    if (cp[cnt] != decimal[cnt])
-      break;
-  if (decimal[cnt] == '\0' && cp[cnt] >= '0' && cp[cnt] <= '9')
-    {
-      /* We accept it.  This funny construct is here only to indent
-	 the code directly.  */
-    }
-#endif
-  else if (c < L_('0') || c > L_('9'))
-    {
-      /* Check for `INF' or `INFINITY'.  */
-      if (TOLOWER (c) == L_('i') && STRNCASECMP (cp, L_("inf"), 3) == 0)
-	{
-	  /* Return +/- infinity.  */
-	  if (endptr != NULL)
-	    *endptr = (STRING_TYPE *)
-		      (cp + (STRNCASECMP (cp + 3, L_("inity"), 5) == 0
-			     ? 8 : 3));
-
-	  return negative ? -FLOAT_HUGE_VAL : FLOAT_HUGE_VAL;
-	}
-
-      if (TOLOWER (c) == L_('n') && STRNCASECMP (cp, L_("nan"), 3) == 0)
-	{
-	  /* Return NaN.  */
-	  FLOAT retval = NAN;
-
-	  cp += 3;
-
-	  /* Match `(n-char-sequence-digit)'.  */
-	  if (*cp == L_('('))
-	    {
-	      const STRING_TYPE *startp = cp;
-	      do
-		++cp;
-	      while ((*cp >= L_('0') && *cp <= L_('9'))
-		     || (TOLOWER (*cp) >= L_('a') && TOLOWER (*cp) <= L_('z'))
-		     || *cp == L_('_'));
-
-	      if (*cp != L_(')'))
-		/* The closing brace is missing.  Only match the NAN
-		   part.  */
-		cp = startp;
-	      else
-		{
-		  /* This is a system-dependent way to specify the
-		     bitmask used for the NaN.  We expect it to be
-		     a number which is put in the mantissa of the
-		     number.  */
-		  STRING_TYPE *endp;
-		  unsigned long long int mant;
-
-		  mant = STRTOULL (startp + 1, &endp, 0);
-		  if (endp == cp)
-		    SET_MANTISSA (retval, mant);
-		}
-	    }
-
-	  if (endptr != NULL)
-	    *endptr = (STRING_TYPE *) cp;
-
-	  return retval;
-	}
-
-      /* It is really a text we do not recognize.  */
-      RETURN (0.0, nptr);
-    }
-
-  /* First look whether we are faced with a hexadecimal number.  */
-  if (c == L_('0') && TOLOWER (cp[1]) == L_('x'))
-    {
-      /* Okay, it is a hexa-decimal number.  Remember this and skip
-	 the characters.  BTW: hexadecimal numbers must not be
-	 grouped.  */
-      base = 16;
-      cp += 2;
-      c = *cp;
-      grouping = NULL;
-    }
-
-  /* Record the start of the digits, in case we will check their grouping.  */
-  start_of_digits = startp = cp;
-
-  /* Ignore leading zeroes.  This helps us to avoid useless computations.  */
-#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-  while (c == L'0' || ((wint_t) thousands != L'\0' && c == (wint_t) thousands))
-    c = *++cp;
-#else
-  if (thousands == NULL)
-    while (c == '0')
-      c = *++cp;
-  else
-    {
-      /* We also have the multibyte thousands string.  */
-      while (1)
-	{
-	  if (c != '0')
-	    {
-	      for (cnt = 0; thousands[cnt] != '\0'; ++cnt)
-		if (c != thousands[cnt])
-		  break;
-	      if (thousands[cnt] != '\0')
-		break;
-	    }
-	  c = *++cp;
-	}
-    }
-#endif
-
-  /* If no other digit but a '0' is found the result is 0.0.
-     Return current read pointer.  */
-  if ((c < L_('0') || c > L_('9'))
-      && (base == 16 && (c < (CHAR_TYPE) TOLOWER (L_('a'))
-			 || c > (CHAR_TYPE) TOLOWER (L_('f'))))
-#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-      && c != (wint_t) decimal
-#else
-      && ({ for (cnt = 0; decimal[cnt] != '\0'; ++cnt)
-	      if (decimal[cnt] != cp[cnt])
-		break;
-	    decimal[cnt] != '\0'; })
-#endif
-      && (base == 16 && (cp == start_of_digits
-			 || (CHAR_TYPE) TOLOWER (c) != L_('p')))
-      && (base != 16 && (CHAR_TYPE) TOLOWER (c) != L_('e')))
-    {
-#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-      tp = __correctly_grouped_prefixwc (start_of_digits, cp, thousands,
-					 grouping);
-#else
-      tp = __correctly_grouped_prefixmb (start_of_digits, cp, thousands,
-					 grouping);
-#endif
-      /* If TP is at the start of the digits, there was no correctly
-	 grouped prefix of the string; so no number found.  */
-      RETURN (0.0, tp == start_of_digits ? (base == 16 ? cp - 1 : nptr) : tp);
-    }
-
-  /* Remember first significant digit and read following characters until the
-     decimal point, exponent character or any non-FP number character.  */
-  startp = cp;
-  dig_no = 0;
-  while (1)
-    {
-      if ((c >= L_('0') && c <= L_('9'))
-	  || (base == 16 && (wint_t) TOLOWER (c) >= L_('a')
-	      && (wint_t) TOLOWER (c) <= L_('f')))
-	++dig_no;
-      else
-	{
-#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-	  if ((wint_t) thousands == L'\0' || c != (wint_t) thousands)
-	    /* Not a digit or separator: end of the integer part.  */
-	    break;
-#else
-	  if (thousands == NULL)
-	    break;
-	  else
-	    {
-	      for (cnt = 0; thousands[cnt] != '\0'; ++cnt)
-		if (thousands[cnt] != cp[cnt])
-		  break;
-	      if (thousands[cnt] != '\0')
-		break;
-	    }
-#endif
-	}
-      c = *++cp;
-    }
-
-  if (grouping && dig_no > 0)
-    {
-      /* Check the grouping of the digits.  */
-#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-      tp = __correctly_grouped_prefixwc (start_of_digits, cp, thousands,
-					 grouping);
-#else
-      tp = __correctly_grouped_prefixmb (start_of_digits, cp, thousands,
-					 grouping);
-#endif
-      if (cp != tp)
-        {
-	  /* Less than the entire string was correctly grouped.  */
-
-	  if (tp == start_of_digits)
-	    /* No valid group of numbers at all: no valid number.  */
-	    RETURN (0.0, nptr);
-
-	  if (tp < startp)
-	    /* The number is validly grouped, but consists
-	       only of zeroes.  The whole value is zero.  */
-	    RETURN (0.0, tp);
-
-	  /* Recompute DIG_NO so we won't read more digits than
-	     are properly grouped.  */
-	  cp = tp;
-	  dig_no = 0;
-	  for (tp = startp; tp < cp; ++tp)
-	    if (*tp >= L_('0') && *tp <= L_('9'))
-	      ++dig_no;
-
-	  int_no = dig_no;
-	  lead_zero = 0;
-
-	  goto number_parsed;
-	}
-    }
-
-  /* We have the number digits in the integer part.  Whether these are all or
-     any is really a fractional digit will be decided later.  */
-  int_no = dig_no;
-  lead_zero = int_no == 0 ? -1 : 0;
-
-  /* Read the fractional digits.  A special case are the 'american style'
-     numbers like `16.' i.e. with decimal but without trailing digits.  */
-  if (
-#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-      c == (wint_t) decimal
-#else
-      ({ for (cnt = 0; decimal[cnt] != '\0'; ++cnt)
-	   if (decimal[cnt] != cp[cnt])
-	     break;
-	 decimal[cnt] == '\0'; })
-#endif
-      )
-    {
-      cp += decimal_len;
-      c = *cp;
-      while ((c >= L_('0') && c <= L_('9')) ||
-	     (base == 16 && TOLOWER (c) >= L_('a') && TOLOWER (c) <= L_('f')))
-	{
-	  if (c != L_('0') && lead_zero == -1)
-	    lead_zero = dig_no - int_no;
-	  ++dig_no;
-	  c = *++cp;
-	}
-    }
-
-  /* Remember start of exponent (if any).  */
-  expp = cp;
-
-  /* Read exponent.  */
-  if ((base == 16 && TOLOWER (c) == L_('p'))
-      || (base != 16 && TOLOWER (c) == L_('e')))
-    {
-      int exp_negative = 0;
-
-      c = *++cp;
-      if (c == L_('-'))
-	{
-	  exp_negative = 1;
-	  c = *++cp;
-	}
-      else if (c == L_('+'))
-	c = *++cp;
-
-      if (c >= L_('0') && c <= L_('9'))
-	{
-	  int exp_limit;
-
-	  /* Get the exponent limit. */
-	  if (base == 16)
-	    exp_limit = (exp_negative ?
-			 -MIN_EXP + MANT_DIG + 4 * int_no :
-			 MAX_EXP - 4 * int_no + lead_zero);
-	  else
-	    exp_limit = (exp_negative ?
-			 -MIN_10_EXP + MANT_DIG + int_no :
-			 MAX_10_EXP - int_no + lead_zero);
-
-	  do
-	    {
-	      exponent *= 10;
-
-	      if (exponent > exp_limit)
-		/* The exponent is too large/small to represent a valid
-		   number.  */
-		{
-	 	  FLOAT result;
-
-		  /* We have to take care for special situation: a joker
-		     might have written "0.0e100000" which is in fact
-		     zero.  */
-		  if (lead_zero == -1)
-		    result = negative ? -0.0 : 0.0;
-		  else
-		    {
-		      /* Overflow or underflow.  */
-		      __set_errno (ERANGE);
-		      result = (exp_negative ? 0.0 :
-				negative ? -FLOAT_HUGE_VAL : FLOAT_HUGE_VAL);
-		    }
-
-		  /* Accept all following digits as part of the exponent.  */
-		  do
-		    ++cp;
-		  while (*cp >= L_('0') && *cp <= L_('9'));
-
-		  RETURN (result, cp);
-		  /* NOTREACHED */
-		}
-
-	      exponent += c - L_('0');
-	      c = *++cp;
-	    }
-	  while (c >= L_('0') && c <= L_('9'));
-
-	  if (exp_negative)
-	    exponent = -exponent;
-	}
-      else
-	cp = expp;
-    }
-
-  /* We don't want to have to work with trailing zeroes after the radix.  */
-  if (dig_no > int_no)
-    {
-      while (expp[-1] == L_('0'))
-	{
-	  --expp;
-	  --dig_no;
-	}
-      assert (dig_no >= int_no);
-    }
-
-  if (dig_no == int_no && dig_no > 0 && exponent < 0)
-    do
-      {
-	while (! (base == 16 ? ISXDIGIT (expp[-1]) : ISDIGIT (expp[-1])))
-	  --expp;
-
-	if (expp[-1] != L_('0'))
-	  break;
-
-	--expp;
-	--dig_no;
-	--int_no;
-	++exponent;
-      }
-    while (dig_no > 0 && exponent < 0);
-
- number_parsed:
-
-  /* The whole string is parsed.  Store the address of the next character.  */
-  if (endptr)
-    *endptr = (STRING_TYPE *) cp;
-
-  if (dig_no == 0)
-    return negative ? -0.0 : 0.0;
-
-  if (lead_zero)
-    {
-      /* Find the decimal point */
-#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-      while (*startp != decimal)
-	++startp;
-#else
-      while (1)
-	{
-	  if (*startp == decimal[0])
-	    {
-	      for (cnt = 1; decimal[cnt] != '\0'; ++cnt)
-		if (decimal[cnt] != startp[cnt])
-		  break;
-	      if (decimal[cnt] == '\0')
-		break;
-	    }
-	  ++startp;
-	}
-#endif
-      startp += lead_zero + decimal_len;
-      exponent -= base == 16 ? 4 * lead_zero : lead_zero;
-      dig_no -= lead_zero;
-    }
-
-  /* If the BASE is 16 we can use a simpler algorithm.  */
-  if (base == 16)
-    {
-      static const int nbits[16] = { 0, 1, 2, 2, 3, 3, 3, 3,
-				     4, 4, 4, 4, 4, 4, 4, 4 };
-      int idx = (MANT_DIG - 1) / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
-      int pos = (MANT_DIG - 1) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
-      mp_limb_t val;
-
-      while (!ISXDIGIT (*startp))
-	++startp;
-      while (*startp == L_('0'))
-	++startp;
-      if (ISDIGIT (*startp))
-	val = *startp++ - L_('0');
-      else
-	val = 10 + TOLOWER (*startp++) - L_('a');
-      bits = nbits[val];
-      /* We cannot have a leading zero.  */
-      assert (bits != 0);
-
-      if (pos + 1 >= 4 || pos + 1 >= bits)
-	{
-	  /* We don't have to care for wrapping.  This is the normal
-	     case so we add the first clause in the `if' expression as
-	     an optimization.  It is a compile-time constant and so does
-	     not cost anything.  */
-	  retval[idx] = val << (pos - bits + 1);
-	  pos -= bits;
-	}
-      else
-	{
-	  retval[idx--] = val >> (bits - pos - 1);
-	  retval[idx] = val << (BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - (bits - pos - 1));
-	  pos = BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - 1 - (bits - pos - 1);
-	}
-
-      /* Adjust the exponent for the bits we are shifting in.  */
-      exponent += bits - 1 + (int_no - 1) * 4;
-
-      while (--dig_no > 0 && idx >= 0)
-	{
-	  if (!ISXDIGIT (*startp))
-	    startp += decimal_len;
-	  if (ISDIGIT (*startp))
-	    val = *startp++ - L_('0');
-	  else
-	    val = 10 + TOLOWER (*startp++) - L_('a');
-
-	  if (pos + 1 >= 4)
-	    {
-	      retval[idx] |= val << (pos - 4 + 1);
-	      pos -= 4;
-	    }
-	  else
-	    {
-	      retval[idx--] |= val >> (4 - pos - 1);
-	      val <<= BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - (4 - pos - 1);
-	      if (idx < 0)
-		return round_and_return (retval, exponent, negative, val,
-					 BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - 1, dig_no > 0);
-
-	      retval[idx] = val;
-	      pos = BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - 1 - (4 - pos - 1);
-	    }
-	}
-
-      /* We ran out of digits.  */
-      MPN_ZERO (retval, idx);
-
-      return round_and_return (retval, exponent, negative, 0, 0, 0);
-    }
-
-  /* Now we have the number of digits in total and the integer digits as well
-     as the exponent and its sign.  We can decide whether the read digits are
-     really integer digits or belong to the fractional part; i.e. we normalize
-     123e-2 to 1.23.  */
-  {
-    register int incr = (exponent < 0 ? MAX (-int_no, exponent)
-			 : MIN (dig_no - int_no, exponent));
-    int_no += incr;
-    exponent -= incr;
-  }
-
-  if (int_no + exponent > MAX_10_EXP + 1)
-    {
-      __set_errno (ERANGE);
-      return negative ? -FLOAT_HUGE_VAL : FLOAT_HUGE_VAL;
-    }
-
-  if (exponent < MIN_10_EXP - (DIG + 1))
-    {
-      __set_errno (ERANGE);
-      return 0.0;
-    }
-
-  if (int_no > 0)
-    {
-      /* Read the integer part as a multi-precision number to NUM.  */
-      startp = str_to_mpn (startp, int_no, num, &numsize, &exponent
-#ifndef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-			   , decimal, decimal_len, thousands
-#endif
-			   );
-
-      if (exponent > 0)
-	{
-	  /* We now multiply the gained number by the given power of ten.  */
-	  mp_limb_t *psrc = num;
-	  mp_limb_t *pdest = den;
-	  int expbit = 1;
-	  const struct mp_power *ttab = &_fpioconst_pow10[0];
-
-	  do
-	    {
-	      if ((exponent & expbit) != 0)
-		{
-		  size_t size = ttab->arraysize - _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET;
-		  mp_limb_t cy;
-		  exponent ^= expbit;
-
-		  /* FIXME: not the whole multiplication has to be
-		     done.  If we have the needed number of bits we
-		     only need the information whether more non-zero
-		     bits follow.  */
-		  if (numsize >= ttab->arraysize - _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET)
-		    cy = __mpn_mul (pdest, psrc, numsize,
-				    &__tens[ttab->arrayoff
-					   + _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET],
-				    size);
-		  else
-		    cy = __mpn_mul (pdest, &__tens[ttab->arrayoff
-						  + _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET],
-				    size, psrc, numsize);
-		  numsize += size;
-		  if (cy == 0)
-		    --numsize;
-		  (void) SWAP (psrc, pdest);
-		}
-	      expbit <<= 1;
-	      ++ttab;
-	    }
-	  while (exponent != 0);
-
-	  if (psrc == den)
-	    memcpy (num, den, numsize * sizeof (mp_limb_t));
-	}
-
-      /* Determine how many bits of the result we already have.  */
-      count_leading_zeros (bits, num[numsize - 1]);
-      bits = numsize * BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - bits;
-
-      /* Now we know the exponent of the number in base two.
-	 Check it against the maximum possible exponent.  */
-      if (bits > MAX_EXP)
-	{
-	  __set_errno (ERANGE);
-	  return negative ? -FLOAT_HUGE_VAL : FLOAT_HUGE_VAL;
-	}
-
-      /* We have already the first BITS bits of the result.  Together with
-	 the information whether more non-zero bits follow this is enough
-	 to determine the result.  */
-      if (bits > MANT_DIG)
-	{
-	  int i;
-	  const mp_size_t least_idx = (bits - MANT_DIG) / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
-	  const mp_size_t least_bit = (bits - MANT_DIG) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
-	  const mp_size_t round_idx = least_bit == 0 ? least_idx - 1
-						     : least_idx;
-	  const mp_size_t round_bit = least_bit == 0 ? BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - 1
-						     : least_bit - 1;
-
-	  if (least_bit == 0)
-	    memcpy (retval, &num[least_idx],
-		    RETURN_LIMB_SIZE * sizeof (mp_limb_t));
-	  else
-            {
-              for (i = least_idx; i < numsize - 1; ++i)
-                retval[i - least_idx] = (num[i] >> least_bit)
-                                        | (num[i + 1]
-                                           << (BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - least_bit));
-              if (i - least_idx < RETURN_LIMB_SIZE)
-                retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - 1] = num[i] >> least_bit;
-            }
-
-	  /* Check whether any limb beside the ones in RETVAL are non-zero.  */
-	  for (i = 0; num[i] == 0; ++i)
-	    ;
-
-	  return round_and_return (retval, bits - 1, negative,
-				   num[round_idx], round_bit,
-				   int_no < dig_no || i < round_idx);
-	  /* NOTREACHED */
-	}
-      else if (dig_no == int_no)
-	{
-	  const mp_size_t target_bit = (MANT_DIG - 1) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
-	  const mp_size_t is_bit = (bits - 1) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
-
-	  if (target_bit == is_bit)
-	    {
-	      memcpy (&retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - numsize], num,
-		      numsize * sizeof (mp_limb_t));
-	      /* FIXME: the following loop can be avoided if we assume a
-		 maximal MANT_DIG value.  */
-	      MPN_ZERO (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - numsize);
-	    }
-	  else if (target_bit > is_bit)
-	    {
-	      (void) __mpn_lshift (&retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - numsize],
-				   num, numsize, target_bit - is_bit);
-	      /* FIXME: the following loop can be avoided if we assume a
-		 maximal MANT_DIG value.  */
-	      MPN_ZERO (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - numsize);
-	    }
-	  else
-	    {
-	      mp_limb_t cy;
-	      assert (numsize < RETURN_LIMB_SIZE);
-
-	      cy = __mpn_rshift (&retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - numsize],
-				 num, numsize, is_bit - target_bit);
-	      retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - numsize - 1] = cy;
-	      /* FIXME: the following loop can be avoided if we assume a
-		 maximal MANT_DIG value.  */
-	      MPN_ZERO (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - numsize - 1);
-	    }
-
-	  return round_and_return (retval, bits - 1, negative, 0, 0, 0);
-	  /* NOTREACHED */
-	}
-
-      /* Store the bits we already have.  */
-      memcpy (retval, num, numsize * sizeof (mp_limb_t));
-#if RETURN_LIMB_SIZE > 1
-      if (numsize < RETURN_LIMB_SIZE)
-        retval[numsize] = 0;
-#endif
-    }
-
-  /* We have to compute at least some of the fractional digits.  */
-  {
-    /* We construct a fraction and the result of the division gives us
-       the needed digits.  The denominator is 1.0 multiplied by the
-       exponent of the lowest digit; i.e. 0.123 gives 123 / 1000 and
-       123e-6 gives 123 / 1000000.  */
-
-    int expbit;
-    int neg_exp;
-    int more_bits;
-    mp_limb_t cy;
-    mp_limb_t *psrc = den;
-    mp_limb_t *pdest = num;
-    const struct mp_power *ttab = &_fpioconst_pow10[0];
-
-    assert (dig_no > int_no && exponent <= 0);
-
-
-    /* For the fractional part we need not process too many digits.  One
-       decimal digits gives us log_2(10) ~ 3.32 bits.  If we now compute
-                        ceil(BITS / 3) =: N
-       digits we should have enough bits for the result.  The remaining
-       decimal digits give us the information that more bits are following.
-       This can be used while rounding.  (Two added as a safety margin.)  */
-    if (dig_no - int_no > (MANT_DIG - bits + 2) / 3 + 2)
-      {
-        dig_no = int_no + (MANT_DIG - bits + 2) / 3 + 2;
-        more_bits = 1;
-      }
-    else
-      more_bits = 0;
-
-    neg_exp = dig_no - int_no - exponent;
-
-    /* Construct the denominator.  */
-    densize = 0;
-    expbit = 1;
-    do
-      {
-	if ((neg_exp & expbit) != 0)
-	  {
-	    mp_limb_t cy;
-	    neg_exp ^= expbit;
-
-	    if (densize == 0)
-	      {
-		densize = ttab->arraysize - _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET;
-		memcpy (psrc, &__tens[ttab->arrayoff + _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET],
-			densize * sizeof (mp_limb_t));
-	      }
-	    else
-	      {
-		cy = __mpn_mul (pdest, &__tens[ttab->arrayoff
-					      + _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET],
-				ttab->arraysize - _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET,
-				psrc, densize);
-		densize += ttab->arraysize - _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET;
-		if (cy == 0)
-		  --densize;
-		(void) SWAP (psrc, pdest);
-	      }
-	  }
-	expbit <<= 1;
-	++ttab;
-      }
-    while (neg_exp != 0);
-
-    if (psrc == num)
-      memcpy (den, num, densize * sizeof (mp_limb_t));
-
-    /* Read the fractional digits from the string.  */
-    (void) str_to_mpn (startp, dig_no - int_no, num, &numsize, &exponent
-#ifndef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-		       , decimal, decimal_len, thousands
-#endif
-		       );
-
-    /* We now have to shift both numbers so that the highest bit in the
-       denominator is set.  In the same process we copy the numerator to
-       a high place in the array so that the division constructs the wanted
-       digits.  This is done by a "quasi fix point" number representation.
-
-       num:   ddddddddddd . 0000000000000000000000
-              |--- m ---|
-       den:                            ddddddddddd      n >= m
-                                       |--- n ---|
-     */
-
-    count_leading_zeros (cnt, den[densize - 1]);
-
-    if (cnt > 0)
-      {
-	/* Don't call `mpn_shift' with a count of zero since the specification
-	   does not allow this.  */
-	(void) __mpn_lshift (den, den, densize, cnt);
-	cy = __mpn_lshift (num, num, numsize, cnt);
-	if (cy != 0)
-	  num[numsize++] = cy;
-      }
-
-    /* Now we are ready for the division.  But it is not necessary to
-       do a full multi-precision division because we only need a small
-       number of bits for the result.  So we do not use __mpn_divmod
-       here but instead do the division here by hand and stop whenever
-       the needed number of bits is reached.  The code itself comes
-       from the GNU MP Library by Torbj\"orn Granlund.  */
-
-    exponent = bits;
-
-    switch (densize)
-      {
-      case 1:
-	{
-	  mp_limb_t d, n, quot;
-	  int used = 0;
-
-	  n = num[0];
-	  d = den[0];
-	  assert (numsize == 1 && n < d);
-
-	  do
-	    {
-	      udiv_qrnnd (quot, n, n, 0, d);
-
-#define got_limb							      \
-	      if (bits == 0)						      \
-		{							      \
-		  register int cnt;					      \
-		  if (quot == 0)					      \
-		    cnt = BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;				      \
-		  else							      \
-		    count_leading_zeros (cnt, quot);			      \
-		  exponent -= cnt;					      \
-		  if (BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - cnt > MANT_DIG)		      \
-		    {							      \
-		      used = MANT_DIG + cnt;				      \
-		      retval[0] = quot >> (BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - used);	      \
-		      bits = MANT_DIG + 1;				      \
-		    }							      \
-		  else							      \
-		    {							      \
-		      /* Note that we only clear the second element.  */      \
-		      /* The conditional is determined at compile time.  */   \
-		      if (RETURN_LIMB_SIZE > 1)				      \
-			retval[1] = 0;					      \
-		      retval[0] = quot;					      \
-		      bits = -cnt;					      \
-		    }							      \
-		}							      \
-	      else if (bits + BITS_PER_MP_LIMB <= MANT_DIG)		      \
-		__mpn_lshift_1 (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE, BITS_PER_MP_LIMB,   \
-				quot);					      \
-	      else							      \
-		{							      \
-		  used = MANT_DIG - bits;				      \
-		  if (used > 0)						      \
-		    __mpn_lshift_1 (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE, used, quot);    \
-		}							      \
-	      bits += BITS_PER_MP_LIMB
-
-	      got_limb;
-	    }
-	  while (bits <= MANT_DIG);
-
-	  return round_and_return (retval, exponent - 1, negative,
-				   quot, BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - 1 - used,
-				   more_bits || n != 0);
-	}
-      case 2:
-	{
-	  mp_limb_t d0, d1, n0, n1;
-	  mp_limb_t quot = 0;
-	  int used = 0;
-
-	  d0 = den[0];
-	  d1 = den[1];
-
-	  if (numsize < densize)
-	    {
-	      if (num[0] >= d1)
-		{
-		  /* The numerator of the number occupies fewer bits than
-		     the denominator but the one limb is bigger than the
-		     high limb of the numerator.  */
-		  n1 = 0;
-		  n0 = num[0];
-		}
-	      else
-		{
-		  if (bits <= 0)
-		    exponent -= BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
-		  else
-		    {
-		      if (bits + BITS_PER_MP_LIMB <= MANT_DIG)
-			__mpn_lshift_1 (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE,
-					BITS_PER_MP_LIMB, 0);
-		      else
-			{
-			  used = MANT_DIG - bits;
-			  if (used > 0)
-			    __mpn_lshift_1 (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE, used, 0);
-			}
-		      bits += BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
-		    }
-		  n1 = num[0];
-		  n0 = 0;
-		}
-	    }
-	  else
-	    {
-	      n1 = num[1];
-	      n0 = num[0];
-	    }
-
-	  while (bits <= MANT_DIG)
-	    {
-	      mp_limb_t r;
-
-	      if (n1 == d1)
-		{
-		  /* QUOT should be either 111..111 or 111..110.  We need
-		     special treatment of this rare case as normal division
-		     would give overflow.  */
-		  quot = ~(mp_limb_t) 0;
-
-		  r = n0 + d1;
-		  if (r < d1)	/* Carry in the addition?  */
-		    {
-		      add_ssaaaa (n1, n0, r - d0, 0, 0, d0);
-		      goto have_quot;
-		    }
-		  n1 = d0 - (d0 != 0);
-		  n0 = -d0;
-		}
-	      else
-		{
-		  udiv_qrnnd (quot, r, n1, n0, d1);
-		  umul_ppmm (n1, n0, d0, quot);
-		}
-
-	    q_test:
-	      if (n1 > r || (n1 == r && n0 > 0))
-		{
-		  /* The estimated QUOT was too large.  */
-		  --quot;
-
-		  sub_ddmmss (n1, n0, n1, n0, 0, d0);
-		  r += d1;
-		  if (r >= d1)	/* If not carry, test QUOT again.  */
-		    goto q_test;
-		}
-	      sub_ddmmss (n1, n0, r, 0, n1, n0);
-
-	    have_quot:
-	      got_limb;
-	    }
-
-	  return round_and_return (retval, exponent - 1, negative,
-				   quot, BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - 1 - used,
-				   more_bits || n1 != 0 || n0 != 0);
-	}
-      default:
-	{
-	  int i;
-	  mp_limb_t cy, dX, d1, n0, n1;
-	  mp_limb_t quot = 0;
-	  int used = 0;
-
-	  dX = den[densize - 1];
-	  d1 = den[densize - 2];
-
-	  /* The division does not work if the upper limb of the two-limb
-	     numerator is greater than the denominator.  */
-	  if (__mpn_cmp (num, &den[densize - numsize], numsize) > 0)
-	    num[numsize++] = 0;
-
-	  if (numsize < densize)
-	    {
-	      mp_size_t empty = densize - numsize;
-
-	      if (bits <= 0)
-		{
-		  register int i;
-		  for (i = numsize; i > 0; --i)
-		    num[i + empty] = num[i - 1];
-		  MPN_ZERO (num, empty + 1);
-		  exponent -= empty * BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
-		}
-	      else
-		{
-		  if (bits + empty * BITS_PER_MP_LIMB <= MANT_DIG)
-		    {
-		      /* We make a difference here because the compiler
-			 cannot optimize the `else' case that good and
-			 this reflects all currently used FLOAT types
-			 and GMP implementations.  */
-		      register int i;
-#if RETURN_LIMB_SIZE <= 2
-		      assert (empty == 1);
-		      __mpn_lshift_1 (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE,
-				      BITS_PER_MP_LIMB, 0);
-#else
-		      for (i = RETURN_LIMB_SIZE; i > empty; --i)
-			retval[i] = retval[i - empty];
-#endif
-		      for (i = numsize; i > 0; --i)
-			num[i + empty] = num[i - 1];
-		      MPN_ZERO (num, empty + 1);
-		    }
-		  else
-		    {
-		      used = MANT_DIG - bits;
-		      if (used >= BITS_PER_MP_LIMB)
-			{
-			  register int i;
-			  (void) __mpn_lshift (&retval[used
-						       / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB],
-					       retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE,
-					       used % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB);
-			  for (i = used / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB; i >= 0; --i)
-			    retval[i] = 0;
-			}
-		      else if (used > 0)
-			__mpn_lshift_1 (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE, used, 0);
-		    }
-		  bits += empty * BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
-		}
-	    }
-	  else
-	    {
-	      int i;
-	      assert (numsize == densize);
-	      for (i = numsize; i > 0; --i)
-		num[i] = num[i - 1];
-	    }
-
-	  den[densize] = 0;
-	  n0 = num[densize];
-
-	  while (bits <= MANT_DIG)
-	    {
-	      if (n0 == dX)
-		/* This might over-estimate QUOT, but it's probably not
-		   worth the extra code here to find out.  */
-		quot = ~(mp_limb_t) 0;
-	      else
-		{
-		  mp_limb_t r;
-
-		  udiv_qrnnd (quot, r, n0, num[densize - 1], dX);
-		  umul_ppmm (n1, n0, d1, quot);
-
-		  while (n1 > r || (n1 == r && n0 > num[densize - 2]))
-		    {
-		      --quot;
-		      r += dX;
-		      if (r < dX) /* I.e. "carry in previous addition?" */
-			break;
-		      n1 -= n0 < d1;
-		      n0 -= d1;
-		    }
-		}
-
-	      /* Possible optimization: We already have (q * n0) and (1 * n1)
-		 after the calculation of QUOT.  Taking advantage of this, we
-		 could make this loop make two iterations less.  */
-
-	      cy = __mpn_submul_1 (num, den, densize + 1, quot);
-
-	      if (num[densize] != cy)
-		{
-		  cy = __mpn_add_n (num, num, den, densize);
-		  assert (cy != 0);
-		  --quot;
-		}
-	      n0 = num[densize] = num[densize - 1];
-	      for (i = densize - 1; i > 0; --i)
-		num[i] = num[i - 1];
-
-	      got_limb;
-	    }
-
-	  for (i = densize; num[i] == 0 && i >= 0; --i)
-	    ;
-	  return round_and_return (retval, exponent - 1, negative,
-				   quot, BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - 1 - used,
-				   more_bits || i >= 0);
-	}
-      }
-  }
-
-  /* NOTREACHED */
+  return INTERNAL(STRTOF_L) (nptr, endptr, group, _NL_CURRENT_LOCALE);
 }
-#if defined _LIBC \
-    && !(defined USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL && defined USE_WIDE_CHAR)
+#if defined _LIBC
 libc_hidden_def (INTERNAL (STRTOF))
 #endif
-
-/* External user entry point.  */
+
 
 FLOAT
 #ifdef weak_function
 weak_function
 #endif
-STRTOF (nptr, endptr LOCALE_PARAM)
+STRTOF (nptr, endptr)
      const STRING_TYPE *nptr;
      STRING_TYPE **endptr;
-     LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
 {
-  return INTERNAL (STRTOF) (nptr, endptr, 0 LOCALE_PARAM);
+  return INTERNAL(STRTOF_L) (nptr, endptr, 0, _NL_CURRENT_LOCALE);
 }
diff --git a/stdlib/strtod_l.c b/stdlib/strtod_l.c
index e8449050d3..89d30b435b 100644
--- a/stdlib/strtod_l.c
+++ b/stdlib/strtod_l.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert string representing a number to float value, using given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1997,98,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1997,98,2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1997.
 
@@ -18,14 +18,1555 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
-
 #include <xlocale.h>
 
 extern double ____strtod_l_internal (const char *, char **, int, __locale_t);
 extern unsigned long long int ____strtoull_l_internal (const char *, char **,
 						       int, int, __locale_t);
 
-#include <strtod.c>
+/* Configuration part.  These macros are defined by `strtold.c',
+   `strtof.c', `wcstod.c', `wcstold.c', and `wcstof.c' to produce the
+   `long double' and `float' versions of the reader.  */
+#ifndef FLOAT
+# define FLOAT		double
+# define FLT		DBL
+# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+#  define STRTOF	wcstod_l
+#  define __STRTOF	__wcstod_l
+# else
+#  define STRTOF	strtod_l
+#  define __STRTOF	__strtod_l
+# endif
+# define MPN2FLOAT	__mpn_construct_double
+# define FLOAT_HUGE_VAL	HUGE_VAL
+# define SET_MANTISSA(flt, mant) \
+  do { union ieee754_double u;						      \
+       u.d = (flt);							      \
+       if ((mant & 0xfffffffffffffULL) == 0)				      \
+	 mant = 0x8000000000000ULL;					      \
+       u.ieee.mantissa0 = ((mant) >> 32) & 0xfffff;			      \
+       u.ieee.mantissa1 = (mant) & 0xffffffff;				      \
+       (flt) = u.d;							      \
+  } while (0)
+#endif
+/* End of configuration part.  */
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <float.h>
+#include <ieee754.h>
+#include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
+#include <locale.h>
+#include <math.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+/* The gmp headers need some configuration frobs.  */
+#define HAVE_ALLOCA 1
+
+/* Include gmp-mparam.h first, such that definitions of _SHORT_LIMB
+   and _LONG_LONG_LIMB in it can take effect into gmp.h.  */
+#include <gmp-mparam.h>
+#include <gmp.h>
+#include <gmp-impl.h>
+#include <longlong.h>
+#include "fpioconst.h"
+
+#define NDEBUG 1
+#include <assert.h>
+
+
+/* We use this code for the extended locale handling where the
+   function gets as an additional argument the locale which has to be
+   used.  To access the values we have to redefine the _NL_CURRENT and
+   _NL_CURRENT_WORD macros.  */
+#undef _NL_CURRENT
+#define _NL_CURRENT(category, item) \
+  (current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (item)].string)
+#undef _NL_CURRENT_WORD
+#define _NL_CURRENT_WORD(category, item) \
+  ((uint32_t) current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (item)].word)
+
+#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_WCHAR_H
+# include <wchar.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+# include <wctype.h>
+# define STRING_TYPE wchar_t
+# define CHAR_TYPE wint_t
+# define L_(Ch) L##Ch
+# define ISSPACE(Ch) __iswspace_l ((Ch), loc)
+# define ISDIGIT(Ch) __iswdigit_l ((Ch), loc)
+# define ISXDIGIT(Ch) __iswxdigit_l ((Ch), loc)
+# define TOLOWER(Ch) __towlower_l ((Ch), loc)
+# define STRNCASECMP(S1, S2, N) __wcsncasecmp_l ((S1), (S2), (N), loc)
+# define STRTOULL(S, E, B) ____wcstoull_l_internal ((S), (E), (B), 0, loc)
+#else
+# define STRING_TYPE char
+# define CHAR_TYPE char
+# define L_(Ch) Ch
+# define ISSPACE(Ch) __isspace_l ((Ch), loc)
+# define ISDIGIT(Ch) __isdigit_l ((Ch), loc)
+# define ISXDIGIT(Ch) __isxdigit_l ((Ch), loc)
+# define TOLOWER(Ch) __tolower_l ((Ch), loc)
+# define STRNCASECMP(S1, S2, N) __strncasecmp_l ((S1), (S2), (N), loc)
+# define STRTOULL(S, E, B) ____strtoull_l_internal ((S), (E), (B), 0, loc)
+#endif
+
+
+/* Constants we need from float.h; select the set for the FLOAT precision.  */
+#define MANT_DIG	PASTE(FLT,_MANT_DIG)
+#define	DIG		PASTE(FLT,_DIG)
+#define	MAX_EXP		PASTE(FLT,_MAX_EXP)
+#define	MIN_EXP		PASTE(FLT,_MIN_EXP)
+#define MAX_10_EXP	PASTE(FLT,_MAX_10_EXP)
+#define MIN_10_EXP	PASTE(FLT,_MIN_10_EXP)
+
+/* Extra macros required to get FLT expanded before the pasting.  */
+#define PASTE(a,b)	PASTE1(a,b)
+#define PASTE1(a,b)	a##b
+
+/* Function to construct a floating point number from an MP integer
+   containing the fraction bits, a base 2 exponent, and a sign flag.  */
+extern FLOAT MPN2FLOAT (mp_srcptr mpn, int exponent, int negative);
+
+/* Definitions according to limb size used.  */
+#if	BITS_PER_MP_LIMB == 32
+# define MAX_DIG_PER_LIMB	9
+# define MAX_FAC_PER_LIMB	1000000000UL
+#elif	BITS_PER_MP_LIMB == 64
+# define MAX_DIG_PER_LIMB	19
+# define MAX_FAC_PER_LIMB	10000000000000000000ULL
+#else
+# error "mp_limb_t size " BITS_PER_MP_LIMB "not accounted for"
+#endif
+
+
+/* Local data structure.  */
+static const mp_limb_t _tens_in_limb[MAX_DIG_PER_LIMB + 1] =
+{    0,                   10,                   100,
+     1000,                10000,                100000L,
+     1000000L,            10000000L,            100000000L,
+     1000000000L
+#if BITS_PER_MP_LIMB > 32
+	        ,	  10000000000ULL,       100000000000ULL,
+     1000000000000ULL,    10000000000000ULL,    100000000000000ULL,
+     1000000000000000ULL, 10000000000000000ULL, 100000000000000000ULL,
+     1000000000000000000ULL, 10000000000000000000ULL
+#endif
+#if BITS_PER_MP_LIMB > 64
+  #error "Need to expand tens_in_limb table to" MAX_DIG_PER_LIMB
+#endif
+};
+
+#ifndef	howmany
+#define	howmany(x,y)		(((x)+((y)-1))/(y))
+#endif
+#define SWAP(x, y)		({ typeof(x) _tmp = x; x = y; y = _tmp; })
+
+#define NDIG			(MAX_10_EXP - MIN_10_EXP + 2 * MANT_DIG)
+#define HEXNDIG			((MAX_EXP - MIN_EXP + 7) / 8 + 2 * MANT_DIG)
+#define	RETURN_LIMB_SIZE		howmany (MANT_DIG, BITS_PER_MP_LIMB)
+
+#define RETURN(val,end)							      \
+    do { if (endptr != NULL) *endptr = (STRING_TYPE *) (end);		      \
+	 return val; } while (0)
+
+/* Maximum size necessary for mpn integers to hold floating point numbers.  */
+#define	MPNSIZE		(howmany (MAX_EXP + 2 * MANT_DIG, BITS_PER_MP_LIMB) \
+			 + 2)
+/* Declare an mpn integer variable that big.  */
+#define	MPN_VAR(name)	mp_limb_t name[MPNSIZE]; mp_size_t name##size
+/* Copy an mpn integer value.  */
+#define MPN_ASSIGN(dst, src) \
+	memcpy (dst, src, (dst##size = src##size) * sizeof (mp_limb_t))
+
+
+/* Return a floating point number of the needed type according to the given
+   multi-precision number after possible rounding.  */
+static FLOAT
+round_and_return (mp_limb_t *retval, int exponent, int negative,
+		  mp_limb_t round_limb, mp_size_t round_bit, int more_bits)
+{
+  if (exponent < MIN_EXP - 1)
+    {
+      mp_size_t shift = MIN_EXP - 1 - exponent;
+
+      if (shift > MANT_DIG)
+	{
+	  __set_errno (EDOM);
+	  return 0.0;
+	}
+
+      more_bits |= (round_limb & ((((mp_limb_t) 1) << round_bit) - 1)) != 0;
+      if (shift == MANT_DIG)
+	/* This is a special case to handle the very seldom case where
+	   the mantissa will be empty after the shift.  */
+	{
+	  int i;
+
+	  round_limb = retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - 1];
+	  round_bit = (MANT_DIG - 1) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
+	  for (i = 0; i < RETURN_LIMB_SIZE; ++i)
+	    more_bits |= retval[i] != 0;
+	  MPN_ZERO (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE);
+	}
+      else if (shift >= BITS_PER_MP_LIMB)
+	{
+	  int i;
+
+	  round_limb = retval[(shift - 1) / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB];
+	  round_bit = (shift - 1) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
+	  for (i = 0; i < (shift - 1) / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB; ++i)
+	    more_bits |= retval[i] != 0;
+	  more_bits |= ((round_limb & ((((mp_limb_t) 1) << round_bit) - 1))
+			!= 0);
+
+	  (void) __mpn_rshift (retval, &retval[shift / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB],
+                               RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - (shift / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB),
+                               shift % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB);
+          MPN_ZERO (&retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - (shift / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB)],
+                    shift / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB);
+	}
+      else if (shift > 0)
+	{
+          round_limb = retval[0];
+          round_bit = shift - 1;
+	  (void) __mpn_rshift (retval, retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE, shift);
+	}
+      /* This is a hook for the m68k long double format, where the
+	 exponent bias is the same for normalized and denormalized
+	 numbers.  */
+#ifndef DENORM_EXP
+# define DENORM_EXP (MIN_EXP - 2)
+#endif
+      exponent = DENORM_EXP;
+    }
+
+  if ((round_limb & (((mp_limb_t) 1) << round_bit)) != 0
+      && (more_bits || (retval[0] & 1) != 0
+          || (round_limb & ((((mp_limb_t) 1) << round_bit) - 1)) != 0))
+    {
+      mp_limb_t cy = __mpn_add_1 (retval, retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE, 1);
+
+      if (((MANT_DIG % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB) == 0 && cy) ||
+          ((MANT_DIG % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB) != 0 &&
+           (retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - 1]
+            & (((mp_limb_t) 1) << (MANT_DIG % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB))) != 0))
+	{
+	  ++exponent;
+	  (void) __mpn_rshift (retval, retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE, 1);
+	  retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - 1]
+	    |= ((mp_limb_t) 1) << ((MANT_DIG - 1) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB);
+	}
+      else if (exponent == DENORM_EXP
+	       && (retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - 1]
+		   & (((mp_limb_t) 1) << ((MANT_DIG - 1) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB)))
+	       != 0)
+	  /* The number was denormalized but now normalized.  */
+	exponent = MIN_EXP - 1;
+    }
+
+  if (exponent > MAX_EXP)
+    return negative ? -FLOAT_HUGE_VAL : FLOAT_HUGE_VAL;
+
+  return MPN2FLOAT (retval, exponent, negative);
+}
+
+
+/* Read a multi-precision integer starting at STR with exactly DIGCNT digits
+   into N.  Return the size of the number limbs in NSIZE at the first
+   character od the string that is not part of the integer as the function
+   value.  If the EXPONENT is small enough to be taken as an additional
+   factor for the resulting number (see code) multiply by it.  */
+static const STRING_TYPE *
+str_to_mpn (const STRING_TYPE *str, int digcnt, mp_limb_t *n, mp_size_t *nsize,
+	    int *exponent
+#ifndef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+	    , const char *decimal, size_t decimal_len, const char *thousands
+#endif
+
+	    )
+{
+  /* Number of digits for actual limb.  */
+  int cnt = 0;
+  mp_limb_t low = 0;
+  mp_limb_t start;
+
+  *nsize = 0;
+  assert (digcnt > 0);
+  do
+    {
+      if (cnt == MAX_DIG_PER_LIMB)
+	{
+	  if (*nsize == 0)
+	    {
+	      n[0] = low;
+	      *nsize = 1;
+	    }
+	  else
+	    {
+	      mp_limb_t cy;
+	      cy = __mpn_mul_1 (n, n, *nsize, MAX_FAC_PER_LIMB);
+	      cy += __mpn_add_1 (n, n, *nsize, low);
+	      if (cy != 0)
+		{
+		  n[*nsize] = cy;
+		  ++(*nsize);
+		}
+	    }
+	  cnt = 0;
+	  low = 0;
+	}
+
+      /* There might be thousands separators or radix characters in
+	 the string.  But these all can be ignored because we know the
+	 format of the number is correct and we have an exact number
+	 of characters to read.  */
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+      if (*str < L'0' || *str > L'9')
+	++str;
+#else
+      if (*str < '0' || *str > '9')
+	{
+	  int inner = 0;
+	  if (thousands != NULL && *str == *thousands
+	      && ({ for (inner = 1; thousands[inner] != '\0'; ++inner)
+		      if (thousands[inner] != str[inner])
+			break;
+		    thousands[inner] == '\0'; }))
+	    str += inner;
+	  else
+	    str += decimal_len;
+	}
+#endif
+      low = low * 10 + *str++ - L_('0');
+      ++cnt;
+    }
+  while (--digcnt > 0);
+
+  if (*exponent > 0 && cnt + *exponent <= MAX_DIG_PER_LIMB)
+    {
+      low *= _tens_in_limb[*exponent];
+      start = _tens_in_limb[cnt + *exponent];
+      *exponent = 0;
+    }
+  else
+    start = _tens_in_limb[cnt];
+
+  if (*nsize == 0)
+    {
+      n[0] = low;
+      *nsize = 1;
+    }
+  else
+    {
+      mp_limb_t cy;
+      cy = __mpn_mul_1 (n, n, *nsize, start);
+      cy += __mpn_add_1 (n, n, *nsize, low);
+      if (cy != 0)
+	n[(*nsize)++] = cy;
+    }
+
+  return str;
+}
+
+
+/* Shift {PTR, SIZE} COUNT bits to the left, and fill the vacated bits
+   with the COUNT most significant bits of LIMB.
+
+   Tege doesn't like this function so I have to write it here myself. :)
+   --drepper */
+static inline void
+__attribute ((always_inline))
+__mpn_lshift_1 (mp_limb_t *ptr, mp_size_t size, unsigned int count,
+		mp_limb_t limb)
+{
+  if (__builtin_constant_p (count) && count == BITS_PER_MP_LIMB)
+    {
+      /* Optimize the case of shifting by exactly a word:
+	 just copy words, with no actual bit-shifting.  */
+      mp_size_t i;
+      for (i = size - 1; i > 0; --i)
+	ptr[i] = ptr[i - 1];
+      ptr[0] = limb;
+    }
+  else
+    {
+      (void) __mpn_lshift (ptr, ptr, size, count);
+      ptr[0] |= limb >> (BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - count);
+    }
+}
+
+
+#define INTERNAL(x) INTERNAL1(x)
+#define INTERNAL1(x) __##x##_internal
+
+/* This file defines a function to check for correct grouping.  */
+#include "grouping.h"
+
+
+/* Return a floating point number with the value of the given string NPTR.
+   Set *ENDPTR to the character after the last used one.  If the number is
+   smaller than the smallest representable number, set `errno' to ERANGE and
+   return 0.0.  If the number is too big to be represented, set `errno' to
+   ERANGE and return HUGE_VAL with the appropriate sign.  */
+FLOAT
+INTERNAL (__STRTOF) (nptr, endptr, group, loc)
+     const STRING_TYPE *nptr;
+     STRING_TYPE **endptr;
+     int group;
+     __locale_t loc;
+{
+  int negative;			/* The sign of the number.  */
+  MPN_VAR (num);		/* MP representation of the number.  */
+  int exponent;			/* Exponent of the number.  */
+
+  /* Numbers starting `0X' or `0x' have to be processed with base 16.  */
+  int base = 10;
+
+  /* When we have to compute fractional digits we form a fraction with a
+     second multi-precision number (and we sometimes need a second for
+     temporary results).  */
+  MPN_VAR (den);
+
+  /* Representation for the return value.  */
+  mp_limb_t retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE];
+  /* Number of bits currently in result value.  */
+  int bits;
+
+  /* Running pointer after the last character processed in the string.  */
+  const STRING_TYPE *cp, *tp;
+  /* Start of significant part of the number.  */
+  const STRING_TYPE *startp, *start_of_digits;
+  /* Points at the character following the integer and fractional digits.  */
+  const STRING_TYPE *expp;
+  /* Total number of digit and number of digits in integer part.  */
+  int dig_no, int_no, lead_zero;
+  /* Contains the last character read.  */
+  CHAR_TYPE c;
+
+/* We should get wint_t from <stddef.h>, but not all GCC versions define it
+   there.  So define it ourselves if it remains undefined.  */
+#ifndef _WINT_T
+  typedef unsigned int wint_t;
+#endif
+  /* The radix character of the current locale.  */
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+  wchar_t decimal;
+#else
+  const char *decimal;
+  size_t decimal_len;
+#endif
+  /* The thousands character of the current locale.  */
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+  wchar_t thousands = L'\0';
+#else
+  const char *thousands = NULL;
+#endif
+  /* The numeric grouping specification of the current locale,
+     in the format described in <locale.h>.  */
+  const char *grouping;
+  /* Used in several places.  */
+  int cnt;
+
+  struct locale_data *current = loc->__locales[LC_NUMERIC];
+
+  if (group)
+    {
+      grouping = _NL_CURRENT (LC_NUMERIC, GROUPING);
+      if (*grouping <= 0 || *grouping == CHAR_MAX)
+	grouping = NULL;
+      else
+	{
+	  /* Figure out the thousands separator character.  */
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+	  thousands = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_NUMERIC,
+					_NL_NUMERIC_THOUSANDS_SEP_WC);
+	  if (thousands == L'\0')
+	    grouping = NULL;
+#else
+	  thousands = _NL_CURRENT (LC_NUMERIC, THOUSANDS_SEP);
+	  if (*thousands == '\0')
+	    {
+	      thousands = NULL;
+	      grouping = NULL;
+	    }
+#endif
+	}
+    }
+  else
+    grouping = NULL;
+
+  /* Find the locale's decimal point character.  */
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+  decimal = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_NUMERIC, _NL_NUMERIC_DECIMAL_POINT_WC);
+  assert (decimal != L'\0');
+# define decimal_len 1
+#else
+  decimal = _NL_CURRENT (LC_NUMERIC, DECIMAL_POINT);
+  decimal_len = strlen (decimal);
+  assert (decimal_len > 0);
+#endif
+
+  /* Prepare number representation.  */
+  exponent = 0;
+  negative = 0;
+  bits = 0;
+
+  /* Parse string to get maximal legal prefix.  We need the number of
+     characters of the integer part, the fractional part and the exponent.  */
+  cp = nptr - 1;
+  /* Ignore leading white space.  */
+  do
+    c = *++cp;
+  while (ISSPACE (c));
+
+  /* Get sign of the result.  */
+  if (c == L_('-'))
+    {
+      negative = 1;
+      c = *++cp;
+    }
+  else if (c == L_('+'))
+    c = *++cp;
+
+  /* Return 0.0 if no legal string is found.
+     No character is used even if a sign was found.  */
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+  if (c == (wint_t) decimal
+      && (wint_t) cp[1] >= L'0' && (wint_t) cp[1] <= L'9')
+    {
+      /* We accept it.  This funny construct is here only to indent
+	 the code directly.  */
+    }
+#else
+  for (cnt = 0; decimal[cnt] != '\0'; ++cnt)
+    if (cp[cnt] != decimal[cnt])
+      break;
+  if (decimal[cnt] == '\0' && cp[cnt] >= '0' && cp[cnt] <= '9')
+    {
+      /* We accept it.  This funny construct is here only to indent
+	 the code directly.  */
+    }
+#endif
+  else if (c < L_('0') || c > L_('9'))
+    {
+      /* Check for `INF' or `INFINITY'.  */
+      if (TOLOWER (c) == L_('i') && STRNCASECMP (cp, L_("inf"), 3) == 0)
+	{
+	  /* Return +/- infinity.  */
+	  if (endptr != NULL)
+	    *endptr = (STRING_TYPE *)
+		      (cp + (STRNCASECMP (cp + 3, L_("inity"), 5) == 0
+			     ? 8 : 3));
+
+	  return negative ? -FLOAT_HUGE_VAL : FLOAT_HUGE_VAL;
+	}
+
+      if (TOLOWER (c) == L_('n') && STRNCASECMP (cp, L_("nan"), 3) == 0)
+	{
+	  /* Return NaN.  */
+	  FLOAT retval = NAN;
+
+	  cp += 3;
+
+	  /* Match `(n-char-sequence-digit)'.  */
+	  if (*cp == L_('('))
+	    {
+	      const STRING_TYPE *startp = cp;
+	      do
+		++cp;
+	      while ((*cp >= L_('0') && *cp <= L_('9'))
+		     || (TOLOWER (*cp) >= L_('a') && TOLOWER (*cp) <= L_('z'))
+		     || *cp == L_('_'));
+
+	      if (*cp != L_(')'))
+		/* The closing brace is missing.  Only match the NAN
+		   part.  */
+		cp = startp;
+	      else
+		{
+		  /* This is a system-dependent way to specify the
+		     bitmask used for the NaN.  We expect it to be
+		     a number which is put in the mantissa of the
+		     number.  */
+		  STRING_TYPE *endp;
+		  unsigned long long int mant;
+
+		  mant = STRTOULL (startp + 1, &endp, 0);
+		  if (endp == cp)
+		    SET_MANTISSA (retval, mant);
+		}
+	    }
+
+	  if (endptr != NULL)
+	    *endptr = (STRING_TYPE *) cp;
+
+	  return retval;
+	}
+
+      /* It is really a text we do not recognize.  */
+      RETURN (0.0, nptr);
+    }
+
+  /* First look whether we are faced with a hexadecimal number.  */
+  if (c == L_('0') && TOLOWER (cp[1]) == L_('x'))
+    {
+      /* Okay, it is a hexa-decimal number.  Remember this and skip
+	 the characters.  BTW: hexadecimal numbers must not be
+	 grouped.  */
+      base = 16;
+      cp += 2;
+      c = *cp;
+      grouping = NULL;
+    }
+
+  /* Record the start of the digits, in case we will check their grouping.  */
+  start_of_digits = startp = cp;
+
+  /* Ignore leading zeroes.  This helps us to avoid useless computations.  */
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+  while (c == L'0' || ((wint_t) thousands != L'\0' && c == (wint_t) thousands))
+    c = *++cp;
+#else
+  if (thousands == NULL)
+    while (c == '0')
+      c = *++cp;
+  else
+    {
+      /* We also have the multibyte thousands string.  */
+      while (1)
+	{
+	  if (c != '0')
+	    {
+	      for (cnt = 0; thousands[cnt] != '\0'; ++cnt)
+		if (c != thousands[cnt])
+		  break;
+	      if (thousands[cnt] != '\0')
+		break;
+	    }
+	  c = *++cp;
+	}
+    }
+#endif
+
+  /* If no other digit but a '0' is found the result is 0.0.
+     Return current read pointer.  */
+  if ((c < L_('0') || c > L_('9'))
+      && (base == 16 && (c < (CHAR_TYPE) TOLOWER (L_('a'))
+			 || c > (CHAR_TYPE) TOLOWER (L_('f'))))
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+      && c != (wint_t) decimal
+#else
+      && ({ for (cnt = 0; decimal[cnt] != '\0'; ++cnt)
+	      if (decimal[cnt] != cp[cnt])
+		break;
+	    decimal[cnt] != '\0'; })
+#endif
+      && (base == 16 && (cp == start_of_digits
+			 || (CHAR_TYPE) TOLOWER (c) != L_('p')))
+      && (base != 16 && (CHAR_TYPE) TOLOWER (c) != L_('e')))
+    {
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+      tp = __correctly_grouped_prefixwc (start_of_digits, cp, thousands,
+					 grouping);
+#else
+      tp = __correctly_grouped_prefixmb (start_of_digits, cp, thousands,
+					 grouping);
+#endif
+      /* If TP is at the start of the digits, there was no correctly
+	 grouped prefix of the string; so no number found.  */
+      RETURN (0.0, tp == start_of_digits ? (base == 16 ? cp - 1 : nptr) : tp);
+    }
+
+  /* Remember first significant digit and read following characters until the
+     decimal point, exponent character or any non-FP number character.  */
+  startp = cp;
+  dig_no = 0;
+  while (1)
+    {
+      if ((c >= L_('0') && c <= L_('9'))
+	  || (base == 16 && (wint_t) TOLOWER (c) >= L_('a')
+	      && (wint_t) TOLOWER (c) <= L_('f')))
+	++dig_no;
+      else
+	{
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+	  if ((wint_t) thousands == L'\0' || c != (wint_t) thousands)
+	    /* Not a digit or separator: end of the integer part.  */
+	    break;
+#else
+	  if (thousands == NULL)
+	    break;
+	  else
+	    {
+	      for (cnt = 0; thousands[cnt] != '\0'; ++cnt)
+		if (thousands[cnt] != cp[cnt])
+		  break;
+	      if (thousands[cnt] != '\0')
+		break;
+	    }
+#endif
+	}
+      c = *++cp;
+    }
+
+  if (grouping && dig_no > 0)
+    {
+      /* Check the grouping of the digits.  */
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+      tp = __correctly_grouped_prefixwc (start_of_digits, cp, thousands,
+					 grouping);
+#else
+      tp = __correctly_grouped_prefixmb (start_of_digits, cp, thousands,
+					 grouping);
+#endif
+      if (cp != tp)
+        {
+	  /* Less than the entire string was correctly grouped.  */
+
+	  if (tp == start_of_digits)
+	    /* No valid group of numbers at all: no valid number.  */
+	    RETURN (0.0, nptr);
+
+	  if (tp < startp)
+	    /* The number is validly grouped, but consists
+	       only of zeroes.  The whole value is zero.  */
+	    RETURN (0.0, tp);
+
+	  /* Recompute DIG_NO so we won't read more digits than
+	     are properly grouped.  */
+	  cp = tp;
+	  dig_no = 0;
+	  for (tp = startp; tp < cp; ++tp)
+	    if (*tp >= L_('0') && *tp <= L_('9'))
+	      ++dig_no;
+
+	  int_no = dig_no;
+	  lead_zero = 0;
+
+	  goto number_parsed;
+	}
+    }
+
+  /* We have the number digits in the integer part.  Whether these are all or
+     any is really a fractional digit will be decided later.  */
+  int_no = dig_no;
+  lead_zero = int_no == 0 ? -1 : 0;
+
+  /* Read the fractional digits.  A special case are the 'american style'
+     numbers like `16.' i.e. with decimal but without trailing digits.  */
+  if (
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+      c == (wint_t) decimal
+#else
+      ({ for (cnt = 0; decimal[cnt] != '\0'; ++cnt)
+	   if (decimal[cnt] != cp[cnt])
+	     break;
+	 decimal[cnt] == '\0'; })
+#endif
+      )
+    {
+      cp += decimal_len;
+      c = *cp;
+      while ((c >= L_('0') && c <= L_('9')) ||
+	     (base == 16 && TOLOWER (c) >= L_('a') && TOLOWER (c) <= L_('f')))
+	{
+	  if (c != L_('0') && lead_zero == -1)
+	    lead_zero = dig_no - int_no;
+	  ++dig_no;
+	  c = *++cp;
+	}
+    }
+
+  /* Remember start of exponent (if any).  */
+  expp = cp;
+
+  /* Read exponent.  */
+  if ((base == 16 && TOLOWER (c) == L_('p'))
+      || (base != 16 && TOLOWER (c) == L_('e')))
+    {
+      int exp_negative = 0;
+
+      c = *++cp;
+      if (c == L_('-'))
+	{
+	  exp_negative = 1;
+	  c = *++cp;
+	}
+      else if (c == L_('+'))
+	c = *++cp;
+
+      if (c >= L_('0') && c <= L_('9'))
+	{
+	  int exp_limit;
+
+	  /* Get the exponent limit. */
+	  if (base == 16)
+	    exp_limit = (exp_negative ?
+			 -MIN_EXP + MANT_DIG + 4 * int_no :
+			 MAX_EXP - 4 * int_no + lead_zero);
+	  else
+	    exp_limit = (exp_negative ?
+			 -MIN_10_EXP + MANT_DIG + int_no :
+			 MAX_10_EXP - int_no + lead_zero);
+
+	  do
+	    {
+	      exponent *= 10;
+
+	      if (exponent > exp_limit)
+		/* The exponent is too large/small to represent a valid
+		   number.  */
+		{
+	 	  FLOAT result;
+
+		  /* We have to take care for special situation: a joker
+		     might have written "0.0e100000" which is in fact
+		     zero.  */
+		  if (lead_zero == -1)
+		    result = negative ? -0.0 : 0.0;
+		  else
+		    {
+		      /* Overflow or underflow.  */
+		      __set_errno (ERANGE);
+		      result = (exp_negative ? 0.0 :
+				negative ? -FLOAT_HUGE_VAL : FLOAT_HUGE_VAL);
+		    }
+
+		  /* Accept all following digits as part of the exponent.  */
+		  do
+		    ++cp;
+		  while (*cp >= L_('0') && *cp <= L_('9'));
+
+		  RETURN (result, cp);
+		  /* NOTREACHED */
+		}
+
+	      exponent += c - L_('0');
+	      c = *++cp;
+	    }
+	  while (c >= L_('0') && c <= L_('9'));
+
+	  if (exp_negative)
+	    exponent = -exponent;
+	}
+      else
+	cp = expp;
+    }
+
+  /* We don't want to have to work with trailing zeroes after the radix.  */
+  if (dig_no > int_no)
+    {
+      while (expp[-1] == L_('0'))
+	{
+	  --expp;
+	  --dig_no;
+	}
+      assert (dig_no >= int_no);
+    }
+
+  if (dig_no == int_no && dig_no > 0 && exponent < 0)
+    do
+      {
+	while (! (base == 16 ? ISXDIGIT (expp[-1]) : ISDIGIT (expp[-1])))
+	  --expp;
+
+	if (expp[-1] != L_('0'))
+	  break;
+
+	--expp;
+	--dig_no;
+	--int_no;
+	++exponent;
+      }
+    while (dig_no > 0 && exponent < 0);
+
+ number_parsed:
+
+  /* The whole string is parsed.  Store the address of the next character.  */
+  if (endptr)
+    *endptr = (STRING_TYPE *) cp;
+
+  if (dig_no == 0)
+    return negative ? -0.0 : 0.0;
+
+  if (lead_zero)
+    {
+      /* Find the decimal point */
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+      while (*startp != decimal)
+	++startp;
+#else
+      while (1)
+	{
+	  if (*startp == decimal[0])
+	    {
+	      for (cnt = 1; decimal[cnt] != '\0'; ++cnt)
+		if (decimal[cnt] != startp[cnt])
+		  break;
+	      if (decimal[cnt] == '\0')
+		break;
+	    }
+	  ++startp;
+	}
+#endif
+      startp += lead_zero + decimal_len;
+      exponent -= base == 16 ? 4 * lead_zero : lead_zero;
+      dig_no -= lead_zero;
+    }
+
+  /* If the BASE is 16 we can use a simpler algorithm.  */
+  if (base == 16)
+    {
+      static const int nbits[16] = { 0, 1, 2, 2, 3, 3, 3, 3,
+				     4, 4, 4, 4, 4, 4, 4, 4 };
+      int idx = (MANT_DIG - 1) / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
+      int pos = (MANT_DIG - 1) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
+      mp_limb_t val;
+
+      while (!ISXDIGIT (*startp))
+	++startp;
+      while (*startp == L_('0'))
+	++startp;
+      if (ISDIGIT (*startp))
+	val = *startp++ - L_('0');
+      else
+	val = 10 + TOLOWER (*startp++) - L_('a');
+      bits = nbits[val];
+      /* We cannot have a leading zero.  */
+      assert (bits != 0);
+
+      if (pos + 1 >= 4 || pos + 1 >= bits)
+	{
+	  /* We don't have to care for wrapping.  This is the normal
+	     case so we add the first clause in the `if' expression as
+	     an optimization.  It is a compile-time constant and so does
+	     not cost anything.  */
+	  retval[idx] = val << (pos - bits + 1);
+	  pos -= bits;
+	}
+      else
+	{
+	  retval[idx--] = val >> (bits - pos - 1);
+	  retval[idx] = val << (BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - (bits - pos - 1));
+	  pos = BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - 1 - (bits - pos - 1);
+	}
+
+      /* Adjust the exponent for the bits we are shifting in.  */
+      exponent += bits - 1 + (int_no - 1) * 4;
+
+      while (--dig_no > 0 && idx >= 0)
+	{
+	  if (!ISXDIGIT (*startp))
+	    startp += decimal_len;
+	  if (ISDIGIT (*startp))
+	    val = *startp++ - L_('0');
+	  else
+	    val = 10 + TOLOWER (*startp++) - L_('a');
+
+	  if (pos + 1 >= 4)
+	    {
+	      retval[idx] |= val << (pos - 4 + 1);
+	      pos -= 4;
+	    }
+	  else
+	    {
+	      retval[idx--] |= val >> (4 - pos - 1);
+	      val <<= BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - (4 - pos - 1);
+	      if (idx < 0)
+		return round_and_return (retval, exponent, negative, val,
+					 BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - 1, dig_no > 0);
+
+	      retval[idx] = val;
+	      pos = BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - 1 - (4 - pos - 1);
+	    }
+	}
+
+      /* We ran out of digits.  */
+      MPN_ZERO (retval, idx);
+
+      return round_and_return (retval, exponent, negative, 0, 0, 0);
+    }
+
+  /* Now we have the number of digits in total and the integer digits as well
+     as the exponent and its sign.  We can decide whether the read digits are
+     really integer digits or belong to the fractional part; i.e. we normalize
+     123e-2 to 1.23.  */
+  {
+    register int incr = (exponent < 0 ? MAX (-int_no, exponent)
+			 : MIN (dig_no - int_no, exponent));
+    int_no += incr;
+    exponent -= incr;
+  }
+
+  if (int_no + exponent > MAX_10_EXP + 1)
+    {
+      __set_errno (ERANGE);
+      return negative ? -FLOAT_HUGE_VAL : FLOAT_HUGE_VAL;
+    }
+
+  if (exponent < MIN_10_EXP - (DIG + 1))
+    {
+      __set_errno (ERANGE);
+      return 0.0;
+    }
+
+  if (int_no > 0)
+    {
+      /* Read the integer part as a multi-precision number to NUM.  */
+      startp = str_to_mpn (startp, int_no, num, &numsize, &exponent
+#ifndef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+			   , decimal, decimal_len, thousands
+#endif
+			   );
+
+      if (exponent > 0)
+	{
+	  /* We now multiply the gained number by the given power of ten.  */
+	  mp_limb_t *psrc = num;
+	  mp_limb_t *pdest = den;
+	  int expbit = 1;
+	  const struct mp_power *ttab = &_fpioconst_pow10[0];
+
+	  do
+	    {
+	      if ((exponent & expbit) != 0)
+		{
+		  size_t size = ttab->arraysize - _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET;
+		  mp_limb_t cy;
+		  exponent ^= expbit;
+
+		  /* FIXME: not the whole multiplication has to be
+		     done.  If we have the needed number of bits we
+		     only need the information whether more non-zero
+		     bits follow.  */
+		  if (numsize >= ttab->arraysize - _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET)
+		    cy = __mpn_mul (pdest, psrc, numsize,
+				    &__tens[ttab->arrayoff
+					   + _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET],
+				    size);
+		  else
+		    cy = __mpn_mul (pdest, &__tens[ttab->arrayoff
+						  + _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET],
+				    size, psrc, numsize);
+		  numsize += size;
+		  if (cy == 0)
+		    --numsize;
+		  (void) SWAP (psrc, pdest);
+		}
+	      expbit <<= 1;
+	      ++ttab;
+	    }
+	  while (exponent != 0);
+
+	  if (psrc == den)
+	    memcpy (num, den, numsize * sizeof (mp_limb_t));
+	}
+
+      /* Determine how many bits of the result we already have.  */
+      count_leading_zeros (bits, num[numsize - 1]);
+      bits = numsize * BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - bits;
+
+      /* Now we know the exponent of the number in base two.
+	 Check it against the maximum possible exponent.  */
+      if (bits > MAX_EXP)
+	{
+	  __set_errno (ERANGE);
+	  return negative ? -FLOAT_HUGE_VAL : FLOAT_HUGE_VAL;
+	}
+
+      /* We have already the first BITS bits of the result.  Together with
+	 the information whether more non-zero bits follow this is enough
+	 to determine the result.  */
+      if (bits > MANT_DIG)
+	{
+	  int i;
+	  const mp_size_t least_idx = (bits - MANT_DIG) / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
+	  const mp_size_t least_bit = (bits - MANT_DIG) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
+	  const mp_size_t round_idx = least_bit == 0 ? least_idx - 1
+						     : least_idx;
+	  const mp_size_t round_bit = least_bit == 0 ? BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - 1
+						     : least_bit - 1;
+
+	  if (least_bit == 0)
+	    memcpy (retval, &num[least_idx],
+		    RETURN_LIMB_SIZE * sizeof (mp_limb_t));
+	  else
+            {
+              for (i = least_idx; i < numsize - 1; ++i)
+                retval[i - least_idx] = (num[i] >> least_bit)
+                                        | (num[i + 1]
+                                           << (BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - least_bit));
+              if (i - least_idx < RETURN_LIMB_SIZE)
+                retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - 1] = num[i] >> least_bit;
+            }
+
+	  /* Check whether any limb beside the ones in RETVAL are non-zero.  */
+	  for (i = 0; num[i] == 0; ++i)
+	    ;
+
+	  return round_and_return (retval, bits - 1, negative,
+				   num[round_idx], round_bit,
+				   int_no < dig_no || i < round_idx);
+	  /* NOTREACHED */
+	}
+      else if (dig_no == int_no)
+	{
+	  const mp_size_t target_bit = (MANT_DIG - 1) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
+	  const mp_size_t is_bit = (bits - 1) % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
+
+	  if (target_bit == is_bit)
+	    {
+	      memcpy (&retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - numsize], num,
+		      numsize * sizeof (mp_limb_t));
+	      /* FIXME: the following loop can be avoided if we assume a
+		 maximal MANT_DIG value.  */
+	      MPN_ZERO (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - numsize);
+	    }
+	  else if (target_bit > is_bit)
+	    {
+	      (void) __mpn_lshift (&retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - numsize],
+				   num, numsize, target_bit - is_bit);
+	      /* FIXME: the following loop can be avoided if we assume a
+		 maximal MANT_DIG value.  */
+	      MPN_ZERO (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - numsize);
+	    }
+	  else
+	    {
+	      mp_limb_t cy;
+	      assert (numsize < RETURN_LIMB_SIZE);
+
+	      cy = __mpn_rshift (&retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - numsize],
+				 num, numsize, is_bit - target_bit);
+	      retval[RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - numsize - 1] = cy;
+	      /* FIXME: the following loop can be avoided if we assume a
+		 maximal MANT_DIG value.  */
+	      MPN_ZERO (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE - numsize - 1);
+	    }
+
+	  return round_and_return (retval, bits - 1, negative, 0, 0, 0);
+	  /* NOTREACHED */
+	}
+
+      /* Store the bits we already have.  */
+      memcpy (retval, num, numsize * sizeof (mp_limb_t));
+#if RETURN_LIMB_SIZE > 1
+      if (numsize < RETURN_LIMB_SIZE)
+        retval[numsize] = 0;
+#endif
+    }
+
+  /* We have to compute at least some of the fractional digits.  */
+  {
+    /* We construct a fraction and the result of the division gives us
+       the needed digits.  The denominator is 1.0 multiplied by the
+       exponent of the lowest digit; i.e. 0.123 gives 123 / 1000 and
+       123e-6 gives 123 / 1000000.  */
+
+    int expbit;
+    int neg_exp;
+    int more_bits;
+    mp_limb_t cy;
+    mp_limb_t *psrc = den;
+    mp_limb_t *pdest = num;
+    const struct mp_power *ttab = &_fpioconst_pow10[0];
+
+    assert (dig_no > int_no && exponent <= 0);
+
+
+    /* For the fractional part we need not process too many digits.  One
+       decimal digits gives us log_2(10) ~ 3.32 bits.  If we now compute
+                        ceil(BITS / 3) =: N
+       digits we should have enough bits for the result.  The remaining
+       decimal digits give us the information that more bits are following.
+       This can be used while rounding.  (Two added as a safety margin.)  */
+    if (dig_no - int_no > (MANT_DIG - bits + 2) / 3 + 2)
+      {
+        dig_no = int_no + (MANT_DIG - bits + 2) / 3 + 2;
+        more_bits = 1;
+      }
+    else
+      more_bits = 0;
+
+    neg_exp = dig_no - int_no - exponent;
+
+    /* Construct the denominator.  */
+    densize = 0;
+    expbit = 1;
+    do
+      {
+	if ((neg_exp & expbit) != 0)
+	  {
+	    mp_limb_t cy;
+	    neg_exp ^= expbit;
+
+	    if (densize == 0)
+	      {
+		densize = ttab->arraysize - _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET;
+		memcpy (psrc, &__tens[ttab->arrayoff + _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET],
+			densize * sizeof (mp_limb_t));
+	      }
+	    else
+	      {
+		cy = __mpn_mul (pdest, &__tens[ttab->arrayoff
+					      + _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET],
+				ttab->arraysize - _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET,
+				psrc, densize);
+		densize += ttab->arraysize - _FPIO_CONST_OFFSET;
+		if (cy == 0)
+		  --densize;
+		(void) SWAP (psrc, pdest);
+	      }
+	  }
+	expbit <<= 1;
+	++ttab;
+      }
+    while (neg_exp != 0);
+
+    if (psrc == num)
+      memcpy (den, num, densize * sizeof (mp_limb_t));
+
+    /* Read the fractional digits from the string.  */
+    (void) str_to_mpn (startp, dig_no - int_no, num, &numsize, &exponent
+#ifndef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+		       , decimal, decimal_len, thousands
+#endif
+		       );
+
+    /* We now have to shift both numbers so that the highest bit in the
+       denominator is set.  In the same process we copy the numerator to
+       a high place in the array so that the division constructs the wanted
+       digits.  This is done by a "quasi fix point" number representation.
+
+       num:   ddddddddddd . 0000000000000000000000
+              |--- m ---|
+       den:                            ddddddddddd      n >= m
+                                       |--- n ---|
+     */
+
+    count_leading_zeros (cnt, den[densize - 1]);
+
+    if (cnt > 0)
+      {
+	/* Don't call `mpn_shift' with a count of zero since the specification
+	   does not allow this.  */
+	(void) __mpn_lshift (den, den, densize, cnt);
+	cy = __mpn_lshift (num, num, numsize, cnt);
+	if (cy != 0)
+	  num[numsize++] = cy;
+      }
+
+    /* Now we are ready for the division.  But it is not necessary to
+       do a full multi-precision division because we only need a small
+       number of bits for the result.  So we do not use __mpn_divmod
+       here but instead do the division here by hand and stop whenever
+       the needed number of bits is reached.  The code itself comes
+       from the GNU MP Library by Torbj\"orn Granlund.  */
+
+    exponent = bits;
+
+    switch (densize)
+      {
+      case 1:
+	{
+	  mp_limb_t d, n, quot;
+	  int used = 0;
+
+	  n = num[0];
+	  d = den[0];
+	  assert (numsize == 1 && n < d);
+
+	  do
+	    {
+	      udiv_qrnnd (quot, n, n, 0, d);
+
+#define got_limb							      \
+	      if (bits == 0)						      \
+		{							      \
+		  register int cnt;					      \
+		  if (quot == 0)					      \
+		    cnt = BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;				      \
+		  else							      \
+		    count_leading_zeros (cnt, quot);			      \
+		  exponent -= cnt;					      \
+		  if (BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - cnt > MANT_DIG)		      \
+		    {							      \
+		      used = MANT_DIG + cnt;				      \
+		      retval[0] = quot >> (BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - used);	      \
+		      bits = MANT_DIG + 1;				      \
+		    }							      \
+		  else							      \
+		    {							      \
+		      /* Note that we only clear the second element.  */      \
+		      /* The conditional is determined at compile time.  */   \
+		      if (RETURN_LIMB_SIZE > 1)				      \
+			retval[1] = 0;					      \
+		      retval[0] = quot;					      \
+		      bits = -cnt;					      \
+		    }							      \
+		}							      \
+	      else if (bits + BITS_PER_MP_LIMB <= MANT_DIG)		      \
+		__mpn_lshift_1 (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE, BITS_PER_MP_LIMB,   \
+				quot);					      \
+	      else							      \
+		{							      \
+		  used = MANT_DIG - bits;				      \
+		  if (used > 0)						      \
+		    __mpn_lshift_1 (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE, used, quot);    \
+		}							      \
+	      bits += BITS_PER_MP_LIMB
+
+	      got_limb;
+	    }
+	  while (bits <= MANT_DIG);
+
+	  return round_and_return (retval, exponent - 1, negative,
+				   quot, BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - 1 - used,
+				   more_bits || n != 0);
+	}
+      case 2:
+	{
+	  mp_limb_t d0, d1, n0, n1;
+	  mp_limb_t quot = 0;
+	  int used = 0;
+
+	  d0 = den[0];
+	  d1 = den[1];
+
+	  if (numsize < densize)
+	    {
+	      if (num[0] >= d1)
+		{
+		  /* The numerator of the number occupies fewer bits than
+		     the denominator but the one limb is bigger than the
+		     high limb of the numerator.  */
+		  n1 = 0;
+		  n0 = num[0];
+		}
+	      else
+		{
+		  if (bits <= 0)
+		    exponent -= BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
+		  else
+		    {
+		      if (bits + BITS_PER_MP_LIMB <= MANT_DIG)
+			__mpn_lshift_1 (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE,
+					BITS_PER_MP_LIMB, 0);
+		      else
+			{
+			  used = MANT_DIG - bits;
+			  if (used > 0)
+			    __mpn_lshift_1 (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE, used, 0);
+			}
+		      bits += BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
+		    }
+		  n1 = num[0];
+		  n0 = 0;
+		}
+	    }
+	  else
+	    {
+	      n1 = num[1];
+	      n0 = num[0];
+	    }
+
+	  while (bits <= MANT_DIG)
+	    {
+	      mp_limb_t r;
+
+	      if (n1 == d1)
+		{
+		  /* QUOT should be either 111..111 or 111..110.  We need
+		     special treatment of this rare case as normal division
+		     would give overflow.  */
+		  quot = ~(mp_limb_t) 0;
+
+		  r = n0 + d1;
+		  if (r < d1)	/* Carry in the addition?  */
+		    {
+		      add_ssaaaa (n1, n0, r - d0, 0, 0, d0);
+		      goto have_quot;
+		    }
+		  n1 = d0 - (d0 != 0);
+		  n0 = -d0;
+		}
+	      else
+		{
+		  udiv_qrnnd (quot, r, n1, n0, d1);
+		  umul_ppmm (n1, n0, d0, quot);
+		}
+
+	    q_test:
+	      if (n1 > r || (n1 == r && n0 > 0))
+		{
+		  /* The estimated QUOT was too large.  */
+		  --quot;
+
+		  sub_ddmmss (n1, n0, n1, n0, 0, d0);
+		  r += d1;
+		  if (r >= d1)	/* If not carry, test QUOT again.  */
+		    goto q_test;
+		}
+	      sub_ddmmss (n1, n0, r, 0, n1, n0);
+
+	    have_quot:
+	      got_limb;
+	    }
+
+	  return round_and_return (retval, exponent - 1, negative,
+				   quot, BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - 1 - used,
+				   more_bits || n1 != 0 || n0 != 0);
+	}
+      default:
+	{
+	  int i;
+	  mp_limb_t cy, dX, d1, n0, n1;
+	  mp_limb_t quot = 0;
+	  int used = 0;
+
+	  dX = den[densize - 1];
+	  d1 = den[densize - 2];
+
+	  /* The division does not work if the upper limb of the two-limb
+	     numerator is greater than the denominator.  */
+	  if (__mpn_cmp (num, &den[densize - numsize], numsize) > 0)
+	    num[numsize++] = 0;
+
+	  if (numsize < densize)
+	    {
+	      mp_size_t empty = densize - numsize;
+
+	      if (bits <= 0)
+		{
+		  register int i;
+		  for (i = numsize; i > 0; --i)
+		    num[i + empty] = num[i - 1];
+		  MPN_ZERO (num, empty + 1);
+		  exponent -= empty * BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
+		}
+	      else
+		{
+		  if (bits + empty * BITS_PER_MP_LIMB <= MANT_DIG)
+		    {
+		      /* We make a difference here because the compiler
+			 cannot optimize the `else' case that good and
+			 this reflects all currently used FLOAT types
+			 and GMP implementations.  */
+		      register int i;
+#if RETURN_LIMB_SIZE <= 2
+		      assert (empty == 1);
+		      __mpn_lshift_1 (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE,
+				      BITS_PER_MP_LIMB, 0);
+#else
+		      for (i = RETURN_LIMB_SIZE; i > empty; --i)
+			retval[i] = retval[i - empty];
+#endif
+		      for (i = numsize; i > 0; --i)
+			num[i + empty] = num[i - 1];
+		      MPN_ZERO (num, empty + 1);
+		    }
+		  else
+		    {
+		      used = MANT_DIG - bits;
+		      if (used >= BITS_PER_MP_LIMB)
+			{
+			  register int i;
+			  (void) __mpn_lshift (&retval[used
+						       / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB],
+					       retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE,
+					       used % BITS_PER_MP_LIMB);
+			  for (i = used / BITS_PER_MP_LIMB; i >= 0; --i)
+			    retval[i] = 0;
+			}
+		      else if (used > 0)
+			__mpn_lshift_1 (retval, RETURN_LIMB_SIZE, used, 0);
+		    }
+		  bits += empty * BITS_PER_MP_LIMB;
+		}
+	    }
+	  else
+	    {
+	      int i;
+	      assert (numsize == densize);
+	      for (i = numsize; i > 0; --i)
+		num[i] = num[i - 1];
+	    }
+
+	  den[densize] = 0;
+	  n0 = num[densize];
+
+	  while (bits <= MANT_DIG)
+	    {
+	      if (n0 == dX)
+		/* This might over-estimate QUOT, but it's probably not
+		   worth the extra code here to find out.  */
+		quot = ~(mp_limb_t) 0;
+	      else
+		{
+		  mp_limb_t r;
+
+		  udiv_qrnnd (quot, r, n0, num[densize - 1], dX);
+		  umul_ppmm (n1, n0, d1, quot);
+
+		  while (n1 > r || (n1 == r && n0 > num[densize - 2]))
+		    {
+		      --quot;
+		      r += dX;
+		      if (r < dX) /* I.e. "carry in previous addition?" */
+			break;
+		      n1 -= n0 < d1;
+		      n0 -= d1;
+		    }
+		}
+
+	      /* Possible optimization: We already have (q * n0) and (1 * n1)
+		 after the calculation of QUOT.  Taking advantage of this, we
+		 could make this loop make two iterations less.  */
+
+	      cy = __mpn_submul_1 (num, den, densize + 1, quot);
+
+	      if (num[densize] != cy)
+		{
+		  cy = __mpn_add_n (num, num, den, densize);
+		  assert (cy != 0);
+		  --quot;
+		}
+	      n0 = num[densize] = num[densize - 1];
+	      for (i = densize - 1; i > 0; --i)
+		num[i] = num[i - 1];
+
+	      got_limb;
+	    }
+
+	  for (i = densize; num[i] == 0 && i >= 0; --i)
+	    ;
+	  return round_and_return (retval, exponent - 1, negative,
+				   quot, BITS_PER_MP_LIMB - 1 - used,
+				   more_bits || i >= 0);
+	}
+      }
+  }
+
+  /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+#if defined _LIBC && !defined USE_WIDE_CHAR
+libc_hidden_def (INTERNAL (__STRTOF))
+#endif
+
+/* External user entry point.  */
 
-weak_alias (__strtod_l, strtod_l)
+FLOAT
+#ifdef weak_function
+weak_function
+#endif
+__STRTOF (nptr, endptr, loc)
+     const STRING_TYPE *nptr;
+     STRING_TYPE **endptr;
+     __locale_t loc;
+{
+  return INTERNAL (__STRTOF) (nptr, endptr, 0, loc);
+}
+weak_alias (__STRTOF, STRTOF)
diff --git a/stdlib/strtof.c b/stdlib/strtof.c
index 9d070279f8..b98cb9bfde 100644
--- a/stdlib/strtof.c
+++ b/stdlib/strtof.c
@@ -1,22 +1,35 @@
+/* Read decimal floating point numbers.
+   This file is part of the GNU C Library.
+   Copyright (C) 1995-2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.org>, 1995.
+
+   The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+   modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+   License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+   version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+   The GNU C Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+   Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+   You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+   License along with the GNU C Library; if not, write to the Free
+   Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
+   02111-1307 USA.  */
+
 /* The actual implementation for all floating point sizes is in strtod.c.
    These macros tell it to produce the `float' version, `strtof'.  */
 
 #define	FLOAT		float
 #define	FLT		FLT
-#ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-# define STRTOF		__strtof_l
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+#define STRTOF		wcstof
+#define STRTOF_L	__wcstof_l
 #else
 # define STRTOF		strtof
+# define STRTOF_L	__strtof_l
 #endif
-#define	MPN2FLOAT	__mpn_construct_float
-#define	FLOAT_HUGE_VAL	HUGE_VALF
-#define SET_MANTISSA(flt, mant) \
-  do { union ieee754_float u;						      \
-       u.f = (flt);							      \
-       if ((mant & 0x7fffff) == 0)					      \
-	 mant = 0x400000;						      \
-       u.ieee.mantissa = (mant) & 0x7fffff;				      \
-       (flt) = u.f;							      \
-  } while (0)
+
 
 #include "strtod.c"
diff --git a/stdlib/strtof_l.c b/stdlib/strtof_l.c
index 1187ffc73b..bbc7611e1e 100644
--- a/stdlib/strtof_l.c
+++ b/stdlib/strtof_l.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert string representing a number to float value, using given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1997,98,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1997,98,2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1997.
 
@@ -18,14 +18,30 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
-
 #include <xlocale.h>
 
 extern float ____strtof_l_internal (const char *, char **, int, __locale_t);
 extern unsigned long long int ____strtoull_l_internal (const char *, char **,
 						       int, int, __locale_t);
 
-#include <strtof.c>
-
-weak_alias (__strtof_l, strtof_l)
+#define	FLOAT		float
+#define	FLT		FLT
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+# define STRTOF		wcstof_l
+# define __STRTOF	__wcstof_l
+#else
+# define STRTOF		strtof_l
+# define __STRTOF	__strtof_l
+#endif
+#define	MPN2FLOAT	__mpn_construct_float
+#define	FLOAT_HUGE_VAL	HUGE_VALF
+#define SET_MANTISSA(flt, mant) \
+  do { union ieee754_float u;						      \
+       u.f = (flt);							      \
+       if ((mant & 0x7fffff) == 0)					      \
+	 mant = 0x400000;						      \
+       u.ieee.mantissa = (mant) & 0x7fffff;				      \
+       (flt) = u.f;							      \
+  } while (0)
+
+#include "strtod_l.c"
diff --git a/stdlib/strtold.c b/stdlib/strtold.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..0bb227a84f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/stdlib/strtold.c
@@ -0,0 +1,35 @@
+/* Read decimal floating point numbers.
+   This file is part of the GNU C Library.
+   Copyright (C) 1995-2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.org>, 1995.
+
+   The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+   modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+   License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+   version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+   The GNU C Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+   Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+   You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+   License along with the GNU C Library; if not, write to the Free
+   Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
+   02111-1307 USA.  */
+
+/* The actual implementation for all floating point sizes is in strtod.c.
+   These macros tell it to produce the `float' version, `strtof'.  */
+
+#define	FLOAT		long double
+#define	FLT		LDBL
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+# define STRTOF		wcstold
+# define STRTOF_L	__wcstold_l
+#else
+# define STRTOF		strtold
+# define STRTOF_L	__strtold_l
+#endif
+
+
+#include "strtod.c"
diff --git a/stdlib/strtold_l.c b/stdlib/strtold_l.c
deleted file mode 100644
index c3a4e79390..0000000000
--- a/stdlib/strtold_l.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,53 +0,0 @@
-/* Convert string representing a number to float value, using given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1997,98,99,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
-   This file is part of the GNU C Library.
-   Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1997.
-
-   The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
-   modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
-   License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
-   version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
-
-   The GNU C Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
-   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
-   Lesser General Public License for more details.
-
-   You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
-   License along with the GNU C Library; if not, write to the Free
-   Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
-   02111-1307 USA.  */
-
-#include <math.h>
-#include <xlocale.h>
-
-#ifndef __NO_LONG_DOUBLE_MATH
-
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
-
-extern long double ____strtold_l_internal (const char *, char **, int,
-					   __locale_t);
-extern unsigned long long int ____strtoull_l_internal (const char *, char **,
-						       int, int, __locale_t);
-
-# include <strtold.c>
-
-#else
-/* There is no `long double' type, use the `double' implementations.  */
-extern double ____strtod_l_internal (const char *, char **, int,
-				     __locale_t);
-long double
-____strtold_l_internal (const char *nptr, char **endptr, int group,
-			__locale_t loc)
-{
-  return ____strtod_l_internal (nptr, endptr, group, loc);
-}
-
-long double
-__strtold_l (const char *nptr, char **endptr, __locale_t loc)
-{
-  return ____strtod_l_internal (nptr, endptr, 0, loc);
-}
-#endif
-
-weak_alias (__strtold_l, strtold_l)
diff --git a/string/strcoll.c b/string/strcoll.c
index 26072018ac..8a73cae564 100644
--- a/string/strcoll.c
+++ b/string/strcoll.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1995,96,97,98,99,2000,2001,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 1995-2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995.
 
@@ -17,540 +17,24 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#include <assert.h>
-#include <langinfo.h>
-#include <locale.h>
-#include <stddef.h>
-#include <stdint.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
 #include <string.h>
 
 #ifndef STRING_TYPE
 # define STRING_TYPE char
-# define USTRING_TYPE unsigned char
-# ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#  define STRCOLL __strcoll_l
-# else
-#  define STRCOLL strcoll
-# endif
-# define STRCMP strcmp
-# define STRLEN strlen
-# define WEIGHT_H "../locale/weight.h"
-# define SUFFIX	MB
-# define L(arg) arg
+# define STRCOLL strcoll
+# define STRCOLL_L __strcoll_l
 #endif
 
-#define CONCAT(a,b) CONCAT1(a,b)
-#define CONCAT1(a,b) a##b
-
 #include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
 
-#ifndef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
+
 int
 STRCOLL (s1, s2)
      const STRING_TYPE *s1;
      const STRING_TYPE *s2;
-#else
-int
-STRCOLL (s1, s2, l)
-     const STRING_TYPE *s1;
-     const STRING_TYPE *s2;
-     __locale_t l;
-#endif
 {
-#ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-  struct locale_data *current = l->__locales[LC_COLLATE];
-  uint_fast32_t nrules = current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (_NL_COLLATE_NRULES)].word;
-#else
-  uint_fast32_t nrules = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_COLLATE, _NL_COLLATE_NRULES);
-#endif
-  /* We don't assign the following values right away since it might be
-     unnecessary in case there are no rules.  */
-  const unsigned char *rulesets;
-  const int32_t *table;
-  const USTRING_TYPE *weights;
-  const USTRING_TYPE *extra;
-  const int32_t *indirect;
-  uint_fast32_t pass;
-  int result = 0;
-  const USTRING_TYPE *us1;
-  const USTRING_TYPE *us2;
-  size_t s1len;
-  size_t s2len;
-  int32_t *idx1arr;
-  int32_t *idx2arr;
-  unsigned char *rule1arr;
-  unsigned char *rule2arr;
-  size_t idx1max;
-  size_t idx2max;
-  size_t idx1cnt;
-  size_t idx2cnt;
-  size_t idx1now;
-  size_t idx2now;
-  size_t backw1_stop;
-  size_t backw2_stop;
-  size_t backw1;
-  size_t backw2;
-  int val1;
-  int val2;
-  int position;
-  int seq1len;
-  int seq2len;
-  int use_malloc;
-
-#include WEIGHT_H
-
-  if (nrules == 0)
-    return STRCMP (s1, s2);
-
-#ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-  rulesets = (const unsigned char *)
-    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (_NL_COLLATE_RULESETS)].string;
-  table = (const int32_t *)
-    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_TABLE,SUFFIX))].string;
-  weights = (const USTRING_TYPE *)
-    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_WEIGHT,SUFFIX))].string;
-  extra = (const USTRING_TYPE *)
-    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_EXTRA,SUFFIX))].string;
-  indirect = (const int32_t *)
-    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_INDIRECT,SUFFIX))].string;
-#else
-  rulesets = (const unsigned char *)
-    _NL_CURRENT (LC_COLLATE, _NL_COLLATE_RULESETS);
-  table = (const int32_t *)
-    _NL_CURRENT (LC_COLLATE, CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_TABLE,SUFFIX));
-  weights = (const USTRING_TYPE *)
-    _NL_CURRENT (LC_COLLATE, CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_WEIGHT,SUFFIX));
-  extra = (const USTRING_TYPE *)
-    _NL_CURRENT (LC_COLLATE, CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_EXTRA,SUFFIX));
-  indirect = (const int32_t *)
-    _NL_CURRENT (LC_COLLATE, CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_INDIRECT,SUFFIX));
-#endif
-  use_malloc = 0;
-
-  assert (((uintptr_t) table) % __alignof__ (table[0]) == 0);
-  assert (((uintptr_t) weights) % __alignof__ (weights[0]) == 0);
-  assert (((uintptr_t) extra) % __alignof__ (extra[0]) == 0);
-  assert (((uintptr_t) indirect) % __alignof__ (indirect[0]) == 0);
-
-  /* We need this a few times.  */
-  s1len = STRLEN (s1);
-  s2len = STRLEN (s2);
-
-  /* Catch empty strings.  */
-  if (__builtin_expect (s1len == 0, 0) || __builtin_expect (s2len == 0, 0))
-    return (s1len != 0) - (s2len != 0);
-
-  /* We need the elements of the strings as unsigned values since they
-     are used as indeces.  */
-  us1 = (const USTRING_TYPE *) s1;
-  us2 = (const USTRING_TYPE *) s2;
-
-  /* Perform the first pass over the string and while doing this find
-     and store the weights for each character.  Since we want this to
-     be as fast as possible we are using `alloca' to store the temporary
-     values.  But since there is no limit on the length of the string
-     we have to use `malloc' if the string is too long.  We should be
-     very conservative here.
-
-     Please note that the localedef programs makes sure that `position'
-     is not used at the first level.  */
-  if (! __libc_use_alloca (s1len + s2len))
-    {
-      idx1arr = (int32_t *) malloc ((s1len + s2len) * (sizeof (int32_t) + 1));
-      idx2arr = &idx1arr[s1len];
-      rule1arr = (unsigned char *) &idx2arr[s2len];
-      rule2arr = &rule1arr[s1len];
-
-      if (idx1arr == NULL)
-	/* No memory.  Well, go with the stack then.
-
-	   XXX Once this implementation is stable we will handle this
-	   differently.  Instead of precomputing the indeces we will
-	   do this in time.  This means, though, that this happens for
-	   every pass again.  */
-	goto try_stack;
-      use_malloc = 1;
-    }
-  else
-    {
-    try_stack:
-      idx1arr = (int32_t *) alloca (s1len * sizeof (int32_t));
-      idx2arr = (int32_t *) alloca (s2len * sizeof (int32_t));
-      rule1arr = (unsigned char *) alloca (s1len);
-      rule2arr = (unsigned char *) alloca (s2len);
-    }
-
-  idx1cnt = 0;
-  idx2cnt = 0;
-  idx1max = 0;
-  idx2max = 0;
-  idx1now = 0;
-  idx2now = 0;
-  backw1_stop = ~0ul;
-  backw2_stop = ~0ul;
-  backw1 = ~0ul;
-  backw2 = ~0ul;
-  seq1len = 0;
-  seq2len = 0;
-  position = rulesets[0] & sort_position;
-  while (1)
-    {
-      val1 = 0;
-      val2 = 0;
-
-      /* Get the next non-IGNOREd element for string `s1'.  */
-      if (seq1len == 0)
-	do
-	  {
-	    ++val1;
-
-	    if (backw1_stop != ~0ul)
-	      {
-		/* The is something pushed.  */
-		if (backw1 == backw1_stop)
-		  {
-		    /* The last pushed character was handled.  Continue
-		       with forward characters.  */
-		    if (idx1cnt < idx1max)
-		      idx1now = idx1cnt;
-		    else
-		      /* Nothing anymore.  The backward sequence ended with
-			 the last sequence in the string.  Note that seq1len
-			 is still zero.  */
-		      break;
-		  }
-		else
-		  idx1now = --backw1;
-	      }
-	    else
-	      {
-		backw1_stop = idx1max;
-
-		while (*us1 != L('\0'))
-		  {
-		    int32_t tmp = findidx (&us1);
-		    rule1arr[idx1max] = tmp >> 24;
-		    idx1arr[idx1max] = tmp & 0xffffff;
-		    idx1cnt = idx1max++;
-
-		    if ((rulesets[rule1arr[idx1cnt] * nrules]
-			 & sort_backward) == 0)
-		      /* No more backward characters to push.  */
-		      break;
-		    ++idx1cnt;
-		  }
-
-		if (backw1_stop >= idx1cnt)
-		  {
-		    /* No sequence at all or just one.  */
-		    if (idx1cnt == idx1max || backw1_stop > idx1cnt)
-		      /* Note that seq1len is still zero.  */
-		      break;
-
-		    backw1_stop = ~0ul;
-		    idx1now = idx1cnt;
-		  }
-		else
-		  /* We pushed backward sequences.  */
-		  idx1now = backw1 = idx1cnt - 1;
-	      }
-	  }
-	while ((seq1len = weights[idx1arr[idx1now]++]) == 0);
-
-      /* And the same for string `s2'.  */
-      if (seq2len == 0)
-	do
-	  {
-	    ++val2;
-
-	    if (backw2_stop != ~0ul)
-	      {
-		/* The is something pushed.  */
-		if (backw2 == backw2_stop)
-		  {
-		    /* The last pushed character was handled.  Continue
-		       with forward characters.  */
-		    if (idx2cnt < idx2max)
-		      idx2now = idx2cnt;
-		    else
-		      /* Nothing anymore.  The backward sequence ended with
-			 the last sequence in the string.  Note that seq2len
-			 is still zero.  */
-		      break;
-		  }
-		else
-		  idx2now = --backw2;
-	      }
-	    else
-	      {
-		backw2_stop = idx2max;
-
-		while (*us2 != L('\0'))
-		  {
-		    int32_t tmp = findidx (&us2);
-		    rule2arr[idx2max] = tmp >> 24;
-		    idx2arr[idx2max] = tmp & 0xffffff;
-		    idx2cnt = idx2max++;
-
-		    if ((rulesets[rule2arr[idx2cnt] * nrules]
-			 & sort_backward) == 0)
-		      /* No more backward characters to push.  */
-		      break;
-		    ++idx2cnt;
-		  }
-
-		if (backw2_stop >= idx2cnt)
-		  {
-		    /* No sequence at all or just one.  */
-		    if (idx2cnt == idx2max || backw2_stop > idx2cnt)
-		      /* Note that seq1len is still zero.  */
-		      break;
-
-		    backw2_stop = ~0ul;
-		    idx2now = idx2cnt;
-		  }
-		else
-		  /* We pushed backward sequences.  */
-		  idx2now = backw2 = idx2cnt - 1;
-	      }
-	  }
-	while ((seq2len = weights[idx2arr[idx2now]++]) == 0);
-
-      /* See whether any or both strings are empty.  */
-      if (seq1len == 0 || seq2len == 0)
-	{
-	  if (seq1len == seq2len)
-	    /* Both ended.  So far so good, both strings are equal at the
-	       first level.  */
-	    break;
-
-	  /* This means one string is shorter than the other.  Find out
-	     which one and return an appropriate value.  */
-	  result = seq1len == 0 ? -1 : 1;
-	  goto free_and_return;
-	}
-
-      /* Test for position if necessary.  */
-      if (position && val1 != val2)
-	{
-	  result = val1 - val2;
-	  goto free_and_return;
-	}
-
-      /* Compare the two sequences.  */
-      do
-	{
-	  if (weights[idx1arr[idx1now]] != weights[idx2arr[idx2now]])
-	    {
-	      /* The sequences differ.  */
-	      result = weights[idx1arr[idx1now]] - weights[idx2arr[idx2now]];
-	      goto free_and_return;
-	    }
-
-	  /* Increment the offsets.  */
-	  ++idx1arr[idx1now];
-	  ++idx2arr[idx2now];
-
-	  --seq1len;
-	  --seq2len;
-	}
-      while (seq1len > 0 && seq2len > 0);
-
-      if (position && seq1len != seq2len)
-	{
-	  result = seq1len - seq2len;
-	  goto free_and_return;
-	}
-    }
-
-  /* Now the remaining passes over the weights.  We now use the
-     indeces we found before.  */
-  for (pass = 1; pass < nrules; ++pass)
-    {
-      /* We assume that if a rule has defined `position' in one section
-	 this is true for all of them.  */
-      idx1cnt = 0;
-      idx2cnt = 0;
-      backw1_stop = ~0ul;
-      backw2_stop = ~0ul;
-      backw1 = ~0ul;
-      backw2 = ~0ul;
-      position = rulesets[rule1arr[0] * nrules + pass] & sort_position;
-
-      while (1)
-	{
-	  val1 = 0;
-	  val2 = 0;
-
-	  /* Get the next non-IGNOREd element for string `s1'.  */
-	  if (seq1len == 0)
-	    do
-	      {
-		++val1;
-
-		if (backw1_stop != ~0ul)
-		  {
-		    /* The is something pushed.  */
-		    if (backw1 == backw1_stop)
-		      {
-			/* The last pushed character was handled.  Continue
-			   with forward characters.  */
-			if (idx1cnt < idx1max)
-			  idx1now = idx1cnt;
-			else
-			  {
-			    /* Nothing anymore.  The backward sequence
-			       ended with the last sequence in the string.  */
-			    idx1now = ~0ul;
-			    break;
-			  }
-		      }
-		    else
-		      idx1now = --backw1;
-		  }
-		else
-		  {
-		    backw1_stop = idx1cnt;
-
-		    while (idx1cnt < idx1max)
-		      {
-			if ((rulesets[rule1arr[idx1cnt] * nrules + pass]
-			     & sort_backward) == 0)
-			  /* No more backward characters to push.  */
-			  break;
-			++idx1cnt;
-		      }
-
-		    if (backw1_stop == idx1cnt)
-		      {
-			/* No sequence at all or just one.  */
-			if (idx1cnt == idx1max)
-			  /* Note that seq1len is still zero.  */
-			  break;
-
-			backw1_stop = ~0ul;
-			idx1now = idx1cnt++;
-		      }
-		    else
-		      /* We pushed backward sequences.  */
-		      idx1now = backw1 = idx1cnt - 1;
-		  }
-	      }
-	    while ((seq1len = weights[idx1arr[idx1now]++]) == 0);
-
-	  /* And the same for string `s2'.  */
-	  if (seq2len == 0)
-	    do
-	      {
-		++val2;
-
-		if (backw2_stop != ~0ul)
-		  {
-		    /* The is something pushed.  */
-		    if (backw2 == backw2_stop)
-		      {
-			/* The last pushed character was handled.  Continue
-			   with forward characters.  */
-			if (idx2cnt < idx2max)
-			  idx2now = idx2cnt;
-			else
-			  {
-			    /* Nothing anymore.  The backward sequence
-			       ended with the last sequence in the string.  */
-			    idx2now = ~0ul;
-			    break;
-			  }
-		      }
-		    else
-		      idx2now = --backw2;
-		  }
-		else
-		  {
-		    backw2_stop = idx2cnt;
-
-		    while (idx2cnt < idx2max)
-		      {
-			if ((rulesets[rule2arr[idx2cnt] * nrules + pass]
-			     & sort_backward) == 0)
-			  /* No more backward characters to push.  */
-			  break;
-			++idx2cnt;
-		      }
-
-		    if (backw2_stop == idx2cnt)
-		      {
-			/* No sequence at all or just one.  */
-			if (idx2cnt == idx2max)
-			  /* Note that seq2len is still zero.  */
-			  break;
-
-			backw2_stop = ~0ul;
-			idx2now = idx2cnt++;
-		      }
-		    else
-		      /* We pushed backward sequences.  */
-		      idx2now = backw2 = idx2cnt - 1;
-		  }
-	      }
-	    while ((seq2len = weights[idx2arr[idx2now]++]) == 0);
-
-	  /* See whether any or both strings are empty.  */
-	  if (seq1len == 0 || seq2len == 0)
-	    {
-	      if (seq1len == seq2len)
-		/* Both ended.  So far so good, both strings are equal
-		   at this level.  */
-		break;
-
-	      /* This means one string is shorter than the other.  Find out
-		 which one and return an appropriate value.  */
-	      result = seq1len == 0 ? -1 : 1;
-	      goto free_and_return;
-	    }
-
-	  /* Test for position if necessary.  */
-	  if (position && val1 != val2)
-	    {
-	      result = val1 - val2;
-	      goto free_and_return;
-	    }
-
-	  /* Compare the two sequences.  */
-	  do
-	    {
-	      if (weights[idx1arr[idx1now]] != weights[idx2arr[idx2now]])
-		{
-		  /* The sequences differ.  */
-		  result = (weights[idx1arr[idx1now]]
-			    - weights[idx2arr[idx2now]]);
-		  goto free_and_return;
-		}
-
-	      /* Increment the offsets.  */
-	      ++idx1arr[idx1now];
-	      ++idx2arr[idx2now];
-
-	      --seq1len;
-	      --seq2len;
-	    }
-	  while (seq1len > 0 && seq2len > 0);
-
-	  if (position && seq1len != seq2len)
-	    {
-	      result = seq1len - seq2len;
-	      goto free_and_return;
-	    }
-	}
-    }
-
-  /* Free the memory if needed.  */
- free_and_return:
-  if (use_malloc)
-    free (idx1arr);
-
-  return result;
+  return STRCOLL_L (s1, s2, _NL_CURRENT_LOCALE);
 }
-#if !defined WIDE_CHAR_VERSION && !defined USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
+#if !defined WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
 libc_hidden_def (strcoll)
 #endif
diff --git a/string/strcoll_l.c b/string/strcoll_l.c
index 6611589ed0..c46921dcc9 100644
--- a/string/strcoll_l.c
+++ b/string/strcoll_l.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1995,96,97,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 1995,96,97,2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.org>, 1995.
 
@@ -17,7 +17,515 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL 1
-#include <strcoll.c>
 
+#include <assert.h>
+#include <langinfo.h>
+#include <locale.h>
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <stdint.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#ifndef STRING_TYPE
+# define STRING_TYPE char
+# define USTRING_TYPE unsigned char
+# define STRCOLL __strcoll_l
+# define STRCMP strcmp
+# define STRLEN strlen
+# define WEIGHT_H "../locale/weight.h"
+# define SUFFIX	MB
+# define L(arg) arg
+#endif
+
+#define CONCAT(a,b) CONCAT1(a,b)
+#define CONCAT1(a,b) a##b
+
+#include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
+
+int
+STRCOLL (s1, s2, l)
+     const STRING_TYPE *s1;
+     const STRING_TYPE *s2;
+     __locale_t l;
+{
+  struct locale_data *current = l->__locales[LC_COLLATE];
+  uint_fast32_t nrules = current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (_NL_COLLATE_NRULES)].word;
+  /* We don't assign the following values right away since it might be
+     unnecessary in case there are no rules.  */
+  const unsigned char *rulesets;
+  const int32_t *table;
+  const USTRING_TYPE *weights;
+  const USTRING_TYPE *extra;
+  const int32_t *indirect;
+  uint_fast32_t pass;
+  int result = 0;
+  const USTRING_TYPE *us1;
+  const USTRING_TYPE *us2;
+  size_t s1len;
+  size_t s2len;
+  int32_t *idx1arr;
+  int32_t *idx2arr;
+  unsigned char *rule1arr;
+  unsigned char *rule2arr;
+  size_t idx1max;
+  size_t idx2max;
+  size_t idx1cnt;
+  size_t idx2cnt;
+  size_t idx1now;
+  size_t idx2now;
+  size_t backw1_stop;
+  size_t backw2_stop;
+  size_t backw1;
+  size_t backw2;
+  int val1;
+  int val2;
+  int position;
+  int seq1len;
+  int seq2len;
+  int use_malloc;
+
+#include WEIGHT_H
+
+  if (nrules == 0)
+    return STRCMP (s1, s2);
+
+  rulesets = (const unsigned char *)
+    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (_NL_COLLATE_RULESETS)].string;
+  table = (const int32_t *)
+    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_TABLE,SUFFIX))].string;
+  weights = (const USTRING_TYPE *)
+    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_WEIGHT,SUFFIX))].string;
+  extra = (const USTRING_TYPE *)
+    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_EXTRA,SUFFIX))].string;
+  indirect = (const int32_t *)
+    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_INDIRECT,SUFFIX))].string;
+  use_malloc = 0;
+
+  assert (((uintptr_t) table) % __alignof__ (table[0]) == 0);
+  assert (((uintptr_t) weights) % __alignof__ (weights[0]) == 0);
+  assert (((uintptr_t) extra) % __alignof__ (extra[0]) == 0);
+  assert (((uintptr_t) indirect) % __alignof__ (indirect[0]) == 0);
+
+  /* We need this a few times.  */
+  s1len = STRLEN (s1);
+  s2len = STRLEN (s2);
+
+  /* Catch empty strings.  */
+  if (__builtin_expect (s1len == 0, 0) || __builtin_expect (s2len == 0, 0))
+    return (s1len != 0) - (s2len != 0);
+
+  /* We need the elements of the strings as unsigned values since they
+     are used as indeces.  */
+  us1 = (const USTRING_TYPE *) s1;
+  us2 = (const USTRING_TYPE *) s2;
+
+  /* Perform the first pass over the string and while doing this find
+     and store the weights for each character.  Since we want this to
+     be as fast as possible we are using `alloca' to store the temporary
+     values.  But since there is no limit on the length of the string
+     we have to use `malloc' if the string is too long.  We should be
+     very conservative here.
+
+     Please note that the localedef programs makes sure that `position'
+     is not used at the first level.  */
+  if (! __libc_use_alloca (s1len + s2len))
+    {
+      idx1arr = (int32_t *) malloc ((s1len + s2len) * (sizeof (int32_t) + 1));
+      idx2arr = &idx1arr[s1len];
+      rule1arr = (unsigned char *) &idx2arr[s2len];
+      rule2arr = &rule1arr[s1len];
+
+      if (idx1arr == NULL)
+	/* No memory.  Well, go with the stack then.
+
+	   XXX Once this implementation is stable we will handle this
+	   differently.  Instead of precomputing the indeces we will
+	   do this in time.  This means, though, that this happens for
+	   every pass again.  */
+	goto try_stack;
+      use_malloc = 1;
+    }
+  else
+    {
+    try_stack:
+      idx1arr = (int32_t *) alloca (s1len * sizeof (int32_t));
+      idx2arr = (int32_t *) alloca (s2len * sizeof (int32_t));
+      rule1arr = (unsigned char *) alloca (s1len);
+      rule2arr = (unsigned char *) alloca (s2len);
+    }
+
+  idx1cnt = 0;
+  idx2cnt = 0;
+  idx1max = 0;
+  idx2max = 0;
+  idx1now = 0;
+  idx2now = 0;
+  backw1_stop = ~0ul;
+  backw2_stop = ~0ul;
+  backw1 = ~0ul;
+  backw2 = ~0ul;
+  seq1len = 0;
+  seq2len = 0;
+  position = rulesets[0] & sort_position;
+  while (1)
+    {
+      val1 = 0;
+      val2 = 0;
+
+      /* Get the next non-IGNOREd element for string `s1'.  */
+      if (seq1len == 0)
+	do
+	  {
+	    ++val1;
+
+	    if (backw1_stop != ~0ul)
+	      {
+		/* The is something pushed.  */
+		if (backw1 == backw1_stop)
+		  {
+		    /* The last pushed character was handled.  Continue
+		       with forward characters.  */
+		    if (idx1cnt < idx1max)
+		      idx1now = idx1cnt;
+		    else
+		      /* Nothing anymore.  The backward sequence ended with
+			 the last sequence in the string.  Note that seq1len
+			 is still zero.  */
+		      break;
+		  }
+		else
+		  idx1now = --backw1;
+	      }
+	    else
+	      {
+		backw1_stop = idx1max;
+
+		while (*us1 != L('\0'))
+		  {
+		    int32_t tmp = findidx (&us1);
+		    rule1arr[idx1max] = tmp >> 24;
+		    idx1arr[idx1max] = tmp & 0xffffff;
+		    idx1cnt = idx1max++;
+
+		    if ((rulesets[rule1arr[idx1cnt] * nrules]
+			 & sort_backward) == 0)
+		      /* No more backward characters to push.  */
+		      break;
+		    ++idx1cnt;
+		  }
+
+		if (backw1_stop >= idx1cnt)
+		  {
+		    /* No sequence at all or just one.  */
+		    if (idx1cnt == idx1max || backw1_stop > idx1cnt)
+		      /* Note that seq1len is still zero.  */
+		      break;
+
+		    backw1_stop = ~0ul;
+		    idx1now = idx1cnt;
+		  }
+		else
+		  /* We pushed backward sequences.  */
+		  idx1now = backw1 = idx1cnt - 1;
+	      }
+	  }
+	while ((seq1len = weights[idx1arr[idx1now]++]) == 0);
+
+      /* And the same for string `s2'.  */
+      if (seq2len == 0)
+	do
+	  {
+	    ++val2;
+
+	    if (backw2_stop != ~0ul)
+	      {
+		/* The is something pushed.  */
+		if (backw2 == backw2_stop)
+		  {
+		    /* The last pushed character was handled.  Continue
+		       with forward characters.  */
+		    if (idx2cnt < idx2max)
+		      idx2now = idx2cnt;
+		    else
+		      /* Nothing anymore.  The backward sequence ended with
+			 the last sequence in the string.  Note that seq2len
+			 is still zero.  */
+		      break;
+		  }
+		else
+		  idx2now = --backw2;
+	      }
+	    else
+	      {
+		backw2_stop = idx2max;
+
+		while (*us2 != L('\0'))
+		  {
+		    int32_t tmp = findidx (&us2);
+		    rule2arr[idx2max] = tmp >> 24;
+		    idx2arr[idx2max] = tmp & 0xffffff;
+		    idx2cnt = idx2max++;
+
+		    if ((rulesets[rule2arr[idx2cnt] * nrules]
+			 & sort_backward) == 0)
+		      /* No more backward characters to push.  */
+		      break;
+		    ++idx2cnt;
+		  }
+
+		if (backw2_stop >= idx2cnt)
+		  {
+		    /* No sequence at all or just one.  */
+		    if (idx2cnt == idx2max || backw2_stop > idx2cnt)
+		      /* Note that seq1len is still zero.  */
+		      break;
+
+		    backw2_stop = ~0ul;
+		    idx2now = idx2cnt;
+		  }
+		else
+		  /* We pushed backward sequences.  */
+		  idx2now = backw2 = idx2cnt - 1;
+	      }
+	  }
+	while ((seq2len = weights[idx2arr[idx2now]++]) == 0);
+
+      /* See whether any or both strings are empty.  */
+      if (seq1len == 0 || seq2len == 0)
+	{
+	  if (seq1len == seq2len)
+	    /* Both ended.  So far so good, both strings are equal at the
+	       first level.  */
+	    break;
+
+	  /* This means one string is shorter than the other.  Find out
+	     which one and return an appropriate value.  */
+	  result = seq1len == 0 ? -1 : 1;
+	  goto free_and_return;
+	}
+
+      /* Test for position if necessary.  */
+      if (position && val1 != val2)
+	{
+	  result = val1 - val2;
+	  goto free_and_return;
+	}
+
+      /* Compare the two sequences.  */
+      do
+	{
+	  if (weights[idx1arr[idx1now]] != weights[idx2arr[idx2now]])
+	    {
+	      /* The sequences differ.  */
+	      result = weights[idx1arr[idx1now]] - weights[idx2arr[idx2now]];
+	      goto free_and_return;
+	    }
+
+	  /* Increment the offsets.  */
+	  ++idx1arr[idx1now];
+	  ++idx2arr[idx2now];
+
+	  --seq1len;
+	  --seq2len;
+	}
+      while (seq1len > 0 && seq2len > 0);
+
+      if (position && seq1len != seq2len)
+	{
+	  result = seq1len - seq2len;
+	  goto free_and_return;
+	}
+    }
+
+  /* Now the remaining passes over the weights.  We now use the
+     indeces we found before.  */
+  for (pass = 1; pass < nrules; ++pass)
+    {
+      /* We assume that if a rule has defined `position' in one section
+	 this is true for all of them.  */
+      idx1cnt = 0;
+      idx2cnt = 0;
+      backw1_stop = ~0ul;
+      backw2_stop = ~0ul;
+      backw1 = ~0ul;
+      backw2 = ~0ul;
+      position = rulesets[rule1arr[0] * nrules + pass] & sort_position;
+
+      while (1)
+	{
+	  val1 = 0;
+	  val2 = 0;
+
+	  /* Get the next non-IGNOREd element for string `s1'.  */
+	  if (seq1len == 0)
+	    do
+	      {
+		++val1;
+
+		if (backw1_stop != ~0ul)
+		  {
+		    /* The is something pushed.  */
+		    if (backw1 == backw1_stop)
+		      {
+			/* The last pushed character was handled.  Continue
+			   with forward characters.  */
+			if (idx1cnt < idx1max)
+			  idx1now = idx1cnt;
+			else
+			  {
+			    /* Nothing anymore.  The backward sequence
+			       ended with the last sequence in the string.  */
+			    idx1now = ~0ul;
+			    break;
+			  }
+		      }
+		    else
+		      idx1now = --backw1;
+		  }
+		else
+		  {
+		    backw1_stop = idx1cnt;
+
+		    while (idx1cnt < idx1max)
+		      {
+			if ((rulesets[rule1arr[idx1cnt] * nrules + pass]
+			     & sort_backward) == 0)
+			  /* No more backward characters to push.  */
+			  break;
+			++idx1cnt;
+		      }
+
+		    if (backw1_stop == idx1cnt)
+		      {
+			/* No sequence at all or just one.  */
+			if (idx1cnt == idx1max)
+			  /* Note that seq1len is still zero.  */
+			  break;
+
+			backw1_stop = ~0ul;
+			idx1now = idx1cnt++;
+		      }
+		    else
+		      /* We pushed backward sequences.  */
+		      idx1now = backw1 = idx1cnt - 1;
+		  }
+	      }
+	    while ((seq1len = weights[idx1arr[idx1now]++]) == 0);
+
+	  /* And the same for string `s2'.  */
+	  if (seq2len == 0)
+	    do
+	      {
+		++val2;
+
+		if (backw2_stop != ~0ul)
+		  {
+		    /* The is something pushed.  */
+		    if (backw2 == backw2_stop)
+		      {
+			/* The last pushed character was handled.  Continue
+			   with forward characters.  */
+			if (idx2cnt < idx2max)
+			  idx2now = idx2cnt;
+			else
+			  {
+			    /* Nothing anymore.  The backward sequence
+			       ended with the last sequence in the string.  */
+			    idx2now = ~0ul;
+			    break;
+			  }
+		      }
+		    else
+		      idx2now = --backw2;
+		  }
+		else
+		  {
+		    backw2_stop = idx2cnt;
+
+		    while (idx2cnt < idx2max)
+		      {
+			if ((rulesets[rule2arr[idx2cnt] * nrules + pass]
+			     & sort_backward) == 0)
+			  /* No more backward characters to push.  */
+			  break;
+			++idx2cnt;
+		      }
+
+		    if (backw2_stop == idx2cnt)
+		      {
+			/* No sequence at all or just one.  */
+			if (idx2cnt == idx2max)
+			  /* Note that seq2len is still zero.  */
+			  break;
+
+			backw2_stop = ~0ul;
+			idx2now = idx2cnt++;
+		      }
+		    else
+		      /* We pushed backward sequences.  */
+		      idx2now = backw2 = idx2cnt - 1;
+		  }
+	      }
+	    while ((seq2len = weights[idx2arr[idx2now]++]) == 0);
+
+	  /* See whether any or both strings are empty.  */
+	  if (seq1len == 0 || seq2len == 0)
+	    {
+	      if (seq1len == seq2len)
+		/* Both ended.  So far so good, both strings are equal
+		   at this level.  */
+		break;
+
+	      /* This means one string is shorter than the other.  Find out
+		 which one and return an appropriate value.  */
+	      result = seq1len == 0 ? -1 : 1;
+	      goto free_and_return;
+	    }
+
+	  /* Test for position if necessary.  */
+	  if (position && val1 != val2)
+	    {
+	      result = val1 - val2;
+	      goto free_and_return;
+	    }
+
+	  /* Compare the two sequences.  */
+	  do
+	    {
+	      if (weights[idx1arr[idx1now]] != weights[idx2arr[idx2now]])
+		{
+		  /* The sequences differ.  */
+		  result = (weights[idx1arr[idx1now]]
+			    - weights[idx2arr[idx2now]]);
+		  goto free_and_return;
+		}
+
+	      /* Increment the offsets.  */
+	      ++idx1arr[idx1now];
+	      ++idx2arr[idx2now];
+
+	      --seq1len;
+	      --seq2len;
+	    }
+	  while (seq1len > 0 && seq2len > 0);
+
+	  if (position && seq1len != seq2len)
+	    {
+	      result = seq1len - seq2len;
+	      goto free_and_return;
+	    }
+	}
+    }
+
+  /* Free the memory if needed.  */
+ free_and_return:
+  if (use_malloc)
+    free (idx1arr);
+
+  return result;
+}
+libc_hidden_def (STRCOLL)
+
+#ifndef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
 weak_alias (__strcoll_l, strcoll_l)
+#endif
diff --git a/string/strxfrm.c b/string/strxfrm.c
index 549d68cc1c..840f270675 100644
--- a/string/strxfrm.c
+++ b/string/strxfrm.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1995-1999,2000,2001,2002,2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 1995-1999,2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995.
 
@@ -17,451 +17,17 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#include <assert.h>
-#include <langinfo.h>
-#include <locale.h>
-#include <stddef.h>
-#include <stdint.h>
-#include <stdlib.h>
 #include <string.h>
-#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <locale/localeinfo.h>
 
 #ifndef STRING_TYPE
 # define STRING_TYPE char
-# define USTRING_TYPE unsigned char
-# ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#  define STRXFRM __strxfrm_l
-# else
-#  define STRXFRM strxfrm
-# endif
-# define STRCMP strcmp
-# define STRLEN strlen
-# define STPNCPY __stpncpy
-# define WEIGHT_H "../locale/weight.h"
-# define SUFFIX	MB
-# define L(arg) arg
+# define STRXFRM strxfrm
+# define STRXFRM_L __strxfrm_l
 #endif
 
-#define CONCAT(a,b) CONCAT1(a,b)
-#define CONCAT1(a,b) a##b
-
-#include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
-
-
-#ifndef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
-
-/* We need UTF-8 encoding of numbers.  */
-static int
-utf8_encode (char *buf, int val)
-{
-  int retval;
-
-  if (val < 0x80)
-    {
-      *buf++ = (char) val;
-      retval = 1;
-    }
-  else
-    {
-      int step;
-
-      for (step = 2; step < 6; ++step)
-	if ((val & (~(uint32_t)0 << (5 * step + 1))) == 0)
-	  break;
-      retval = step;
-
-      *buf = (unsigned char) (~0xff >> step);
-      --step;
-      do
-	{
-	  buf[step] = 0x80 | (val & 0x3f);
-	  val >>= 6;
-	}
-      while (--step > 0);
-      *buf |= val;
-    }
-
-  return retval;
-}
-#endif
-
-
-#ifndef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
 size_t
 STRXFRM (STRING_TYPE *dest, const STRING_TYPE *src, size_t n)
-#else
-size_t
-STRXFRM (STRING_TYPE *dest, const STRING_TYPE *src, size_t n, __locale_t l)
-#endif
 {
-#ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-  struct locale_data *current = l->__locales[LC_COLLATE];
-  uint_fast32_t nrules = current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (_NL_COLLATE_NRULES)].word;
-#else
-  uint32_t nrules = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_COLLATE, _NL_COLLATE_NRULES);
-#endif
-  /* We don't assign the following values right away since it might be
-     unnecessary in case there are no rules.  */
-  const unsigned char *rulesets;
-  const int32_t *table;
-  const USTRING_TYPE *weights;
-  const USTRING_TYPE *extra;
-  const int32_t *indirect;
-  uint_fast32_t pass;
-  size_t needed;
-  const USTRING_TYPE *usrc;
-  size_t srclen = STRLEN (src);
-  int32_t *idxarr;
-  unsigned char *rulearr;
-  size_t idxmax;
-  size_t idxcnt;
-  int use_malloc;
-
-#include WEIGHT_H
-
-  if (nrules == 0)
-    {
-      if (n != 0)
-	STPNCPY (dest, src, MIN (srclen + 1, n));
-
-      return srclen;
-    }
-
-#ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-  rulesets = (const unsigned char *)
-    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (_NL_COLLATE_RULESETS)].string;
-  table = (const int32_t *)
-    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_TABLE,SUFFIX))].string;
-  weights = (const USTRING_TYPE *)
-    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_WEIGHT,SUFFIX))].string;
-  extra = (const USTRING_TYPE *)
-    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_EXTRA,SUFFIX))].string;
-  indirect = (const int32_t *)
-    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_INDIRECT,SUFFIX))].string;
-#else
-  rulesets = (const unsigned char *)
-    _NL_CURRENT (LC_COLLATE, _NL_COLLATE_RULESETS);
-  table = (const int32_t *)
-    _NL_CURRENT (LC_COLLATE, CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_TABLE,SUFFIX));
-  weights = (const USTRING_TYPE *)
-    _NL_CURRENT (LC_COLLATE, CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_WEIGHT,SUFFIX));
-  extra = (const USTRING_TYPE *)
-    _NL_CURRENT (LC_COLLATE, CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_EXTRA,SUFFIX));
-  indirect = (const int32_t *)
-    _NL_CURRENT (LC_COLLATE, CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_INDIRECT,SUFFIX));
-#endif
-  use_malloc = 0;
-
-  assert (((uintptr_t) table) % __alignof__ (table[0]) == 0);
-  assert (((uintptr_t) weights) % __alignof__ (weights[0]) == 0);
-  assert (((uintptr_t) extra) % __alignof__ (extra[0]) == 0);
-  assert (((uintptr_t) indirect) % __alignof__ (indirect[0]) == 0);
-
-  /* Handle an empty string as a special case.  */
-  if (srclen == 0)
-    {
-      if (n != 0)
-        *dest = L('\0');
-      return 0;
-    }
-
-  /* We need the elements of the string as unsigned values since they
-     are used as indeces.  */
-  usrc = (const USTRING_TYPE *) src;
-
-  /* Perform the first pass over the string and while doing this find
-     and store the weights for each character.  Since we want this to
-     be as fast as possible we are using `alloca' to store the temporary
-     values.  But since there is no limit on the length of the string
-     we have to use `malloc' if the string is too long.  We should be
-     very conservative here.  */
-  if (! __libc_use_alloca (srclen))
-    {
-      idxarr = (int32_t *) malloc ((srclen + 1) * (sizeof (int32_t) + 1));
-      rulearr = (unsigned char *) &idxarr[srclen];
-
-      if (idxarr == NULL)
-	/* No memory.  Well, go with the stack then.
-
-	   XXX Once this implementation is stable we will handle this
-	   differently.  Instead of precomputing the indeces we will
-	   do this in time.  This means, though, that this happens for
-	   every pass again.  */
-	goto try_stack;
-      use_malloc = 1;
-    }
-  else
-    {
-    try_stack:
-      idxarr = (int32_t *) alloca (srclen * sizeof (int32_t));
-      rulearr = (unsigned char *) alloca (srclen + 1);
-    }
-
-  idxmax = 0;
-  do
-    {
-      int32_t tmp = findidx (&usrc);
-      rulearr[idxmax] = tmp >> 24;
-      idxarr[idxmax] = tmp & 0xffffff;
-
-      ++idxmax;
-    }
-  while (*usrc != L('\0'));
-
-  /* This element is only read, the value never used but to determine
-     another value which then is ignored.  */
-  rulearr[idxmax] = '\0';
-
-  /* Now the passes over the weights.  We now use the indeces we found
-     before.  */
-  needed = 0;
-  for (pass = 0; pass < nrules; ++pass)
-    {
-      size_t backw_stop = ~0ul;
-      int rule = rulesets[rulearr[0] * nrules + pass];
-      /* We assume that if a rule has defined `position' in one section
-	 this is true for all of them.  */
-      int position = rule & sort_position;
-
-      if (position == 0)
-	{
-	  for (idxcnt = 0; idxcnt < idxmax; ++idxcnt)
-	    {
-	      if ((rule & sort_forward) != 0)
-		{
-		  size_t len;
-
-		  if (backw_stop != ~0ul)
-		    {
-		      /* Handle the pushed elements now.  */
-		      size_t backw;
-
-		      for (backw = idxcnt - 1; backw >= backw_stop; --backw)
-			{
-			  len = weights[idxarr[backw]++];
-
-			  if (needed + len < n)
-			    while (len-- > 0)
-			      dest[needed++] = weights[idxarr[backw]++];
-			  else
-			    {
-				/* No more characters fit into the buffer.  */
-			      needed += len;
-			      idxarr[backw] += len;
-			    }
-			}
-
-		      backw_stop = ~0ul;
-		    }
-
-		  /* Now handle the forward element.  */
-		  len = weights[idxarr[idxcnt]++];
-		  if (needed + len < n)
-		    while (len-- > 0)
-		      dest[needed++] = weights[idxarr[idxcnt]++];
-		  else
-		    {
-		      /* No more characters fit into the buffer.  */
-		      needed += len;
-		      idxarr[idxcnt] += len;
-		    }
-		}
-	      else
-		{
-		  /* Remember where the backwards series started.  */
-		  if (backw_stop == ~0ul)
-		    backw_stop = idxcnt;
-		}
-
-	      rule = rulesets[rulearr[idxcnt + 1] * nrules + pass];
-	    }
-
-
-	  if (backw_stop != ~0ul)
-	    {
-	      /* Handle the pushed elements now.  */
-	      size_t backw;
-
-	      backw = idxcnt;
-	      while (backw > backw_stop)
-		{
-		  size_t len = weights[idxarr[--backw]++];
-
-		  if (needed + len < n)
-		    while (len-- > 0)
-		      dest[needed++] = weights[idxarr[backw]++];
-		  else
-		    {
-		      /* No more characters fit into the buffer.  */
-		      needed += len;
-		      idxarr[backw] += len;
-		    }
-		}
-	    }
-	}
-      else
-	{
-	  int val = 1;
-#ifndef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
-	  char buf[7];
-	  size_t buflen;
-#endif
-	  size_t i;
-
-	  for (idxcnt = 0; idxcnt < idxmax; ++idxcnt)
-	    {
-	      if ((rule & sort_forward) != 0)
-		{
-		  size_t len;
-
-		  if (backw_stop != ~0ul)
-		    {
-		     /* Handle the pushed elements now.  */
-		      size_t backw;
-
-		      for (backw = idxcnt - 1; backw >= backw_stop; --backw)
-			{
-			  len = weights[idxarr[backw]++];
-			  if (len != 0)
-			    {
-#ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
-			      if (needed + 1 + len < n)
-				{
-				  dest[needed] = val;
-				  for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
-				    dest[needed + 1 + i] =
-				      weights[idxarr[backw] + i];
-				}
-			      needed += 1 + len;
-#else
-			      buflen = utf8_encode (buf, val);
-			      if (needed + buflen + len < n)
-				{
-				  for (i = 0; i < buflen; ++i)
-				    dest[needed + i] = buf[i];
-				  for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
-				    dest[needed + buflen + i] =
-				      weights[idxarr[backw] + i];
-				}
-			      needed += buflen + len;
-#endif
-			      idxarr[backw] += len;
-			      val = 1;
-			    }
-			  else
-			    ++val;
-			}
-
-		      backw_stop = ~0ul;
-		    }
-
-		  /* Now handle the forward element.  */
-		  len = weights[idxarr[idxcnt]++];
-		  if (len != 0)
-		    {
-#ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
-		      if (needed + 1+ len < n)
-			{
-			  dest[needed] = val;
-			  for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
-			    dest[needed + 1 + i] =
-			      weights[idxarr[idxcnt] + i];
-			}
-		      needed += 1 + len;
-#else
-		      buflen = utf8_encode (buf, val);
-		      if (needed + buflen + len < n)
-			{
-			  for (i = 0; i < buflen; ++i)
-			    dest[needed + i] = buf[i];
-			  for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
-			    dest[needed + buflen + i] =
-			      weights[idxarr[idxcnt] + i];
-			}
-		      needed += buflen + len;
-#endif
-		      idxarr[idxcnt] += len;
-		      val = 1;
-		    }
-		  else
-		    /* Note that we don't have to increment `idxarr[idxcnt]'
-		       since the length is zero.  */
-		    ++val;
-		}
-	      else
-		{
-		  /* Remember where the backwards series started.  */
-		  if (backw_stop == ~0ul)
-		    backw_stop = idxcnt;
-		}
-
-	      rule = rulesets[rulearr[idxcnt + 1] * nrules + pass];
-	    }
-
-	  if (backw_stop != ~0ul)
-	    {
-	      /* Handle the pushed elements now.  */
-	      size_t backw;
-
-	      backw = idxmax - 1;
-	      while (backw > backw_stop)
-		{
-		  size_t len = weights[idxarr[--backw]++];
-		  if (len != 0)
-		    {
-#ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
-		      if (needed + 1 + len < n)
-			{
-			  dest[needed] = val;
-			  for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
-			    dest[needed + 1 + i] =
-			      weights[idxarr[backw] + i];
-			}
-		      needed += 1 + len;
-#else
-		      buflen = utf8_encode (buf, val);
-		      if (needed + buflen + len < n)
-			{
-			  for (i = 0; i < buflen; ++i)
-			    dest[needed + i] = buf[i];
-			  for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
-			    dest[needed + buflen + i] =
-			      weights[idxarr[backw] + i];
-			}
-		      needed += buflen + len;
-#endif
-		      idxarr[backw] += len;
-		      val = 1;
-		    }
-		  else
-		    ++val;
-		}
-	    }
-	}
-
-      /* Finally store the byte to separate the passes or terminate
-	 the string.  */
-      if (needed < n)
-	dest[needed] = pass + 1 < nrules ? L('\1') : L('\0');
-      ++needed;
-    }
-
-  /* This is a little optimization: many collation specifications have
-     a `position' rule at the end and if no non-ignored character
-     is found the last \1 byte is immediately followed by a \0 byte
-     signalling this.  We can avoid the \1 byte(s).  */
-  if (needed <= n && needed > 2 && dest[needed - 2] == L('\1'))
-    {
-      /* Remove the \1 byte.  */
-      --needed;
-      dest[needed - 1] = L('\0');
-    }
-
-  /* Free the memory if needed.  */
-  if (use_malloc)
-    free (idxarr);
-
-  /* Return the number of bytes/words we need, but don't count the NUL
-     byte/word at the end.  */
-  return needed - 1;
+  return STRXFRM_L (dest, src, n, _NL_CURRENT_LOCALE);
 }
diff --git a/string/strxfrm_l.c b/string/strxfrm_l.c
index 264ab9bfe3..44b605168a 100644
--- a/string/strxfrm_l.c
+++ b/string/strxfrm_l.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1995,96,97,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 1995,96,97,2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.org>, 1995.
 
@@ -17,7 +17,430 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
-#include <strxfrm.c>
+#include <assert.h>
+#include <langinfo.h>
+#include <locale.h>
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <stdint.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
 
+#ifndef STRING_TYPE
+# define STRING_TYPE char
+# define USTRING_TYPE unsigned char
+# define STRXFRM __strxfrm_l
+# define STRCMP strcmp
+# define STRLEN strlen
+# define STPNCPY __stpncpy
+# define WEIGHT_H "../locale/weight.h"
+# define SUFFIX	MB
+# define L(arg) arg
+#endif
+
+#define CONCAT(a,b) CONCAT1(a,b)
+#define CONCAT1(a,b) a##b
+
+#include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
+
+
+#ifndef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
+
+/* We need UTF-8 encoding of numbers.  */
+static int
+utf8_encode (char *buf, int val)
+{
+  int retval;
+
+  if (val < 0x80)
+    {
+      *buf++ = (char) val;
+      retval = 1;
+    }
+  else
+    {
+      int step;
+
+      for (step = 2; step < 6; ++step)
+	if ((val & (~(uint32_t)0 << (5 * step + 1))) == 0)
+	  break;
+      retval = step;
+
+      *buf = (unsigned char) (~0xff >> step);
+      --step;
+      do
+	{
+	  buf[step] = 0x80 | (val & 0x3f);
+	  val >>= 6;
+	}
+      while (--step > 0);
+      *buf |= val;
+    }
+
+  return retval;
+}
+#endif
+
+
+size_t
+STRXFRM (STRING_TYPE *dest, const STRING_TYPE *src, size_t n, __locale_t l)
+{
+  struct locale_data *current = l->__locales[LC_COLLATE];
+  uint_fast32_t nrules = current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (_NL_COLLATE_NRULES)].word;
+  /* We don't assign the following values right away since it might be
+     unnecessary in case there are no rules.  */
+  const unsigned char *rulesets;
+  const int32_t *table;
+  const USTRING_TYPE *weights;
+  const USTRING_TYPE *extra;
+  const int32_t *indirect;
+  uint_fast32_t pass;
+  size_t needed;
+  const USTRING_TYPE *usrc;
+  size_t srclen = STRLEN (src);
+  int32_t *idxarr;
+  unsigned char *rulearr;
+  size_t idxmax;
+  size_t idxcnt;
+  int use_malloc;
+
+#include WEIGHT_H
+
+  if (nrules == 0)
+    {
+      if (n != 0)
+	STPNCPY (dest, src, MIN (srclen + 1, n));
+
+      return srclen;
+    }
+
+  rulesets = (const unsigned char *)
+    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (_NL_COLLATE_RULESETS)].string;
+  table = (const int32_t *)
+    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_TABLE,SUFFIX))].string;
+  weights = (const USTRING_TYPE *)
+    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_WEIGHT,SUFFIX))].string;
+  extra = (const USTRING_TYPE *)
+    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_EXTRA,SUFFIX))].string;
+  indirect = (const int32_t *)
+    current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_INDIRECT,SUFFIX))].string;
+  use_malloc = 0;
+
+  assert (((uintptr_t) table) % __alignof__ (table[0]) == 0);
+  assert (((uintptr_t) weights) % __alignof__ (weights[0]) == 0);
+  assert (((uintptr_t) extra) % __alignof__ (extra[0]) == 0);
+  assert (((uintptr_t) indirect) % __alignof__ (indirect[0]) == 0);
+
+  /* Handle an empty string as a special case.  */
+  if (srclen == 0)
+    {
+      if (n != 0)
+        *dest = L('\0');
+      return 0;
+    }
+
+  /* We need the elements of the string as unsigned values since they
+     are used as indeces.  */
+  usrc = (const USTRING_TYPE *) src;
+
+  /* Perform the first pass over the string and while doing this find
+     and store the weights for each character.  Since we want this to
+     be as fast as possible we are using `alloca' to store the temporary
+     values.  But since there is no limit on the length of the string
+     we have to use `malloc' if the string is too long.  We should be
+     very conservative here.  */
+  if (! __libc_use_alloca (srclen))
+    {
+      idxarr = (int32_t *) malloc ((srclen + 1) * (sizeof (int32_t) + 1));
+      rulearr = (unsigned char *) &idxarr[srclen];
+
+      if (idxarr == NULL)
+	/* No memory.  Well, go with the stack then.
+
+	   XXX Once this implementation is stable we will handle this
+	   differently.  Instead of precomputing the indeces we will
+	   do this in time.  This means, though, that this happens for
+	   every pass again.  */
+	goto try_stack;
+      use_malloc = 1;
+    }
+  else
+    {
+    try_stack:
+      idxarr = (int32_t *) alloca (srclen * sizeof (int32_t));
+      rulearr = (unsigned char *) alloca (srclen + 1);
+    }
+
+  idxmax = 0;
+  do
+    {
+      int32_t tmp = findidx (&usrc);
+      rulearr[idxmax] = tmp >> 24;
+      idxarr[idxmax] = tmp & 0xffffff;
+
+      ++idxmax;
+    }
+  while (*usrc != L('\0'));
+
+  /* This element is only read, the value never used but to determine
+     another value which then is ignored.  */
+  rulearr[idxmax] = '\0';
+
+  /* Now the passes over the weights.  We now use the indeces we found
+     before.  */
+  needed = 0;
+  for (pass = 0; pass < nrules; ++pass)
+    {
+      size_t backw_stop = ~0ul;
+      int rule = rulesets[rulearr[0] * nrules + pass];
+      /* We assume that if a rule has defined `position' in one section
+	 this is true for all of them.  */
+      int position = rule & sort_position;
+
+      if (position == 0)
+	{
+	  for (idxcnt = 0; idxcnt < idxmax; ++idxcnt)
+	    {
+	      if ((rule & sort_forward) != 0)
+		{
+		  size_t len;
+
+		  if (backw_stop != ~0ul)
+		    {
+		      /* Handle the pushed elements now.  */
+		      size_t backw;
+
+		      for (backw = idxcnt - 1; backw >= backw_stop; --backw)
+			{
+			  len = weights[idxarr[backw]++];
+
+			  if (needed + len < n)
+			    while (len-- > 0)
+			      dest[needed++] = weights[idxarr[backw]++];
+			  else
+			    {
+				/* No more characters fit into the buffer.  */
+			      needed += len;
+			      idxarr[backw] += len;
+			    }
+			}
+
+		      backw_stop = ~0ul;
+		    }
+
+		  /* Now handle the forward element.  */
+		  len = weights[idxarr[idxcnt]++];
+		  if (needed + len < n)
+		    while (len-- > 0)
+		      dest[needed++] = weights[idxarr[idxcnt]++];
+		  else
+		    {
+		      /* No more characters fit into the buffer.  */
+		      needed += len;
+		      idxarr[idxcnt] += len;
+		    }
+		}
+	      else
+		{
+		  /* Remember where the backwards series started.  */
+		  if (backw_stop == ~0ul)
+		    backw_stop = idxcnt;
+		}
+
+	      rule = rulesets[rulearr[idxcnt + 1] * nrules + pass];
+	    }
+
+
+	  if (backw_stop != ~0ul)
+	    {
+	      /* Handle the pushed elements now.  */
+	      size_t backw;
+
+	      backw = idxcnt;
+	      while (backw > backw_stop)
+		{
+		  size_t len = weights[idxarr[--backw]++];
+
+		  if (needed + len < n)
+		    while (len-- > 0)
+		      dest[needed++] = weights[idxarr[backw]++];
+		  else
+		    {
+		      /* No more characters fit into the buffer.  */
+		      needed += len;
+		      idxarr[backw] += len;
+		    }
+		}
+	    }
+	}
+      else
+	{
+	  int val = 1;
+#ifndef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
+	  char buf[7];
+	  size_t buflen;
+#endif
+	  size_t i;
+
+	  for (idxcnt = 0; idxcnt < idxmax; ++idxcnt)
+	    {
+	      if ((rule & sort_forward) != 0)
+		{
+		  size_t len;
+
+		  if (backw_stop != ~0ul)
+		    {
+		     /* Handle the pushed elements now.  */
+		      size_t backw;
+
+		      for (backw = idxcnt - 1; backw >= backw_stop; --backw)
+			{
+			  len = weights[idxarr[backw]++];
+			  if (len != 0)
+			    {
+#ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
+			      if (needed + 1 + len < n)
+				{
+				  dest[needed] = val;
+				  for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
+				    dest[needed + 1 + i] =
+				      weights[idxarr[backw] + i];
+				}
+			      needed += 1 + len;
+#else
+			      buflen = utf8_encode (buf, val);
+			      if (needed + buflen + len < n)
+				{
+				  for (i = 0; i < buflen; ++i)
+				    dest[needed + i] = buf[i];
+				  for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
+				    dest[needed + buflen + i] =
+				      weights[idxarr[backw] + i];
+				}
+			      needed += buflen + len;
+#endif
+			      idxarr[backw] += len;
+			      val = 1;
+			    }
+			  else
+			    ++val;
+			}
+
+		      backw_stop = ~0ul;
+		    }
+
+		  /* Now handle the forward element.  */
+		  len = weights[idxarr[idxcnt]++];
+		  if (len != 0)
+		    {
+#ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
+		      if (needed + 1+ len < n)
+			{
+			  dest[needed] = val;
+			  for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
+			    dest[needed + 1 + i] =
+			      weights[idxarr[idxcnt] + i];
+			}
+		      needed += 1 + len;
+#else
+		      buflen = utf8_encode (buf, val);
+		      if (needed + buflen + len < n)
+			{
+			  for (i = 0; i < buflen; ++i)
+			    dest[needed + i] = buf[i];
+			  for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
+			    dest[needed + buflen + i] =
+			      weights[idxarr[idxcnt] + i];
+			}
+		      needed += buflen + len;
+#endif
+		      idxarr[idxcnt] += len;
+		      val = 1;
+		    }
+		  else
+		    /* Note that we don't have to increment `idxarr[idxcnt]'
+		       since the length is zero.  */
+		    ++val;
+		}
+	      else
+		{
+		  /* Remember where the backwards series started.  */
+		  if (backw_stop == ~0ul)
+		    backw_stop = idxcnt;
+		}
+
+	      rule = rulesets[rulearr[idxcnt + 1] * nrules + pass];
+	    }
+
+	  if (backw_stop != ~0ul)
+	    {
+	      /* Handle the pushed elements now.  */
+	      size_t backw;
+
+	      backw = idxmax - 1;
+	      while (backw > backw_stop)
+		{
+		  size_t len = weights[idxarr[--backw]++];
+		  if (len != 0)
+		    {
+#ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
+		      if (needed + 1 + len < n)
+			{
+			  dest[needed] = val;
+			  for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
+			    dest[needed + 1 + i] =
+			      weights[idxarr[backw] + i];
+			}
+		      needed += 1 + len;
+#else
+		      buflen = utf8_encode (buf, val);
+		      if (needed + buflen + len < n)
+			{
+			  for (i = 0; i < buflen; ++i)
+			    dest[needed + i] = buf[i];
+			  for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
+			    dest[needed + buflen + i] =
+			      weights[idxarr[backw] + i];
+			}
+		      needed += buflen + len;
+#endif
+		      idxarr[backw] += len;
+		      val = 1;
+		    }
+		  else
+		    ++val;
+		}
+	    }
+	}
+
+      /* Finally store the byte to separate the passes or terminate
+	 the string.  */
+      if (needed < n)
+	dest[needed] = pass + 1 < nrules ? L('\1') : L('\0');
+      ++needed;
+    }
+
+  /* This is a little optimization: many collation specifications have
+     a `position' rule at the end and if no non-ignored character
+     is found the last \1 byte is immediately followed by a \0 byte
+     signalling this.  We can avoid the \1 byte(s).  */
+  if (needed <= n && needed > 2 && dest[needed - 2] == L('\1'))
+    {
+      /* Remove the \1 byte.  */
+      --needed;
+      dest[needed - 1] = L('\0');
+    }
+
+  /* Free the memory if needed.  */
+  if (use_malloc)
+    free (idxarr);
+
+  /* Return the number of bytes/words we need, but don't count the NUL
+     byte/word at the end.  */
+  return needed - 1;
+}
+libc_hidden_def (STRXFRM)
+
+#ifndef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
 weak_alias (__strxfrm_l, strxfrm_l)
+#endif
diff --git a/sysdeps/generic/strtol.c b/sysdeps/generic/strtol.c
index 953c6c4a90..02ec19aabe 100644
--- a/sysdeps/generic/strtol.c
+++ b/sysdeps/generic/strtol.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert string representation of a number into an integer value.
-   Copyright (C) 1991,92,94,95,96,97,98,99,2000,2001,2002,2003
+   Copyright (C) 1991,92,94,95,96,97,98,99,2000,2001,2002,2003,2004
    	Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
 
@@ -18,46 +18,10 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
-# include <config.h>
-#endif
-
-#ifdef _LIBC
-# define USE_NUMBER_GROUPING
-# define STDC_HEADERS
-# define HAVE_LIMITS_H
-#endif
-
-#include <ctype.h>
-#include <errno.h>
-#ifndef errno
-extern int errno;
-#endif
-#ifndef __set_errno
-# define __set_errno(Val) errno = (Val)
-#endif
-
-#ifdef HAVE_LIMITS_H
-# include <limits.h>
-#endif
-
-#ifdef STDC_HEADERS
-# include <stddef.h>
-# include <stdlib.h>
-# include <string.h>
-# include <locale.h>
-#else
-# ifndef NULL
-#  define NULL 0
-# endif
-#endif
-
-#ifdef USE_NUMBER_GROUPING
-# include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
-#endif
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <wchar.h>
+#include <locale/localeinfo.h>
 
-/* Nonzero if we are defining `strtoul' or `strtoull', operating on
-   unsigned integers.  */
 #ifndef UNSIGNED
 # define UNSIGNED 0
 # define INT LONG int
@@ -65,508 +29,83 @@ extern int errno;
 # define INT unsigned LONG int
 #endif
 
-/* Determine the name.  */
-#ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-# if UNSIGNED
-#  ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-#   ifdef QUAD
-#    define strtol __wcstoull_l
-#   else
-#    define strtol __wcstoul_l
-#   endif
+#if UNSIGNED
+# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+#  ifdef QUAD
+#   define strtol wcstoull
+#   define __strtol_l __wcstoull_l
 #  else
-#   ifdef QUAD
-#    define strtol __strtoull_l
-#   else
-#    define strtol __strtoul_l
-#   endif
+#   define strtol wcstoul
+#   define __strtol_l __wcstoul_l
 #  endif
 # else
-#  ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-#   ifdef QUAD
-#    define strtol __wcstoll_l
-#   else
-#    define strtol __wcstol_l
-#   endif
+#  ifdef QUAD
+#   define strtol strtoull
+#   define __strtol_l __strtoull_l
 #  else
-#   ifdef QUAD
-#    define strtol __strtoll_l
-#   else
-#    define strtol __strtol_l
-#   endif
+#   define strtol strtoul
+#   define __strtol_l __strtoul_l
 #  endif
 # endif
 #else
-# if UNSIGNED
-#  ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-#   ifdef QUAD
-#    define strtol wcstoull
-#   else
-#    define strtol wcstoul
-#   endif
+# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+#  ifdef QUAD
+#   define strtol wcstoll
+#   define __strtol_l __wcstoll_l
 #  else
-#   ifdef QUAD
-#    define strtol strtoull
-#   else
-#    define strtol strtoul
-#   endif
+#   define strtol wcstol
+#   define __strtol_l __wcstol_l
 #  endif
 # else
-#  ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-#   ifdef QUAD
-#    define strtol wcstoll
-#   else
-#    define strtol wcstol
-#   endif
-#  else
-#   ifdef QUAD
-#    define strtol strtoll
-#   endif
+#  ifdef QUAD
+#   define strtol strtoll
+#   define __strtol_l __strtoll_l
 #  endif
 # endif
 #endif
 
+
 /* If QUAD is defined, we are defining `strtoll' or `strtoull',
    operating on `long long int's.  */
 #ifdef QUAD
 # define LONG long long
-# define STRTOL_LONG_MIN LONG_LONG_MIN
-# define STRTOL_LONG_MAX LONG_LONG_MAX
-# define STRTOL_ULONG_MAX ULONG_LONG_MAX
-# if __GNUC__ == 2 && __GNUC_MINOR__ < 7
-   /* Work around gcc bug with using this constant.  */
-   static const unsigned long long int maxquad = ULONG_LONG_MAX;
-#  undef STRTOL_ULONG_MAX
-#  define STRTOL_ULONG_MAX maxquad
-# endif
 #else
 # define LONG long
-
-# ifndef ULONG_MAX
-#  define ULONG_MAX ((unsigned long) ~(unsigned long) 0)
-# endif
-# ifndef LONG_MAX
-#  define LONG_MAX ((long int) (ULONG_MAX >> 1))
-# endif
-# define STRTOL_LONG_MIN LONG_MIN
-# define STRTOL_LONG_MAX LONG_MAX
-# define STRTOL_ULONG_MAX ULONG_MAX
-#endif
-
-
-/* We use this code also for the extended locale handling where the
-   function gets as an additional argument the locale which has to be
-   used.  To access the values we have to redefine the _NL_CURRENT
-   macro.  */
-#ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-# undef _NL_CURRENT
-# define _NL_CURRENT(category, item) \
-  (current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (item)].string)
-# define LOCALE_PARAM , loc
-# define LOCALE_PARAM_DECL __locale_t loc;
-#else
-# define LOCALE_PARAM
-# define LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
 #endif
 
-#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_WCHAR_H
-# include <wchar.h>
-#endif
 
 #ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-# include <wctype.h>
-# define L_(Ch) L##Ch
-# define UCHAR_TYPE wint_t
 # define STRING_TYPE wchar_t
-# ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#  define ISSPACE(Ch) __iswspace_l ((Ch), loc)
-#  define ISALPHA(Ch) __iswalpha_l ((Ch), loc)
-#  define TOUPPER(Ch) __towupper_l ((Ch), loc)
-# else
-#  define ISSPACE(Ch) iswspace (Ch)
-#  define ISALPHA(Ch) iswalpha (Ch)
-#  define TOUPPER(Ch) towupper (Ch)
-# endif
-# else
-#  if defined _LIBC \
-   || defined STDC_HEADERS || (!defined isascii && !defined HAVE_ISASCII)
-#   define IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN(c) 1
-#  else
-#   define IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN(c) isascii(c)
-#  endif
-#  define L_(Ch) Ch
-#  define UCHAR_TYPE unsigned char
-#  define STRING_TYPE char
-# ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#  define ISSPACE(Ch) __isspace_l ((Ch), loc)
-#  define ISALPHA(Ch) __isalpha_l ((Ch), loc)
-#  define TOUPPER(Ch) __toupper_l ((Ch), loc)
-# else
-#  define ISSPACE(Ch) (IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN (Ch) && isspace (Ch))
-#  define ISALPHA(Ch) (IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN (Ch) && isalpha (Ch))
-#  define TOUPPER(Ch) (IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN (Ch) ? toupper (Ch) : (Ch))
-# endif
-#endif
-
-#ifdef __STDC__
-# define INTERNAL(X) INTERNAL1(X)
-# define INTERNAL1(X) __##X##_internal
-# define WEAKNAME(X) WEAKNAME1(X)
 #else
-# define INTERNAL(X) __/**/X/**/_internal
+# define STRING_TYPE char
 #endif
 
-#ifdef USE_NUMBER_GROUPING
-/* This file defines a function to check for correct grouping.  */
-# include "grouping.h"
-#endif
+
+#define INTERNAL(X) INTERNAL1(X)
+#define INTERNAL1(X) __##X##_internal
 
 
+extern INT INTERNAL (__strtol_l) (const STRING_TYPE *, STRING_TYPE **, int,
+				  int, __locale_t);
 
-/* Convert NPTR to an `unsigned long int' or `long int' in base BASE.
-   If BASE is 0 the base is determined by the presence of a leading
-   zero, indicating octal or a leading "0x" or "0X", indicating hexadecimal.
-   If BASE is < 2 or > 36, it is reset to 10.
-   If ENDPTR is not NULL, a pointer to the character after the last
-   one converted is stored in *ENDPTR.  */
 
 INT
-INTERNAL (strtol) (nptr, endptr, base, group LOCALE_PARAM)
+INTERNAL (strtol) (nptr, endptr, base, group)
      const STRING_TYPE *nptr;
      STRING_TYPE **endptr;
      int base;
      int group;
-     LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
 {
-  int negative;
-  register unsigned LONG int cutoff;
-  register unsigned int cutlim;
-  register unsigned LONG int i;
-  register const STRING_TYPE *s;
-  register UCHAR_TYPE c;
-  const STRING_TYPE *save, *end;
-  int overflow;
-#ifndef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-  size_t cnt;
-#endif
-
-#ifdef USE_NUMBER_GROUPING
-# ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-  struct locale_data *current = loc->__locales[LC_NUMERIC];
-# endif
-  /* The thousands character of the current locale.  */
-# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-  wchar_t thousands = L'\0';
-# else
-  const char *thousands = NULL;
-  size_t thousands_len = 0;
-# endif
-  /* The numeric grouping specification of the current locale,
-     in the format described in <locale.h>.  */
-  const char *grouping;
-
-  if (__builtin_expect (group, 0))
-    {
-      grouping = _NL_CURRENT (LC_NUMERIC, GROUPING);
-      if (*grouping <= 0 || *grouping == CHAR_MAX)
-	grouping = NULL;
-      else
-	{
-	  /* Figure out the thousands separator character.  */
-# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-#  ifdef _LIBC
-	  thousands = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_NUMERIC,
-					_NL_NUMERIC_THOUSANDS_SEP_WC);
-#  endif
-	  if (thousands == L'\0')
-	    grouping = NULL;
-# else
-#  ifdef _LIBC
-	  thousands = _NL_CURRENT (LC_NUMERIC, THOUSANDS_SEP);
-#  endif
-	  if (*thousands == '\0')
-	    {
-	      thousands = NULL;
-	      grouping = NULL;
-	    }
-# endif
-	}
-    }
-  else
-    grouping = NULL;
-#endif
-
-  if (base < 0 || base == 1 || base > 36)
-    {
-      __set_errno (EINVAL);
-      return 0;
-    }
-
-  save = s = nptr;
-
-  /* Skip white space.  */
-  while (ISSPACE (*s))
-    ++s;
-  if (__builtin_expect (*s == L_('\0'), 0))
-    goto noconv;
-
-  /* Check for a sign.  */
-  negative = 0;
-  if (*s == L_('-'))
-    {
-      negative = 1;
-      ++s;
-    }
-  else if (*s == L_('+'))
-    ++s;
-
-  /* Recognize number prefix and if BASE is zero, figure it out ourselves.  */
-  if (*s == L_('0'))
-    {
-      if ((base == 0 || base == 16) && TOUPPER (s[1]) == L_('X'))
-	{
-	  s += 2;
-	  base = 16;
-	}
-      else if (base == 0)
-	base = 8;
-    }
-  else if (base == 0)
-    base = 10;
-
-  /* Save the pointer so we can check later if anything happened.  */
-  save = s;
-
-#ifdef USE_NUMBER_GROUPING
-  if (base != 10)
-    grouping = NULL;
-
-  if (__builtin_expect (grouping != NULL, 0))
-    {
-# ifndef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-      thousands_len = strlen (thousands);
-# endif
-
-      /* Find the end of the digit string and check its grouping.  */
-      end = s;
-      if (
-# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-	  *s != thousands
-# else
-	  ({ for (cnt = 0; cnt < thousands_len; ++cnt)
-	       if (thousands[cnt] != end[cnt])
-		 break;
-	     cnt < thousands_len; })
-# endif
-	  )
-	{
-	  for (c = *end; c != L_('\0'); c = *++end)
-	    if (((STRING_TYPE) c < L_('0') || (STRING_TYPE) c > L_('9'))
-# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-		&& (wchar_t) c != thousands
-# else
-		&& ({ for (cnt = 0; cnt < thousands_len; ++cnt)
-		      if (thousands[cnt] != end[cnt])
-			break;
-		      cnt < thousands_len; })
-# endif
-		&& (!ISALPHA (c)
-		    || (int) (TOUPPER (c) - L_('A') + 10) >= base))
-	      break;
-
-# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-	  end = __correctly_grouped_prefixwc (s, end, thousands, grouping);
-# else
-	  end = __correctly_grouped_prefixmb (s, end, thousands, grouping);
-# endif
-	}
-    }
-  else
-#endif
-    end = NULL;
-
-  cutoff = STRTOL_ULONG_MAX / (unsigned LONG int) base;
-  cutlim = STRTOL_ULONG_MAX % (unsigned LONG int) base;
-
-  overflow = 0;
-  i = 0;
-  c = *s;
-  if (sizeof (long int) != sizeof (LONG int))
-    {
-      unsigned long int j = 0;
-      unsigned long int jmax = ULONG_MAX / base;
-
-      for (;c != L_('\0'); c = *++s)
-	{
-	  if (s == end)
-	    break;
-	  if (c >= L_('0') && c <= L_('9'))
-	    c -= L_('0');
-#ifdef USE_NUMBER_GROUPING
-# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-	  else if (grouping && (wchar_t) c == thousands)
-	    continue;
-# else
-	  else if (thousands_len)
-	    {
-	      for (cnt = 0; cnt < thousands_len; ++cnt)
-		if (thousands[cnt] != s[cnt])
-		  break;
-	      if (cnt == thousands_len)
-		{
-		  s += thousands_len - 1;
-		  continue;
-		}
-	      if (ISALPHA (c))
-		c = TOUPPER (c) - L_('A') + 10;
-	      else
-		break;
-	    }
-# endif
-#endif
-	  else if (ISALPHA (c))
-	    c = TOUPPER (c) - L_('A') + 10;
-	  else
-	    break;
-	  if ((int) c >= base)
-	    break;
-	  /* Note that we never can have an overflow.  */
-	  else if (j >= jmax)
-	    {
-	      /* We have an overflow.  Now use the long representation.  */
-	      i = (unsigned LONG int) j;
-	      goto use_long;
-	    }
-	  else
-	    j = j * (unsigned long int) base + c;
-	}
-
-      i = (unsigned LONG int) j;
-    }
-  else
-    for (;c != L_('\0'); c = *++s)
-      {
-	if (s == end)
-	  break;
-	if (c >= L_('0') && c <= L_('9'))
-	  c -= L_('0');
-#ifdef USE_NUMBER_GROUPING
-# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
-	else if (grouping && (wchar_t) c == thousands)
-	  continue;
-# else
-	else if (thousands_len)
-	  {
-	    for (cnt = 0; cnt < thousands_len; ++cnt)
-	      if (thousands[cnt] != s[cnt])
-		break;
-	    if (cnt == thousands_len)
-	      {
-		s += thousands_len - 1;
-		continue;
-	      }
-	    if (ISALPHA (c))
-	      c = TOUPPER (c) - L_('A') + 10;
-	    else
-	      break;
-	  }
-# endif
-#endif
-	else if (ISALPHA (c))
-	  c = TOUPPER (c) - L_('A') + 10;
-	else
-	  break;
-	if ((int) c >= base)
-	  break;
-	/* Check for overflow.  */
-	if (i > cutoff || (i == cutoff && c > cutlim))
-	  overflow = 1;
-	else
-	  {
-	  use_long:
-	    i *= (unsigned LONG int) base;
-	    i += c;
-	  }
-      }
-
-  /* Check if anything actually happened.  */
-  if (s == save)
-    goto noconv;
-
-  /* Store in ENDPTR the address of one character
-     past the last character we converted.  */
-  if (endptr != NULL)
-    *endptr = (STRING_TYPE *) s;
-
-#if !UNSIGNED
-  /* Check for a value that is within the range of
-     `unsigned LONG int', but outside the range of `LONG int'.  */
-  if (overflow == 0
-      && i > (negative
-	      ? -((unsigned LONG int) (STRTOL_LONG_MIN + 1)) + 1
-	      : (unsigned LONG int) STRTOL_LONG_MAX))
-    overflow = 1;
-#endif
-
-  if (__builtin_expect (overflow, 0))
-    {
-      __set_errno (ERANGE);
-#if UNSIGNED
-      return STRTOL_ULONG_MAX;
-#else
-      return negative ? STRTOL_LONG_MIN : STRTOL_LONG_MAX;
-#endif
-    }
-
-  /* Return the result of the appropriate sign.  */
-  return negative ? -i : i;
-
-noconv:
-  /* We must handle a special case here: the base is 0 or 16 and the
-     first two characters are '0' and 'x', but the rest are no
-     hexadecimal digits.  This is no error case.  We return 0 and
-     ENDPTR points to the `x`.  */
-  if (endptr != NULL)
-    {
-      if (save - nptr >= 2 && TOUPPER (save[-1]) == L_('X')
-	  && save[-2] == L_('0'))
-	*endptr = (STRING_TYPE *) &save[-1];
-      else
-	/*  There was no number to convert.  */
-	*endptr = (STRING_TYPE *) nptr;
-    }
-
-  return 0L;
+  return INTERNAL (__strtol_l) (nptr, endptr, base, group, _NL_CURRENT_LOCALE);
 }
-#if defined _LIBC \
-    && !(defined USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL && defined USE_WIDE_CHAR)
 libc_hidden_def (INTERNAL (strtol))
-#endif
-
-/* External user entry point.  */
-
-#if _LIBC - 0 == 0
-# undef PARAMS
-# if defined (__STDC__) && __STDC__
-#  define PARAMS(Args) Args
-# else
-#  define PARAMS(Args) ()
-# endif
-
-/* Prototype.  */
-INT strtol PARAMS ((const STRING_TYPE *nptr, STRING_TYPE **endptr, int base));
-#endif
 
 
 INT
-#ifdef weak_function
-weak_function
-#endif
-strtol (nptr, endptr, base LOCALE_PARAM)
+strtol (nptr, endptr, base)
      const STRING_TYPE *nptr;
      STRING_TYPE **endptr;
      int base;
-     LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
 {
-  return INTERNAL (strtol) (nptr, endptr, base, 0 LOCALE_PARAM);
+  return INTERNAL (__strtol_l) (nptr, endptr, base, 0, _NL_CURRENT_LOCALE);
 }
diff --git a/sysdeps/generic/strtol_l.c b/sysdeps/generic/strtol_l.c
index e4c3140a03..a3800d6f78 100644
--- a/sysdeps/generic/strtol_l.c
+++ b/sysdeps/generic/strtol_l.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert string representing a number to integer value, using given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1997, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1997, 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1997.
 
@@ -18,13 +18,496 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
 
+#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define USE_NUMBER_GROUPING
+# define STDC_HEADERS
+# define HAVE_LIMITS_H
+#endif
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#ifndef __set_errno
+# define __set_errno(Val) errno = (Val)
+#endif
+
+#ifdef HAVE_LIMITS_H
+# include <limits.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <locale.h>
 #include <xlocale.h>
 
-extern long int ____strtol_l_internal (const char *, char **, int, int,
-				       __locale_t);
+#ifdef USE_NUMBER_GROUPING
+# include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
+#endif
+
+/* Nonzero if we are defining `strtoul' or `strtoull', operating on
+   unsigned integers.  */
+#ifndef UNSIGNED
+# define UNSIGNED 0
+# define INT LONG int
+#else
+# define INT unsigned LONG int
+#endif
+
+/* Determine the name.  */
+#if UNSIGNED
+# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+#  ifdef QUAD
+#   define strtol_l wcstoull_l
+#  else
+#   define strtol_l wcstoul_l
+#  endif
+# else
+#  ifdef QUAD
+#   define strtol_l strtoull_l
+#  else
+#   define strtol_l strtoul_l
+#  endif
+# endif
+#else
+# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+#  ifdef QUAD
+#   define strtol_l wcstoll_l
+#  else
+#   define strtol_l wcstol_l
+#  endif
+# else
+#  ifdef QUAD
+#   define strtol_l strtoll_l
+#  else
+#   define strtol_l strtol_l
+#  endif
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#define __strtol_l __strtol_l2(strtol_l)
+#define __strtol_l2(name) __strtol_l3(name)
+#define __strtol_l3(name) __##name
+
+
+/* If QUAD is defined, we are defining `strtoll' or `strtoull',
+   operating on `long long int's.  */
+#ifdef QUAD
+# define LONG long long
+# define STRTOL_LONG_MIN LONG_LONG_MIN
+# define STRTOL_LONG_MAX LONG_LONG_MAX
+# define STRTOL_ULONG_MAX ULONG_LONG_MAX
+#else
+# define LONG long
+
+# ifndef ULONG_MAX
+#  define ULONG_MAX ((unsigned long int) ~(unsigned long int) 0)
+# endif
+# ifndef LONG_MAX
+#  define LONG_MAX ((long int) (ULONG_MAX >> 1))
+# endif
+# define STRTOL_LONG_MIN LONG_MIN
+# define STRTOL_LONG_MAX LONG_MAX
+# define STRTOL_ULONG_MAX ULONG_MAX
+#endif
+
+
+/* We use this code for the extended locale handling where the
+   function gets as an additional argument the locale which has to be
+   used.  To access the values we have to redefine the _NL_CURRENT and
+   _NL_CURRENT_WORD macros.  */
+#undef _NL_CURRENT
+#define _NL_CURRENT(category, item) \
+  (current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (item)].string)
+#undef _NL_CURRENT_WORD
+#define _NL_CURRENT_WORD(category, item) \
+  ((uint32_t) current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (item)].word)
+
+#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_WCHAR_H
+# include <wchar.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+# include <wctype.h>
+# define L_(Ch) L##Ch
+# define UCHAR_TYPE wint_t
+# define STRING_TYPE wchar_t
+# define ISSPACE(Ch) __iswspace_l ((Ch), loc)
+# define ISALPHA(Ch) __iswalpha_l ((Ch), loc)
+# define TOUPPER(Ch) __towupper_l ((Ch), loc)
+#else
+# if defined _LIBC \
+   || defined STDC_HEADERS || (!defined isascii && !defined HAVE_ISASCII)
+#  define IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN(c) 1
+# else
+#  define IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN(c) isascii(c)
+# endif
+# define L_(Ch) Ch
+# define UCHAR_TYPE unsigned char
+# define STRING_TYPE char
+# define ISSPACE(Ch) __isspace_l ((Ch), loc)
+# define ISALPHA(Ch) __isalpha_l ((Ch), loc)
+# define TOUPPER(Ch) __toupper_l ((Ch), loc)
+#endif
+
+#define INTERNAL(X) INTERNAL1(X)
+#define INTERNAL1(X) __##X##_internal
+#define WEAKNAME(X) WEAKNAME1(X)
+
+#ifdef USE_NUMBER_GROUPING
+/* This file defines a function to check for correct grouping.  */
+# include "grouping.h"
+#endif
+
+
+
+/* Convert NPTR to an `unsigned long int' or `long int' in base BASE.
+   If BASE is 0 the base is determined by the presence of a leading
+   zero, indicating octal or a leading "0x" or "0X", indicating hexadecimal.
+   If BASE is < 2 or > 36, it is reset to 10.
+   If ENDPTR is not NULL, a pointer to the character after the last
+   one converted is stored in *ENDPTR.  */
+
+INT
+INTERNAL (__strtol_l) (nptr, endptr, base, group, loc)
+     const STRING_TYPE *nptr;
+     STRING_TYPE **endptr;
+     int base;
+     int group;
+     __locale_t loc;
+{
+  int negative;
+  register unsigned LONG int cutoff;
+  register unsigned int cutlim;
+  register unsigned LONG int i;
+  register const STRING_TYPE *s;
+  register UCHAR_TYPE c;
+  const STRING_TYPE *save, *end;
+  int overflow;
+#ifndef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+  size_t cnt;
+#endif
+
+#ifdef USE_NUMBER_GROUPING
+  struct locale_data *current = loc->__locales[LC_NUMERIC];
+  /* The thousands character of the current locale.  */
+# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+  wchar_t thousands = L'\0';
+# else
+  const char *thousands = NULL;
+  size_t thousands_len = 0;
+# endif
+  /* The numeric grouping specification of the current locale,
+     in the format described in <locale.h>.  */
+  const char *grouping;
+
+  if (__builtin_expect (group, 0))
+    {
+      grouping = _NL_CURRENT (LC_NUMERIC, GROUPING);
+      if (*grouping <= 0 || *grouping == CHAR_MAX)
+	grouping = NULL;
+      else
+	{
+	  /* Figure out the thousands separator character.  */
+# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+#  ifdef _LIBC
+	  thousands = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_NUMERIC,
+					_NL_NUMERIC_THOUSANDS_SEP_WC);
+#  endif
+	  if (thousands == L'\0')
+	    grouping = NULL;
+# else
+#  ifdef _LIBC
+	  thousands = _NL_CURRENT (LC_NUMERIC, THOUSANDS_SEP);
+#  endif
+	  if (*thousands == '\0')
+	    {
+	      thousands = NULL;
+	      grouping = NULL;
+	    }
+# endif
+	}
+    }
+  else
+    grouping = NULL;
+#endif
+
+  if (base < 0 || base == 1 || base > 36)
+    {
+      __set_errno (EINVAL);
+      return 0;
+    }
+
+  save = s = nptr;
+
+  /* Skip white space.  */
+  while (ISSPACE (*s))
+    ++s;
+  if (__builtin_expect (*s == L_('\0'), 0))
+    goto noconv;
+
+  /* Check for a sign.  */
+  negative = 0;
+  if (*s == L_('-'))
+    {
+      negative = 1;
+      ++s;
+    }
+  else if (*s == L_('+'))
+    ++s;
+
+  /* Recognize number prefix and if BASE is zero, figure it out ourselves.  */
+  if (*s == L_('0'))
+    {
+      if ((base == 0 || base == 16) && TOUPPER (s[1]) == L_('X'))
+	{
+	  s += 2;
+	  base = 16;
+	}
+      else if (base == 0)
+	base = 8;
+    }
+  else if (base == 0)
+    base = 10;
+
+  /* Save the pointer so we can check later if anything happened.  */
+  save = s;
+
+#ifdef USE_NUMBER_GROUPING
+  if (base != 10)
+    grouping = NULL;
+
+  if (__builtin_expect (grouping != NULL, 0))
+    {
+# ifndef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+      thousands_len = strlen (thousands);
+# endif
+
+      /* Find the end of the digit string and check its grouping.  */
+      end = s;
+      if (
+# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+	  *s != thousands
+# else
+	  ({ for (cnt = 0; cnt < thousands_len; ++cnt)
+	       if (thousands[cnt] != end[cnt])
+		 break;
+	     cnt < thousands_len; })
+# endif
+	  )
+	{
+	  for (c = *end; c != L_('\0'); c = *++end)
+	    if (((STRING_TYPE) c < L_('0') || (STRING_TYPE) c > L_('9'))
+# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+		&& (wchar_t) c != thousands
+# else
+		&& ({ for (cnt = 0; cnt < thousands_len; ++cnt)
+		      if (thousands[cnt] != end[cnt])
+			break;
+		      cnt < thousands_len; })
+# endif
+		&& (!ISALPHA (c)
+		    || (int) (TOUPPER (c) - L_('A') + 10) >= base))
+	      break;
+
+# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+	  end = __correctly_grouped_prefixwc (s, end, thousands, grouping);
+# else
+	  end = __correctly_grouped_prefixmb (s, end, thousands, grouping);
+# endif
+	}
+    }
+  else
+#endif
+    end = NULL;
+
+  cutoff = STRTOL_ULONG_MAX / (unsigned LONG int) base;
+  cutlim = STRTOL_ULONG_MAX % (unsigned LONG int) base;
+
+  overflow = 0;
+  i = 0;
+  c = *s;
+  if (sizeof (long int) != sizeof (LONG int))
+    {
+      unsigned long int j = 0;
+      unsigned long int jmax = ULONG_MAX / base;
+
+      for (;c != L_('\0'); c = *++s)
+	{
+	  if (s == end)
+	    break;
+	  if (c >= L_('0') && c <= L_('9'))
+	    c -= L_('0');
+#ifdef USE_NUMBER_GROUPING
+# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+	  else if (grouping && (wchar_t) c == thousands)
+	    continue;
+# else
+	  else if (thousands_len)
+	    {
+	      for (cnt = 0; cnt < thousands_len; ++cnt)
+		if (thousands[cnt] != s[cnt])
+		  break;
+	      if (cnt == thousands_len)
+		{
+		  s += thousands_len - 1;
+		  continue;
+		}
+	      if (ISALPHA (c))
+		c = TOUPPER (c) - L_('A') + 10;
+	      else
+		break;
+	    }
+# endif
+#endif
+	  else if (ISALPHA (c))
+	    c = TOUPPER (c) - L_('A') + 10;
+	  else
+	    break;
+	  if ((int) c >= base)
+	    break;
+	  /* Note that we never can have an overflow.  */
+	  else if (j >= jmax)
+	    {
+	      /* We have an overflow.  Now use the long representation.  */
+	      i = (unsigned LONG int) j;
+	      goto use_long;
+	    }
+	  else
+	    j = j * (unsigned long int) base + c;
+	}
+
+      i = (unsigned LONG int) j;
+    }
+  else
+    for (;c != L_('\0'); c = *++s)
+      {
+	if (s == end)
+	  break;
+	if (c >= L_('0') && c <= L_('9'))
+	  c -= L_('0');
+#ifdef USE_NUMBER_GROUPING
+# ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+	else if (grouping && (wchar_t) c == thousands)
+	  continue;
+# else
+	else if (thousands_len)
+	  {
+	    for (cnt = 0; cnt < thousands_len; ++cnt)
+	      if (thousands[cnt] != s[cnt])
+		break;
+	    if (cnt == thousands_len)
+	      {
+		s += thousands_len - 1;
+		continue;
+	      }
+	    if (ISALPHA (c))
+	      c = TOUPPER (c) - L_('A') + 10;
+	    else
+	      break;
+	  }
+# endif
+#endif
+	else if (ISALPHA (c))
+	  c = TOUPPER (c) - L_('A') + 10;
+	else
+	  break;
+	if ((int) c >= base)
+	  break;
+	/* Check for overflow.  */
+	if (i > cutoff || (i == cutoff && c > cutlim))
+	  overflow = 1;
+	else
+	  {
+	  use_long:
+	    i *= (unsigned LONG int) base;
+	    i += c;
+	  }
+      }
+
+  /* Check if anything actually happened.  */
+  if (s == save)
+    goto noconv;
+
+  /* Store in ENDPTR the address of one character
+     past the last character we converted.  */
+  if (endptr != NULL)
+    *endptr = (STRING_TYPE *) s;
+
+#if !UNSIGNED
+  /* Check for a value that is within the range of
+     `unsigned LONG int', but outside the range of `LONG int'.  */
+  if (overflow == 0
+      && i > (negative
+	      ? -((unsigned LONG int) (STRTOL_LONG_MIN + 1)) + 1
+	      : (unsigned LONG int) STRTOL_LONG_MAX))
+    overflow = 1;
+#endif
+
+  if (__builtin_expect (overflow, 0))
+    {
+      __set_errno (ERANGE);
+#if UNSIGNED
+      return STRTOL_ULONG_MAX;
+#else
+      return negative ? STRTOL_LONG_MIN : STRTOL_LONG_MAX;
+#endif
+    }
+
+  /* Return the result of the appropriate sign.  */
+  return negative ? -i : i;
+
+noconv:
+  /* We must handle a special case here: the base is 0 or 16 and the
+     first two characters are '0' and 'x', but the rest are no
+     hexadecimal digits.  This is no error case.  We return 0 and
+     ENDPTR points to the `x`.  */
+  if (endptr != NULL)
+    {
+      if (save - nptr >= 2 && TOUPPER (save[-1]) == L_('X')
+	  && save[-2] == L_('0'))
+	*endptr = (STRING_TYPE *) &save[-1];
+      else
+	/*  There was no number to convert.  */
+	*endptr = (STRING_TYPE *) nptr;
+    }
+
+  return 0L;
+}
+#if defined _LIBC && !defined USE_WIDE_CHAR
+libc_hidden_def (INTERNAL (__strtol_l))
+#endif
+
+/* External user entry point.  */
+
+#if _LIBC - 0 == 0
+# undef PARAMS
+# if defined (__STDC__) && __STDC__
+#  define PARAMS(Args) Args
+# else
+#  define PARAMS(Args) ()
+# endif
+
+/* Prototype.  */
+extern INT __strtol_l PARAMS ((const STRING_TYPE *nptr, STRING_TYPE **endptr,
+			       int base));
+#endif
 
-#include "strtol.c"
 
+INT
+#ifdef weak_function
+weak_function
+#endif
+__strtol_l (nptr, endptr, base, loc)
+     const STRING_TYPE *nptr;
+     STRING_TYPE **endptr;
+     int base;
+     __locale_t loc;
+{
+  return INTERNAL (__strtol_l) (nptr, endptr, base, 0, loc);
+}
 weak_alias (__strtol_l, strtol_l)
diff --git a/sysdeps/generic/strtold.c b/sysdeps/generic/strtold_l.c
index 7303025eff..e43654700f 100644
--- a/sysdeps/generic/strtold.c
+++ b/sysdeps/generic/strtold_l.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1999, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 1999, 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
 
    The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
@@ -18,17 +18,23 @@
 
 #include <math.h>
 #include <stdlib.h>
+#include <xlocale.h>
+
+
+extern double ____strtod_l_internal (const char *, char **, int, __locale_t);
+
 
 /* There is no `long double' type, use the `double' implementations.  */
 long double
-__strtold_internal (const char *nptr, char **endptr, int group)
+____strtold_l_internal (const char *nptr, char **endptr, int group,
+			__locale_t loc)
 {
-  return __strtod_internal (nptr, endptr, group);
+  return ____strtod_l_internal (nptr, endptr, group, loc);
 }
-libc_hidden_def (__strtold_internal)
+
 
 long double
-strtold (const char *nptr, char **endptr)
+strtold (const char *nptr, char **endptr, __locale_t loc)
 {
-  return __strtod_internal (nptr, endptr, 0);
+  return ____strtod_l_internal (nptr, endptr, 0, loc);
 }
diff --git a/sysdeps/generic/strtoll_l.c b/sysdeps/generic/strtoll_l.c
index 5e7ae7674c..7725035bd1 100644
--- a/sysdeps/generic/strtoll_l.c
+++ b/sysdeps/generic/strtoll_l.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert string representing a number to integer value, using given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1997, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1997, 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1997.
 
@@ -18,13 +18,11 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
+#define QUAD	1
 
 #include <xlocale.h>
 
 extern long long int ____strtoll_l_internal (const char *, char **, int, int,
 					     __locale_t);
 
-#include <strtoll.c>
-
-weak_alias (__strtoll_l, strtoll_l)
+#include <strtol_l.c>
diff --git a/sysdeps/generic/strtoul_l.c b/sysdeps/generic/strtoul_l.c
index a049d2d006..a8b980f48d 100644
--- a/sysdeps/generic/strtoul_l.c
+++ b/sysdeps/generic/strtoul_l.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert string representing a number to integer value, using given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1997, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1997, 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1997.
 
@@ -18,13 +18,11 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
+#define UNSIGNED	1
 
 #include <xlocale.h>
 
 extern unsigned long int ____strtoul_l_internal (const char *, char **, int,
 						 int, __locale_t);
 
-#include "strtoul.c"
-
-weak_alias (__strtoul_l, strtoul_l)
+#include "strtol_l.c"
diff --git a/sysdeps/generic/strtoull_l.c b/sysdeps/generic/strtoull_l.c
index 55be504318..68ad0d826e 100644
--- a/sysdeps/generic/strtoull_l.c
+++ b/sysdeps/generic/strtoull_l.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert string representing a number to integer value, using given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1997, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1997, 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1997.
 
@@ -18,13 +18,12 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
+#define QUAD		1
+#define UNSIGNED	1
 
 #include <xlocale.h>
 
 extern unsigned long long int ____strtoull_l_internal (const char *, char **,
 						       int, int, __locale_t);
 
-#include <strtoull.c>
-
-weak_alias (__strtoull_l, strtoull_l)
+#include <strtol_l.c>
diff --git a/sysdeps/generic/wcstol_l.c b/sysdeps/generic/wcstol_l.c
index 91b0d3fa7d..f1b4171f18 100644
--- a/sysdeps/generic/wcstol_l.c
+++ b/sysdeps/generic/wcstol_l.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert string representing a number to integer value, using given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1997, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1997, 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1997.
 
@@ -22,11 +22,9 @@
 #include <stddef.h>
 #include <locale.h>
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
+#define	USE_WIDE_CHAR	1
 
 extern long int ____wcstol_l_internal (const wchar_t *, wchar_t **, int, int,
 				       __locale_t);
 
-#include "wcstol.c"
-
-weak_alias (__wcstol_l, wcstol_l)
+#include "strtol_l.c"
diff --git a/sysdeps/generic/wcstoll_l.c b/sysdeps/generic/wcstoll_l.c
index 9ed2c5aca7..f1a4ca1623 100644
--- a/sysdeps/generic/wcstoll_l.c
+++ b/sysdeps/generic/wcstoll_l.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert string representing a number to integer value, using given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1997, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1997.
 
@@ -22,11 +22,9 @@
 #include <stddef.h>
 #include <locale.h>
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
+#define QUAD	1
 
 extern long long int ____wcstoll_l_internal (const wchar_t *, wchar_t **,
 					     int, int, __locale_t);
 
-#include <wcstoll.c>
-
-weak_alias (__wcstoll_l, wcstoll_l)
+#include <wcstol_l.c>
diff --git a/sysdeps/generic/wcstoul_l.c b/sysdeps/generic/wcstoul_l.c
index 9d567bbcc5..eeee1f0baa 100644
--- a/sysdeps/generic/wcstoul_l.c
+++ b/sysdeps/generic/wcstoul_l.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert string representing a number to integer value, using given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1997, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1997, 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1997.
 
@@ -22,11 +22,9 @@
 #include <stddef.h>
 #include <locale.h>
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
+#define UNSIGNED	1
 
 extern unsigned long int ____wcstoul_l_internal (const wchar_t *, wchar_t **,
 						 int, int, __locale_t);
 
-#include <wcstoul.c>
-
-weak_alias (__wcstoul_l, wcstoul_l)
+#include <wcstol_l.c>
diff --git a/sysdeps/generic/wcstoull_l.c b/sysdeps/generic/wcstoull_l.c
index f8f05ba8d8..32bc3c4bb9 100644
--- a/sysdeps/generic/wcstoull_l.c
+++ b/sysdeps/generic/wcstoull_l.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert string representing a number to integer value, using given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1997, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1997, 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1997.
 
@@ -22,12 +22,10 @@
 #include <stddef.h>
 #include <locale.h>
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
+#define UNSIGNED	1
 
 extern unsigned long long int ____wcstoull_l_internal (const wchar_t *,
 						       wchar_t **, int, int,
 						       __locale_t);
 
-#include <wcstoull.c>
-
-weak_alias (__wcstoull_l, wcstoull_l)
+#include <wcstoll_l.c>
diff --git a/sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-128/strtold.c b/sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-128/strtold_l.c
index 45ba361c75..eb227fce61 100644
--- a/sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-128/strtold.c
+++ b/sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-128/strtold_l.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 1999, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
 
    The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
@@ -21,16 +21,18 @@
 /* The actual implementation for all floating point sizes is in strtod.c.
    These macros tell it to produce the `long double' version, `strtold'.  */
 
-# define FLOAT		long double
-# define FLT		LDBL
-# ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#  define STRTOF	__strtold_l
-# else
-#  define STRTOF	strtold
-# endif
-# define MPN2FLOAT	__mpn_construct_long_double
-# define FLOAT_HUGE_VAL	HUGE_VALL
-# define SET_MANTISSA(flt, mant) \
+#define FLOAT		long double
+#define FLT		LDBL
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+# define STRTOF		wcstold_l
+# define __STRTOF	__wcstold_l
+#else
+# define STRTOF		strtold_l
+# define __STRTOF	__strtold_l
+#endif
+#define MPN2FLOAT	__mpn_construct_long_double
+#define FLOAT_HUGE_VAL	HUGE_VALL
+#define SET_MANTISSA(flt, mant) \
   do { union ieee854_long_double u;					      \
        u.d = (flt);							      \
        u.ieee.mantissa0 = 0x8000;					      \
@@ -40,4 +42,4 @@
        (flt) = u.d;							      \
   } while (0)
 
-# include "strtod.c"
+#include <strtod_l.c>
diff --git a/sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-96/strtold.c b/sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-96/strtold_l.c
index c4f395273b..32bf18084b 100644
--- a/sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-96/strtold.c
+++ b/sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-96/strtold_l.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 1999, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
 
    The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
@@ -21,16 +21,18 @@
 /* The actual implementation for all floating point sizes is in strtod.c.
    These macros tell it to produce the `long double' version, `strtold'.  */
 
-# define FLOAT		long double
-# define FLT		LDBL
-# ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#  define STRTOF	__strtold_l
-# else
-#  define STRTOF	strtold
-# endif
-# define MPN2FLOAT	__mpn_construct_long_double
-# define FLOAT_HUGE_VAL	HUGE_VALL
-# define SET_MANTISSA(flt, mant) \
+#define FLOAT		long double
+#define FLT		LDBL
+#ifdef USE_WIDE_CHAR
+# define STRTOF		wcstold_l
+# define __STRTOF	__wcstold_l
+#else
+# define STRTOF		strtold_l
+# define __STRTOF	__strtold_l
+#endif
+#define MPN2FLOAT	__mpn_construct_long_double
+#define FLOAT_HUGE_VAL	HUGE_VALL
+#define SET_MANTISSA(flt, mant) \
   do { union ieee854_long_double u;					      \
        u.d = (flt);							      \
        if ((mant & 0x7fffffffffffffffULL) == 0)				      \
@@ -40,4 +42,4 @@
        (flt) = u.d;							      \
   } while (0)
 
-# include "strtod.c"
+#include <strtod_l.c>
diff --git a/sysdeps/m68k/strtold.c b/sysdeps/m68k/strtold.c
deleted file mode 100644
index f756488275..0000000000
--- a/sysdeps/m68k/strtold.c
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,2 +0,0 @@
-#define DENORM_EXP (MIN_EXP - 1)
-#include <sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-96/strtold.c>
diff --git a/sysdeps/m68k/strtold_l.c b/sysdeps/m68k/strtold_l.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000000..481d9924c2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/sysdeps/m68k/strtold_l.c
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+#define DENORM_EXP (MIN_EXP - 1)
+#include <sysdeps/ieee754/ldbl-96/strtold_l.c>
diff --git a/time/strftime.c b/time/strftime.c
index 04250317e3..5a4917e352 100644
--- a/time/strftime.c
+++ b/time/strftime.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1991-1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003
+/* Copyright (C) 1991-1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004
    Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
 
@@ -17,1422 +17,13 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
-# include <config.h>
-#endif
+#include <time.h>
+#include <locale/localeinfo.h>
 
-#ifdef _LIBC
-# define HAVE_LIMITS_H 1
-# define HAVE_MBLEN 1
-# define HAVE_MBRLEN 1
-# define HAVE_STRUCT_ERA_ENTRY 1
-# define HAVE_TM_GMTOFF 1
-# define HAVE_TM_ZONE 1
-# define HAVE_TZNAME 1
-# define HAVE_TZSET 1
-# define MULTIBYTE_IS_FORMAT_SAFE 1
-# define STDC_HEADERS 1
-# include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
-#endif
 
-#if defined emacs && !defined HAVE_BCOPY
-# define HAVE_MEMCPY 1
-#endif
-
-#include <ctype.h>
-#include <sys/types.h>		/* Some systems define `time_t' here.  */
-
-#ifdef TIME_WITH_SYS_TIME
-# include <sys/time.h>
-# include <time.h>
-#else
-# ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
-#  include <sys/time.h>
-# else
-#  include <time.h>
-# endif
-#endif
-#if HAVE_TZNAME
-extern char *tzname[];
-#endif
-
-/* Do multibyte processing if multibytes are supported, unless
-   multibyte sequences are safe in formats.  Multibyte sequences are
-   safe if they cannot contain byte sequences that look like format
-   conversion specifications.  The GNU C Library uses UTF8 multibyte
-   encoding, which is safe for formats, but strftime.c can be used
-   with other C libraries that use unsafe encodings.  */
-#define DO_MULTIBYTE (HAVE_MBLEN && ! MULTIBYTE_IS_FORMAT_SAFE)
-
-#if DO_MULTIBYTE
-# if HAVE_MBRLEN
-#  include <wchar.h>
-# else
-   /* Simulate mbrlen with mblen as best we can.  */
-#  define mbstate_t int
-#  define mbrlen(s, n, ps) mblen (s, n)
-#  define mbsinit(ps) (*(ps) == 0)
-# endif
-  static const mbstate_t mbstate_zero;
-#endif
-
-#if HAVE_LIMITS_H
-# include <limits.h>
-#endif
-
-#if STDC_HEADERS
-# include <stddef.h>
-# include <stdlib.h>
-# include <string.h>
-#else
-# ifndef HAVE_MEMCPY
-#  define memcpy(d, s, n) bcopy ((s), (d), (n))
-# endif
-#endif
-
-#ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
-# include <endian.h>
-# define CHAR_T wchar_t
-# define UCHAR_T unsigned int
-# define L_(Str) L##Str
-# define NLW(Sym) _NL_W##Sym
-
-# define MEMCPY(d, s, n) __wmemcpy (d, s, n)
-# define STRLEN(s) __wcslen (s)
-
-#else
-# define CHAR_T char
-# define UCHAR_T unsigned char
-# define L_(Str) Str
-# define NLW(Sym) Sym
-
-# if !defined STDC_HEADERS && !defined HAVE_MEMCPY
-#  define MEMCPY(d, s, n) bcopy ((s), (d), (n))
-# else
-#  define MEMCPY(d, s, n) memcpy ((d), (s), (n))
-# endif
-# define STRLEN(s) strlen (s)
-
-# ifdef _LIBC
-#  define MEMPCPY(d, s, n) __mempcpy (d, s, n)
-# else
-#  ifndef HAVE_MEMPCPY
-#   define MEMPCPY(d, s, n) ((void *) ((char *) memcpy (d, s, n) + (n)))
-#  endif
-# endif
-#endif
-
-#ifndef __P
-# if defined __GNUC__ || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
-#  define __P(args) args
-# else
-#  define __P(args) ()
-# endif  /* GCC.  */
-#endif  /* Not __P.  */
-
-#ifndef PTR
-# ifdef __STDC__
-#  define PTR void *
-# else
-#  define PTR char *
-# endif
-#endif
-
-#ifndef CHAR_BIT
-# define CHAR_BIT 8
-#endif
-
-#ifndef NULL
-# define NULL 0
-#endif
-
-#define TYPE_SIGNED(t) ((t) -1 < 0)
-
-/* Bound on length of the string representing an integer value of type t.
-   Subtract one for the sign bit if t is signed;
-   302 / 1000 is log10 (2) rounded up;
-   add one for integer division truncation;
-   add one more for a minus sign if t is signed.  */
-#define INT_STRLEN_BOUND(t) \
- ((sizeof (t) * CHAR_BIT - TYPE_SIGNED (t)) * 302 / 1000 + 1 + TYPE_SIGNED (t))
-
-#define TM_YEAR_BASE 1900
-
-#ifndef __isleap
-/* Nonzero if YEAR is a leap year (every 4 years,
-   except every 100th isn't, and every 400th is).  */
-# define __isleap(year)	\
-  ((year) % 4 == 0 && ((year) % 100 != 0 || (year) % 400 == 0))
-#endif
-
-
-#ifdef _LIBC
-# define tzname __tzname
-# define tzset __tzset
-#endif
-
-#if !HAVE_TM_GMTOFF
-/* Portable standalone applications should supply a "time_r.h" that
-   declares a POSIX-compliant localtime_r, for the benefit of older
-   implementations that lack localtime_r or have a nonstandard one.
-   Similarly for gmtime_r.  See the gnulib time_r module for one way
-   to implement this.  */
-# include "time_r.h"
-# undef __gmtime_r
-# undef __localtime_r
-# define __gmtime_r gmtime_r
-# define __localtime_r localtime_r
-#endif
-
-
-#if !defined memset && !defined HAVE_MEMSET && !defined _LIBC
-/* Some systems lack the `memset' function and we don't want to
-   introduce additional dependencies.  */
-/* The SGI compiler reportedly barfs on the trailing null
-   if we use a string constant as the initializer.  28 June 1997, rms.  */
-static const CHAR_T spaces[16] = /* "                " */
-{
-  L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),
-  L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' ')
-};
-static const CHAR_T zeroes[16] = /* "0000000000000000" */
-{
-  L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),
-  L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0')
-};
-
-# define memset_space(P, Len) \
-  do {									      \
-    int _len = (Len);							      \
-									      \
-    do									      \
-      {									      \
-	int _this = _len > 16 ? 16 : _len;				      \
-	(P) = MEMPCPY ((P), spaces, _this * sizeof (CHAR_T));		      \
-	_len -= _this;							      \
-      }									      \
-    while (_len > 0);							      \
-  } while (0)
-
-# define memset_zero(P, Len) \
-  do {									      \
-    int _len = (Len);							      \
-									      \
-    do									      \
-      {									      \
-	int _this = _len > 16 ? 16 : _len;				      \
-	(P) = MEMPCPY ((P), zeroes, _this * sizeof (CHAR_T));		      \
-	_len -= _this;							      \
-      }									      \
-    while (_len > 0);							      \
-  } while (0)
-#else
-# ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
-#  define memset_space(P, Len) (wmemset ((P), L' ', (Len)), (P) += (Len))
-#  define memset_zero(P, Len) (wmemset ((P), L'0', (Len)), (P) += (Len))
-# else
-#  define memset_space(P, Len) (memset ((P), ' ', (Len)), (P) += (Len))
-#  define memset_zero(P, Len) (memset ((P), '0', (Len)), (P) += (Len))
-# endif
-#endif
-
-#define add(n, f)							      \
-  do									      \
-    {									      \
-      int _n = (n);							      \
-      int _delta = width - _n;						      \
-      int _incr = _n + (_delta > 0 ? _delta : 0);			      \
-      if ((size_t) _incr >= maxsize - i)				      \
-	return 0;							      \
-      if (p)								      \
-	{								      \
-	  if (_delta > 0)						      \
-	    {								      \
-	      if (pad == L_('0'))					      \
-		memset_zero (p, _delta);				      \
-	      else							      \
-		memset_space (p, _delta);				      \
-	    }								      \
-	  f;								      \
-	  p += _n;							      \
-	}								      \
-      i += _incr;							      \
-    } while (0)
-
-#define cpy(n, s) \
-    add ((n),								      \
-	 if (to_lowcase)						      \
-	   memcpy_lowcase (p, (s), _n LOCALE_ARG);			      \
-	 else if (to_uppcase)						      \
-	   memcpy_uppcase (p, (s), _n LOCALE_ARG);			      \
-	 else								      \
-	   MEMCPY ((PTR) p, (const PTR) (s), _n))
-
-#ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
-# ifndef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#  undef __mbsrtowcs_l
-#  define __mbsrtowcs_l(d, s, l, st, loc) __mbsrtowcs (d, s, l, st)
-# endif
-# define widen(os, ws, l) \
-  {									      \
-    mbstate_t __st;							      \
-    const char *__s = os;						      \
-    memset (&__st, '\0', sizeof (__st));				      \
-    l = __mbsrtowcs_l (NULL, &__s, 0, &__st, loc);			      \
-    ws = alloca ((l + 1) * sizeof (wchar_t));				      \
-    (void) __mbsrtowcs_l (ws, &__s, l, &__st, loc);			      \
-  }
-#endif
-
-
-#if defined _LIBC && defined USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-/* We use this code also for the extended locale handling where the
-   function gets as an additional argument the locale which has to be
-   used.  To access the values we have to redefine the _NL_CURRENT
-   macro.  */
-# define strftime		__strftime_l
-# define wcsftime		__wcsftime_l
-# undef _NL_CURRENT
-# define _NL_CURRENT(category, item) \
-  (current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (item)].string)
-# define LOCALE_PARAM , loc
-# define LOCALE_ARG , loc
-# define LOCALE_PARAM_DECL  __locale_t loc;
-# define LOCALE_PARAM_PROTO , __locale_t loc
-# define HELPER_LOCALE_ARG  , current
-#else
-# define LOCALE_PARAM
-# define LOCALE_PARAM_PROTO
-# define LOCALE_ARG
-# define LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
-# ifdef _LIBC
-#  define HELPER_LOCALE_ARG , _NL_CURRENT_DATA (LC_TIME)
-# else
-#  define HELPER_LOCALE_ARG
-# endif
-#endif
-
-#ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
-# ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#  define TOUPPER(Ch, L) __towupper_l (Ch, L)
-#  define TOLOWER(Ch, L) __towlower_l (Ch, L)
-# else
-#  define TOUPPER(Ch, L) towupper (Ch)
-#  define TOLOWER(Ch, L) towlower (Ch)
-# endif
-#else
-# ifdef _LIBC
-#  ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#   define TOUPPER(Ch, L) __toupper_l (Ch, L)
-#   define TOLOWER(Ch, L) __tolower_l (Ch, L)
-#  else
-#   define TOUPPER(Ch, L) toupper (Ch)
-#   define TOLOWER(Ch, L) tolower (Ch)
-#  endif
-# else
-#  define TOUPPER(Ch, L) (islower (Ch) ? toupper (Ch) : (Ch))
-#  define TOLOWER(Ch, L) (isupper (Ch) ? tolower (Ch) : (Ch))
-# endif
-#endif
-/* We don't use `isdigit' here since the locale dependent
-   interpretation is not what we want here.  We only need to accept
-   the arabic digits in the ASCII range.  One day there is perhaps a
-   more reliable way to accept other sets of digits.  */
-#define ISDIGIT(Ch) ((unsigned int) (Ch) - L_('0') <= 9)
-
-static CHAR_T *memcpy_lowcase __P ((CHAR_T *dest, const CHAR_T *src,
-				    size_t len LOCALE_PARAM_PROTO));
-
-static CHAR_T *
-memcpy_lowcase (dest, src, len LOCALE_PARAM)
-     CHAR_T *dest;
-     const CHAR_T *src;
-     size_t len;
-     LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
-{
-  while (len-- > 0)
-    dest[len] = TOLOWER ((UCHAR_T) src[len], loc);
-  return dest;
-}
-
-static CHAR_T *memcpy_uppcase __P ((CHAR_T *dest, const CHAR_T *src,
-				    size_t len LOCALE_PARAM_PROTO));
-
-static CHAR_T *
-memcpy_uppcase (dest, src, len LOCALE_PARAM)
-     CHAR_T *dest;
-     const CHAR_T *src;
-     size_t len;
-     LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
-{
-  while (len-- > 0)
-    dest[len] = TOUPPER ((UCHAR_T) src[len], loc);
-  return dest;
-}
-
-
-#if ! HAVE_TM_GMTOFF
-/* Yield the difference between *A and *B,
-   measured in seconds, ignoring leap seconds.  */
-# define tm_diff ftime_tm_diff
-static int tm_diff __P ((const struct tm *, const struct tm *));
-static int
-tm_diff (a, b)
-     const struct tm *a;
-     const struct tm *b;
-{
-  /* Compute intervening leap days correctly even if year is negative.
-     Take care to avoid int overflow in leap day calculations,
-     but it's OK to assume that A and B are close to each other.  */
-  int a4 = (a->tm_year >> 2) + (TM_YEAR_BASE >> 2) - ! (a->tm_year & 3);
-  int b4 = (b->tm_year >> 2) + (TM_YEAR_BASE >> 2) - ! (b->tm_year & 3);
-  int a100 = a4 / 25 - (a4 % 25 < 0);
-  int b100 = b4 / 25 - (b4 % 25 < 0);
-  int a400 = a100 >> 2;
-  int b400 = b100 >> 2;
-  int intervening_leap_days = (a4 - b4) - (a100 - b100) + (a400 - b400);
-  int years = a->tm_year - b->tm_year;
-  int days = (365 * years + intervening_leap_days
-	      + (a->tm_yday - b->tm_yday));
-  return (60 * (60 * (24 * days + (a->tm_hour - b->tm_hour))
-		+ (a->tm_min - b->tm_min))
-	  + (a->tm_sec - b->tm_sec));
-}
-#endif /* ! HAVE_TM_GMTOFF */
-
-
-
-/* The number of days from the first day of the first ISO week of this
-   year to the year day YDAY with week day WDAY.  ISO weeks start on
-   Monday; the first ISO week has the year's first Thursday.  YDAY may
-   be as small as YDAY_MINIMUM.  */
-#define ISO_WEEK_START_WDAY 1 /* Monday */
-#define ISO_WEEK1_WDAY 4 /* Thursday */
-#define YDAY_MINIMUM (-366)
-static int iso_week_days __P ((int, int));
-#ifdef __GNUC__
-__inline__
-#endif
-static int
-iso_week_days (yday, wday)
-     int yday;
-     int wday;
-{
-  /* Add enough to the first operand of % to make it nonnegative.  */
-  int big_enough_multiple_of_7 = (-YDAY_MINIMUM / 7 + 2) * 7;
-  return (yday
-	  - (yday - wday + ISO_WEEK1_WDAY + big_enough_multiple_of_7) % 7
-	  + ISO_WEEK1_WDAY - ISO_WEEK_START_WDAY);
-}
-
-
-#if !(defined _NL_CURRENT || HAVE_STRFTIME)
-static CHAR_T const weekday_name[][10] =
-  {
-    L_("Sunday"), L_("Monday"), L_("Tuesday"), L_("Wednesday"),
-    L_("Thursday"), L_("Friday"), L_("Saturday")
-  };
-static CHAR_T const month_name[][10] =
-  {
-    L_("January"), L_("February"), L_("March"), L_("April"), L_("May"),
-    L_("June"), L_("July"), L_("August"), L_("September"), L_("October"),
-    L_("November"), L_("December")
-  };
-#endif
-
-
-#ifdef emacs
-# define my_strftime emacs_strftimeu
-# define ut_argument , ut
-# define ut_argument_spec int ut;
-# define ut_argument_spec_iso , int ut
-#else
-# ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
-#  define my_strftime wcsftime
-#  define nl_get_alt_digit _nl_get_walt_digit
-# else
-#  define my_strftime strftime
-#  define nl_get_alt_digit _nl_get_alt_digit
-# endif
-# define ut_argument
-# define ut_argument_spec
-# define ut_argument_spec_iso
-/* We don't have this information in general.  */
-# define ut 0
-#endif
-
-#if !defined _LIBC && HAVE_TZNAME && HAVE_TZSET
-  /* Solaris 2.5 tzset sometimes modifies the storage returned by localtime.
-     Work around this bug by copying *tp before it might be munged.  */
-  size_t _strftime_copytm __P ((char *, size_t, const char *,
-			        const struct tm * ut_argument_spec_iso));
-  size_t
-  my_strftime (s, maxsize, format, tp ut_argument)
-      CHAR_T *s;
-      size_t maxsize;
-      const CHAR_T *format;
-      const struct tm *tp;
-      ut_argument_spec
-  {
-    struct tm tmcopy;
-    tmcopy = *tp;
-    return _strftime_copytm (s, maxsize, format, &tmcopy ut_argument);
-  }
-# undef my_strftime
-# define my_strftime _strftime_copytm
-#endif
-
-
-/* Write information from TP into S according to the format
-   string FORMAT, writing no more that MAXSIZE characters
-   (including the terminating '\0') and returning number of
-   characters written.  If S is NULL, nothing will be written
-   anywhere, so to determine how many characters would be
-   written, use NULL for S and (size_t) UINT_MAX for MAXSIZE.  */
-size_t
-my_strftime (s, maxsize, format, tp ut_argument LOCALE_PARAM)
-      CHAR_T *s;
-      size_t maxsize;
-      const CHAR_T *format;
-      const struct tm *tp;
-      ut_argument_spec
-      LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
-{
-#if defined _LIBC && defined USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-  struct locale_data *const current = loc->__locales[LC_TIME];
-#endif
-
-  int hour12 = tp->tm_hour;
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-  /* We cannot make the following values variables since we must delay
-     the evaluation of these values until really needed since some
-     expressions might not be valid in every situation.  The `struct tm'
-     might be generated by a strptime() call that initialized
-     only a few elements.  Dereference the pointers only if the format
-     requires this.  Then it is ok to fail if the pointers are invalid.  */
-# define a_wkday \
-  ((const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(ABDAY_1) + tp->tm_wday))
-# define f_wkday \
-  ((const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(DAY_1) + tp->tm_wday))
-# define a_month \
-  ((const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(ABMON_1) + tp->tm_mon))
-# define f_month \
-  ((const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(MON_1) + tp->tm_mon))
-# define ampm \
-  ((const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, tp->tm_hour > 11		      \
-				 ? NLW(PM_STR) : NLW(AM_STR)))
-
-# define aw_len STRLEN (a_wkday)
-# define am_len STRLEN (a_month)
-# define ap_len STRLEN (ampm)
-#else
-# if !HAVE_STRFTIME
-#  define f_wkday (weekday_name[tp->tm_wday])
-#  define f_month (month_name[tp->tm_mon])
-#  define a_wkday f_wkday
-#  define a_month f_month
-#  define ampm (L_("AMPM") + 2 * (tp->tm_hour > 11))
-
-  size_t aw_len = 3;
-  size_t am_len = 3;
-  size_t ap_len = 2;
-# endif
-#endif
-  const char *zone;
-  size_t i = 0;
-  CHAR_T *p = s;
-  const CHAR_T *f;
-#if DO_MULTIBYTE && !defined COMPILE_WIDE
-  const char *format_end = NULL;
-#endif
-
-  zone = NULL;
-#if HAVE_TM_ZONE
-  /* The POSIX test suite assumes that setting
-     the environment variable TZ to a new value before calling strftime()
-     will influence the result (the %Z format) even if the information in
-     TP is computed with a totally different time zone.
-     This is bogus: though POSIX allows bad behavior like this,
-     POSIX does not require it.  Do the right thing instead.  */
-  zone = (const char *) tp->tm_zone;
-#endif
-#if HAVE_TZNAME
-  if (ut)
-    {
-      if (! (zone && *zone))
-	zone = "GMT";
-    }
-  else
-    {
-      /* POSIX.1 requires that local time zone information is used as
-	 though strftime called tzset.  */
-# if HAVE_TZSET
-      tzset ();
-# endif
-    }
-#endif
-
-  if (hour12 > 12)
-    hour12 -= 12;
-  else
-    if (hour12 == 0)
-      hour12 = 12;
-
-  for (f = format; *f != '\0'; ++f)
-    {
-      int pad = 0;		/* Padding for number ('-', '_', or 0).  */
-      int modifier;		/* Field modifier ('E', 'O', or 0).  */
-      int digits;		/* Max digits for numeric format.  */
-      int number_value; 	/* Numeric value to be printed.  */
-      int negative_number;	/* 1 if the number is negative.  */
-      const CHAR_T *subfmt;
-      CHAR_T *bufp;
-      CHAR_T buf[1 + (sizeof (int) < sizeof (time_t)
-		      ? INT_STRLEN_BOUND (time_t)
-		      : INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int))];
-      int width = -1;
-      int to_lowcase = 0;
-      int to_uppcase = 0;
-      int change_case = 0;
-      int format_char;
-
-#if DO_MULTIBYTE && !defined COMPILE_WIDE
-      switch (*f)
-	{
-	case L_('%'):
-	  break;
-
-	case L_('\b'): case L_('\t'): case L_('\n'):
-	case L_('\v'): case L_('\f'): case L_('\r'):
-	case L_(' '): case L_('!'): case L_('"'): case L_('#'): case L_('&'):
-	case L_('\''): case L_('('): case L_(')'): case L_('*'): case L_('+'):
-	case L_(','): case L_('-'): case L_('.'): case L_('/'): case L_('0'):
-	case L_('1'): case L_('2'): case L_('3'): case L_('4'): case L_('5'):
-	case L_('6'): case L_('7'): case L_('8'): case L_('9'): case L_(':'):
-	case L_(';'): case L_('<'): case L_('='): case L_('>'): case L_('?'):
-	case L_('A'): case L_('B'): case L_('C'): case L_('D'): case L_('E'):
-	case L_('F'): case L_('G'): case L_('H'): case L_('I'): case L_('J'):
-	case L_('K'): case L_('L'): case L_('M'): case L_('N'): case L_('O'):
-	case L_('P'): case L_('Q'): case L_('R'): case L_('S'): case L_('T'):
-	case L_('U'): case L_('V'): case L_('W'): case L_('X'): case L_('Y'):
-	case L_('Z'): case L_('['): case L_('\\'): case L_(']'): case L_('^'):
-	case L_('_'): case L_('a'): case L_('b'): case L_('c'): case L_('d'):
-	case L_('e'): case L_('f'): case L_('g'): case L_('h'): case L_('i'):
-	case L_('j'): case L_('k'): case L_('l'): case L_('m'): case L_('n'):
-	case L_('o'): case L_('p'): case L_('q'): case L_('r'): case L_('s'):
-	case L_('t'): case L_('u'): case L_('v'): case L_('w'): case L_('x'):
-	case L_('y'): case L_('z'): case L_('{'): case L_('|'): case L_('}'):
-	case L_('~'):
-	  /* The C Standard requires these 98 characters (plus '%') to
-	     be in the basic execution character set.  None of these
-	     characters can start a multibyte sequence, so they need
-	     not be analyzed further.  */
-	  add (1, *p = *f);
-	  continue;
-
-	default:
-	  /* Copy this multibyte sequence until we reach its end, find
-	     an error, or come back to the initial shift state.  */
-	  {
-	    mbstate_t mbstate = mbstate_zero;
-	    size_t len = 0;
-	    size_t fsize;
-
-	    if (! format_end)
-	      format_end = f + strlen (f) + 1;
-	    fsize = format_end - f;
-
-	    do
-	      {
-		size_t bytes = mbrlen (f + len, fsize - len, &mbstate);
-
-		if (bytes == 0)
-		  break;
-
-		if (bytes == (size_t) -2)
-		  {
-		    len += strlen (f + len);
-		    break;
-		  }
-
-		if (bytes == (size_t) -1)
-		  {
-		    len++;
-		    break;
-		  }
-
-		len += bytes;
-	      }
-	    while (! mbsinit (&mbstate));
-
-	    cpy (len, f);
-	    f += len - 1;
-	    continue;
-	  }
-	}
-
-#else /* ! DO_MULTIBYTE */
-
-      /* Either multibyte encodings are not supported, they are
-	 safe for formats, so any non-'%' byte can be copied through,
-	 or this is the wide character version.  */
-      if (*f != L_('%'))
-	{
-	  add (1, *p = *f);
-	  continue;
-	}
-
-#endif /* ! DO_MULTIBYTE */
-
-      /* Check for flags that can modify a format.  */
-      while (1)
-	{
-	  switch (*++f)
-	    {
-	      /* This influences the number formats.  */
-	    case L_('_'):
-	    case L_('-'):
-	    case L_('0'):
-	      pad = *f;
-	      continue;
-
-	      /* This changes textual output.  */
-	    case L_('^'):
-	      to_uppcase = 1;
-	      continue;
-	    case L_('#'):
-	      change_case = 1;
-	      continue;
-
-	    default:
-	      break;
-	    }
-	  break;
-	}
-
-      /* As a GNU extension we allow to specify the field width.  */
-      if (ISDIGIT (*f))
-	{
-	  width = 0;
-	  do
-	    {
-	      if (width > INT_MAX / 10
-		  || (width == INT_MAX / 10 && *f - L_('0') > INT_MAX % 10))
-		/* Avoid overflow.  */
-		width = INT_MAX;
-	      else
-		{
-		  width *= 10;
-		  width += *f - L_('0');
-		}
-	      ++f;
-	    }
-	  while (ISDIGIT (*f));
-	}
-
-      /* Check for modifiers.  */
-      switch (*f)
-	{
-	case L_('E'):
-	case L_('O'):
-	  modifier = *f++;
-	  break;
-
-	default:
-	  modifier = 0;
-	  break;
-	}
-
-      /* Now do the specified format.  */
-      format_char = *f;
-      switch (format_char)
-	{
-#define DO_NUMBER(d, v) \
-	  digits = d > width ? d : width;				      \
-	  number_value = v; goto do_number
-#define DO_NUMBER_SPACEPAD(d, v) \
-	  digits = d > width ? d : width;				      \
-	  number_value = v; goto do_number_spacepad
-
-	case L_('%'):
-	  if (modifier != 0)
-	    goto bad_format;
-	  add (1, *p = *f);
-	  break;
-
-	case L_('a'):
-	  if (modifier != 0)
-	    goto bad_format;
-	  if (change_case)
-	    {
-	      to_uppcase = 1;
-	      to_lowcase = 0;
-	    }
-#if defined _NL_CURRENT || !HAVE_STRFTIME
-	  cpy (aw_len, a_wkday);
-	  break;
-#else
-	  goto underlying_strftime;
-#endif
-
-	case 'A':
-	  if (modifier != 0)
-	    goto bad_format;
-	  if (change_case)
-	    {
-	      to_uppcase = 1;
-	      to_lowcase = 0;
-	    }
-#if defined _NL_CURRENT || !HAVE_STRFTIME
-	  cpy (STRLEN (f_wkday), f_wkday);
-	  break;
-#else
-	  goto underlying_strftime;
-#endif
-
-	case L_('b'):
-	case L_('h'):
-	  if (change_case)
-	    {
-	      to_uppcase = 1;
-	      to_lowcase = 0;
-	    }
-	  if (modifier != 0)
-	    goto bad_format;
-#if defined _NL_CURRENT || !HAVE_STRFTIME
-	  cpy (am_len, a_month);
-	  break;
-#else
-	  goto underlying_strftime;
-#endif
-
-	case L_('B'):
-	  if (modifier != 0)
-	    goto bad_format;
-	  if (change_case)
-	    {
-	      to_uppcase = 1;
-	      to_lowcase = 0;
-	    }
-#if defined _NL_CURRENT || !HAVE_STRFTIME
-	  cpy (STRLEN (f_month), f_month);
-	  break;
-#else
-	  goto underlying_strftime;
-#endif
-
-	case L_('c'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('O'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-	  if (! (modifier == 'E'
-		 && (*(subfmt =
-		       (const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME,
-						     NLW(ERA_D_T_FMT)))
-		     != '\0')))
-	    subfmt = (const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(D_T_FMT));
-#else
-# if HAVE_STRFTIME
-	  goto underlying_strftime;
-# else
-	  subfmt = L_("%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Y");
-# endif
-#endif
-
-	subformat:
-	  {
-	    CHAR_T *old_start = p;
-	    size_t len = my_strftime (NULL, (size_t) -1, subfmt,
-				      tp ut_argument LOCALE_ARG);
-	    add (len, my_strftime (p, maxsize - i, subfmt,
-				   tp ut_argument LOCALE_ARG));
-
-	    if (to_uppcase)
-	      while (old_start < p)
-		{
-		  *old_start = TOUPPER ((UCHAR_T) *old_start, loc);
-		  ++old_start;
-		}
-	  }
-	  break;
-
-#if HAVE_STRFTIME && ! (defined _NL_CURRENT && HAVE_STRUCT_ERA_ENTRY)
-	underlying_strftime:
-	  {
-	    /* The relevant information is available only via the
-	       underlying strftime implementation, so use that.  */
-	    char ufmt[4];
-	    char *u = ufmt;
-	    char ubuf[1024]; /* enough for any single format in practice */
-	    size_t len;
-	    /* Make sure we're calling the actual underlying strftime.
-	       In some cases, config.h contains something like
-	       "#define strftime rpl_strftime".  */
-# ifdef strftime
-#  undef strftime
-	    size_t strftime ();
-# endif
-
-	    *u++ = '%';
-	    if (modifier != 0)
-	      *u++ = modifier;
-	    *u++ = format_char;
-	    *u = '\0';
-	    len = strftime (ubuf, sizeof ubuf, ufmt, tp);
-	    if (len == 0 && ubuf[0] != '\0')
-	      return 0;
-	    cpy (len, ubuf);
-	  }
-	  break;
-#endif
-
-	case L_('C'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('O'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    {
-#if HAVE_STRUCT_ERA_ENTRY
-	      struct era_entry *era = _nl_get_era_entry (tp HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
-	      if (era)
-		{
-# ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
-		  size_t len = __wcslen (era->era_wname);
-		  cpy (len, era->era_wname);
-# else
-		  size_t len = strlen (era->era_name);
-		  cpy (len, era->era_name);
-# endif
-		  break;
-		}
-#else
-# if HAVE_STRFTIME
-	      goto underlying_strftime;
-# endif
-#endif
-	    }
-
-	  {
-	    int year = tp->tm_year + TM_YEAR_BASE;
-	    DO_NUMBER (1, year / 100 - (year % 100 < 0));
-	  }
-
-	case L_('x'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('O'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-	  if (! (modifier == L_('E')
-		 && (*(subfmt =
-		       (const CHAR_T *)_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(ERA_D_FMT)))
-		     != L_('\0'))))
-	    subfmt = (const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(D_FMT));
-	  goto subformat;
-#else
-# if HAVE_STRFTIME
-	  goto underlying_strftime;
-# else
-	  /* Fall through.  */
-# endif
-#endif
-	case L_('D'):
-	  if (modifier != 0)
-	    goto bad_format;
-	  subfmt = L_("%m/%d/%y");
-	  goto subformat;
-
-	case L_('d'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-
-	  DO_NUMBER (2, tp->tm_mday);
-
-	case L_('e'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-
-	  DO_NUMBER_SPACEPAD (2, tp->tm_mday);
-
-	  /* All numeric formats set DIGITS and NUMBER_VALUE and then
-	     jump to one of these two labels.  */
-
-	do_number_spacepad:
-	  /* Force `_' flag unless overwritten by `0' or '-' flag.  */
-	  if (pad != L_('0') && pad != L_('-'))
-	    pad = L_('_');
-
-	do_number:
-	  /* Format the number according to the MODIFIER flag.  */
-
-	  if (modifier == L_('O') && 0 <= number_value)
-	    {
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-	      /* Get the locale specific alternate representation of
-		 the number NUMBER_VALUE.  If none exist NULL is returned.  */
-	      const CHAR_T *cp = nl_get_alt_digit (number_value
-						   HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
-
-	      if (cp != NULL)
-		{
-		  size_t digitlen = STRLEN (cp);
-		  if (digitlen != 0)
-		    {
-		      cpy (digitlen, cp);
-		      break;
-		    }
-		}
-#else
-# if HAVE_STRFTIME
-	      goto underlying_strftime;
-# endif
-#endif
-	    }
-	  {
-	    unsigned int u = number_value;
-
-	    bufp = buf + sizeof (buf) / sizeof (buf[0]);
-	    negative_number = number_value < 0;
-
-	    if (negative_number)
-	      u = -u;
-
-	    do
-	      *--bufp = u % 10 + L_('0');
-	    while ((u /= 10) != 0);
-  	  }
-
-	do_number_sign_and_padding:
-	  if (negative_number)
-	    *--bufp = L_('-');
-
-	  if (pad != L_('-'))
-	    {
-	      int padding = digits - (buf + (sizeof (buf) / sizeof (buf[0]))
-				      - bufp);
-
-	      if (padding > 0)
-		{
-		  if (pad == L_('_'))
-		    {
-		      if ((size_t) padding >= maxsize - i)
-			return 0;
-
-		      if (p)
-			memset_space (p, padding);
-		      i += padding;
-		      width = width > padding ? width - padding : 0;
-		    }
-		  else
-		    {
-		      if ((size_t) digits >= maxsize - i)
-			return 0;
-
-		      if (negative_number)
-			{
-			  ++bufp;
-
-			  if (p)
-			    *p++ = L_('-');
-			  ++i;
-			}
-
-		      if (p)
-			memset_zero (p, padding);
-		      i += padding;
-		      width = 0;
-		    }
-		}
-	    }
-
-	  cpy (buf + sizeof (buf) / sizeof (buf[0]) - bufp, bufp);
-	  break;
-
-	case L_('F'):
-	  if (modifier != 0)
-	    goto bad_format;
-	  subfmt = L_("%Y-%m-%d");
-	  goto subformat;
-
-	case L_('H'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-
-	  DO_NUMBER (2, tp->tm_hour);
-
-	case L_('I'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-
-	  DO_NUMBER (2, hour12);
-
-	case L_('k'):		/* GNU extension.  */
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-
-	  DO_NUMBER_SPACEPAD (2, tp->tm_hour);
-
-	case L_('l'):		/* GNU extension.  */
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-
-	  DO_NUMBER_SPACEPAD (2, hour12);
-
-	case L_('j'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-
-	  DO_NUMBER (3, 1 + tp->tm_yday);
-
-	case L_('M'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-
-	  DO_NUMBER (2, tp->tm_min);
-
-	case L_('m'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-
-	  DO_NUMBER (2, tp->tm_mon + 1);
-
-	case L_('n'):
-	  add (1, *p = L_('\n'));
-	  break;
-
-	case L_('P'):
-	  to_lowcase = 1;
-#if !defined _NL_CURRENT && HAVE_STRFTIME
-	  format_char = L_('p');
-#endif
-	  /* FALLTHROUGH */
-
-	case L_('p'):
-	  if (change_case)
-	    {
-	      to_uppcase = 0;
-	      to_lowcase = 1;
-	    }
-#if defined _NL_CURRENT || !HAVE_STRFTIME
-	  cpy (ap_len, ampm);
-	  break;
-#else
-	  goto underlying_strftime;
-#endif
-
-	case L_('R'):
-	  subfmt = L_("%H:%M");
-	  goto subformat;
-
-	case L_('r'):
-#if !defined _NL_CURRENT && HAVE_STRFTIME
-	  goto underlying_strftime;
-#else
-# ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-	  if (*(subfmt = (const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME,
-						       NLW(T_FMT_AMPM)))
-	      == L_('\0'))
-# endif
-	    subfmt = L_("%I:%M:%S %p");
-	  goto subformat;
-#endif
-
-	case L_('S'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-
-	  DO_NUMBER (2, tp->tm_sec);
-
-	case L_('s'):		/* GNU extension.  */
-  	  {
-	    struct tm ltm;
-	    time_t t;
-
-	    ltm = *tp;
-	    t = mktime (&ltm);
-
-	    /* Generate string value for T using time_t arithmetic;
-	       this works even if sizeof (long) < sizeof (time_t).  */
-
-	    bufp = buf + sizeof (buf) / sizeof (buf[0]);
-	    negative_number = t < 0;
-
-	    do
-	      {
-		int d = t % 10;
-		t /= 10;
-
-		if (negative_number)
-		  {
-		    d = -d;
-
-		    /* Adjust if division truncates to minus infinity.  */
-		    if (0 < -1 % 10 && d < 0)
-		      {
-			t++;
-			d += 10;
-		      }
-		  }
-
-		*--bufp = d + L_('0');
-	      }
-	    while (t != 0);
-
-	    digits = 1;
-	    goto do_number_sign_and_padding;
-	  }
-
-	case L_('X'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('O'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-	  if (! (modifier == L_('E')
-		 && (*(subfmt =
-		       (const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(ERA_T_FMT)))
-		     != L_('\0'))))
-	    subfmt = (const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(T_FMT));
-	  goto subformat;
-#else
-# if HAVE_STRFTIME
-	  goto underlying_strftime;
-# else
-	  /* Fall through.  */
-# endif
-#endif
-	case L_('T'):
-	  subfmt = L_("%H:%M:%S");
-	  goto subformat;
-
-	case L_('t'):
-	  add (1, *p = L_('\t'));
-	  break;
-
-	case L_('u'):
-	  DO_NUMBER (1, (tp->tm_wday - 1 + 7) % 7 + 1);
-
-	case L_('U'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-
-	  DO_NUMBER (2, (tp->tm_yday - tp->tm_wday + 7) / 7);
-
-	case L_('V'):
-	case L_('g'):
-	case L_('G'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-	  {
-	    int year = tp->tm_year + TM_YEAR_BASE;
-	    int days = iso_week_days (tp->tm_yday, tp->tm_wday);
-
-	    if (days < 0)
-	      {
-		/* This ISO week belongs to the previous year.  */
-		year--;
-		days = iso_week_days (tp->tm_yday + (365 + __isleap (year)),
-				      tp->tm_wday);
-	      }
-	    else
-	      {
-		int d = iso_week_days (tp->tm_yday - (365 + __isleap (year)),
-				       tp->tm_wday);
-		if (0 <= d)
-		  {
-		    /* This ISO week belongs to the next year.  */
-		    year++;
-		    days = d;
-		  }
-	      }
-
-	    switch (*f)
-	      {
-	      case L_('g'):
-		DO_NUMBER (2, (year % 100 + 100) % 100);
-
-	      case L_('G'):
-		DO_NUMBER (1, year);
-
-	      default:
-		DO_NUMBER (2, days / 7 + 1);
-	      }
-	  }
-
-	case L_('W'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-
-	  DO_NUMBER (2, (tp->tm_yday - (tp->tm_wday - 1 + 7) % 7 + 7) / 7);
-
-	case L_('w'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-
-	  DO_NUMBER (1, tp->tm_wday);
-
-	case L_('Y'):
-	  if (modifier == 'E')
-	    {
-#if HAVE_STRUCT_ERA_ENTRY
-	      struct era_entry *era = _nl_get_era_entry (tp HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
-	      if (era)
-		{
-# ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
-		  subfmt = era->era_wformat;
-# else
-		  subfmt = era->era_format;
-# endif
-		  goto subformat;
-		}
-#else
-# if HAVE_STRFTIME
-	      goto underlying_strftime;
-# endif
-#endif
-	    }
-	  if (modifier == L_('O'))
-	    goto bad_format;
-	  else
-	    DO_NUMBER (1, tp->tm_year + TM_YEAR_BASE);
-
-	case L_('y'):
-	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
-	    {
-#if HAVE_STRUCT_ERA_ENTRY
-	      struct era_entry *era = _nl_get_era_entry (tp HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
-	      if (era)
-		{
-		  int delta = tp->tm_year - era->start_date[0];
-		  DO_NUMBER (1, (era->offset
-				 + delta * era->absolute_direction));
-		}
-#else
-# if HAVE_STRFTIME
-	      goto underlying_strftime;
-# endif
-#endif
-	    }
-	  DO_NUMBER (2, (tp->tm_year % 100 + 100) % 100);
-
-	case L_('Z'):
-	  if (change_case)
-	    {
-	      to_uppcase = 0;
-	      to_lowcase = 1;
-	    }
-
-#if HAVE_TZNAME
-	  /* The tzset() call might have changed the value.  */
-	  if (!(zone && *zone) && tp->tm_isdst >= 0)
-	    zone = tzname[tp->tm_isdst];
-#endif
-	  if (! zone)
-	    zone = "";
-
-#ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
-	  {
-	    /* The zone string is always given in multibyte form.  We have
-	       to transform it first.  */
-	    wchar_t *wczone;
-	    size_t len;
-	    widen (zone, wczone, len);
-	    cpy (len, wczone);
-	  }
-#else
-	  cpy (strlen (zone), zone);
-#endif
-	  break;
-
-	case L_('z'):
-	  if (tp->tm_isdst < 0)
-	    break;
-
-	  {
-	    int diff;
-#if HAVE_TM_GMTOFF
-	    diff = tp->tm_gmtoff;
-#else
-	    if (ut)
-	      diff = 0;
-	    else
-	      {
-		struct tm gtm;
-		struct tm ltm;
-		time_t lt;
-
-		ltm = *tp;
-		lt = mktime (&ltm);
-
-		if (lt == (time_t) -1)
-		  {
-		    /* mktime returns -1 for errors, but -1 is also a
-		       valid time_t value.  Check whether an error really
-		       occurred.  */
-		    struct tm tm;
-
-		    if (! __localtime_r (&lt, &tm)
-			|| ((ltm.tm_sec ^ tm.tm_sec)
-			    | (ltm.tm_min ^ tm.tm_min)
-			    | (ltm.tm_hour ^ tm.tm_hour)
-			    | (ltm.tm_mday ^ tm.tm_mday)
-			    | (ltm.tm_mon ^ tm.tm_mon)
-			    | (ltm.tm_year ^ tm.tm_year)))
-		      break;
-		  }
-
-		if (! __gmtime_r (&lt, &gtm))
-		  break;
-
-		diff = tm_diff (&ltm, &gtm);
-	      }
-#endif
-
-	    if (diff < 0)
-	      {
-		add (1, *p = L_('-'));
-		diff = -diff;
-	      }
-	    else
-	      add (1, *p = L_('+'));
-
-	    diff /= 60;
-	    DO_NUMBER (4, (diff / 60) * 100 + diff % 60);
-	  }
-
-	case L_('\0'):		/* GNU extension: % at end of format.  */
-	    --f;
-	    /* Fall through.  */
-	default:
-	  /* Unknown format; output the format, including the '%',
-	     since this is most likely the right thing to do if a
-	     multibyte string has been misparsed.  */
-	bad_format:
-	  {
-	    int flen;
-	    for (flen = 1; f[1 - flen] != L_('%'); flen++)
-	      continue;
-	    cpy (flen, &f[1 - flen]);
-	  }
-	  break;
-	}
-    }
-
-  if (p && maxsize != 0)
-    *p = L_('\0');
-  return i;
-}
-#ifdef _LIBC
-libc_hidden_def (my_strftime)
-#endif
-
-
-#ifdef emacs
-/* For Emacs we have a separate interface which corresponds to the normal
-   strftime function and does not have the extra information whether the
-   TP arguments comes from a `gmtime' call or not.  */
 size_t
-emacs_strftime (s, maxsize, format, tp)
-      char *s;
-      size_t maxsize;
-      const char *format;
-      const struct tm *tp;
+strftime (char *s, size_t maxsize, const char *format, const struct tm *tp)
 {
-  return my_strftime (s, maxsize, format, tp, 0);
+  return __strftime_l (s, maxsize, format, tp, _NL_CURRENT_LOCALE);
 }
-#endif
+libc_hidden_def (strftime)
diff --git a/time/strftime_l.c b/time/strftime_l.c
index c6ecada4ce..6cae85d32f 100644
--- a/time/strftime_l.c
+++ b/time/strftime_l.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
 
    The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
@@ -16,7 +16,1427 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL 1
-#include <strftime.c>
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
 
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL 1
+# define HAVE_LIMITS_H 1
+# define HAVE_MBLEN 1
+# define HAVE_MBRLEN 1
+# define HAVE_STRUCT_ERA_ENTRY 1
+# define HAVE_TM_GMTOFF 1
+# define HAVE_TM_ZONE 1
+# define HAVE_TZNAME 1
+# define HAVE_TZSET 1
+# define MULTIBYTE_IS_FORMAT_SAFE 1
+# define STDC_HEADERS 1
+# include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
+#endif
+
+#if defined emacs && !defined HAVE_BCOPY
+# define HAVE_MEMCPY 1
+#endif
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>		/* Some systems define `time_t' here.  */
+
+#ifdef TIME_WITH_SYS_TIME
+# include <sys/time.h>
+# include <time.h>
+#else
+# ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
+#  include <sys/time.h>
+# else
+#  include <time.h>
+# endif
+#endif
+#if HAVE_TZNAME
+extern char *tzname[];
+#endif
+
+/* Do multibyte processing if multibytes are supported, unless
+   multibyte sequences are safe in formats.  Multibyte sequences are
+   safe if they cannot contain byte sequences that look like format
+   conversion specifications.  The GNU C Library uses UTF8 multibyte
+   encoding, which is safe for formats, but strftime.c can be used
+   with other C libraries that use unsafe encodings.  */
+#define DO_MULTIBYTE (HAVE_MBLEN && ! MULTIBYTE_IS_FORMAT_SAFE)
+
+#if DO_MULTIBYTE
+# if HAVE_MBRLEN
+#  include <wchar.h>
+# else
+   /* Simulate mbrlen with mblen as best we can.  */
+#  define mbstate_t int
+#  define mbrlen(s, n, ps) mblen (s, n)
+#  define mbsinit(ps) (*(ps) == 0)
+# endif
+  static const mbstate_t mbstate_zero;
+#endif
+
+#if HAVE_LIMITS_H
+# include <limits.h>
+#endif
+
+#if STDC_HEADERS
+# include <stddef.h>
+# include <stdlib.h>
+# include <string.h>
+#else
+# ifndef HAVE_MEMCPY
+#  define memcpy(d, s, n) bcopy ((s), (d), (n))
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
+# include <endian.h>
+# define CHAR_T wchar_t
+# define UCHAR_T unsigned int
+# define L_(Str) L##Str
+# define NLW(Sym) _NL_W##Sym
+
+# define MEMCPY(d, s, n) __wmemcpy (d, s, n)
+# define STRLEN(s) __wcslen (s)
+
+#else
+# define CHAR_T char
+# define UCHAR_T unsigned char
+# define L_(Str) Str
+# define NLW(Sym) Sym
+
+# if !defined STDC_HEADERS && !defined HAVE_MEMCPY
+#  define MEMCPY(d, s, n) bcopy ((s), (d), (n))
+# else
+#  define MEMCPY(d, s, n) memcpy ((d), (s), (n))
+# endif
+# define STRLEN(s) strlen (s)
+
+# ifdef _LIBC
+#  define MEMPCPY(d, s, n) __mempcpy (d, s, n)
+# else
+#  ifndef HAVE_MEMPCPY
+#   define MEMPCPY(d, s, n) ((void *) ((char *) memcpy (d, s, n) + (n)))
+#  endif
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#ifndef __P
+# if defined __GNUC__ || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
+#  define __P(args) args
+# else
+#  define __P(args) ()
+# endif  /* GCC.  */
+#endif  /* Not __P.  */
+
+#ifndef PTR
+# ifdef __STDC__
+#  define PTR void *
+# else
+#  define PTR char *
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#ifndef CHAR_BIT
+# define CHAR_BIT 8
+#endif
+
+#ifndef NULL
+# define NULL 0
+#endif
+
+#define TYPE_SIGNED(t) ((t) -1 < 0)
+
+/* Bound on length of the string representing an integer value of type t.
+   Subtract one for the sign bit if t is signed;
+   302 / 1000 is log10 (2) rounded up;
+   add one for integer division truncation;
+   add one more for a minus sign if t is signed.  */
+#define INT_STRLEN_BOUND(t) \
+ ((sizeof (t) * CHAR_BIT - TYPE_SIGNED (t)) * 302 / 1000 + 1 + TYPE_SIGNED (t))
+
+#define TM_YEAR_BASE 1900
+
+#ifndef __isleap
+/* Nonzero if YEAR is a leap year (every 4 years,
+   except every 100th isn't, and every 400th is).  */
+# define __isleap(year)	\
+  ((year) % 4 == 0 && ((year) % 100 != 0 || (year) % 400 == 0))
+#endif
+
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# define tzname __tzname
+# define tzset __tzset
+#endif
+
+#if !HAVE_TM_GMTOFF
+/* Portable standalone applications should supply a "time_r.h" that
+   declares a POSIX-compliant localtime_r, for the benefit of older
+   implementations that lack localtime_r or have a nonstandard one.
+   Similarly for gmtime_r.  See the gnulib time_r module for one way
+   to implement this.  */
+# include "time_r.h"
+# undef __gmtime_r
+# undef __localtime_r
+# define __gmtime_r gmtime_r
+# define __localtime_r localtime_r
+#endif
+
+
+#if !defined memset && !defined HAVE_MEMSET && !defined _LIBC
+/* Some systems lack the `memset' function and we don't want to
+   introduce additional dependencies.  */
+/* The SGI compiler reportedly barfs on the trailing null
+   if we use a string constant as the initializer.  28 June 1997, rms.  */
+static const CHAR_T spaces[16] = /* "                " */
+{
+  L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),
+  L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' '),L_(' ')
+};
+static const CHAR_T zeroes[16] = /* "0000000000000000" */
+{
+  L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),
+  L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0'),L_('0')
+};
+
+# define memset_space(P, Len) \
+  do {									      \
+    int _len = (Len);							      \
+									      \
+    do									      \
+      {									      \
+	int _this = _len > 16 ? 16 : _len;				      \
+	(P) = MEMPCPY ((P), spaces, _this * sizeof (CHAR_T));		      \
+	_len -= _this;							      \
+      }									      \
+    while (_len > 0);							      \
+  } while (0)
+
+# define memset_zero(P, Len) \
+  do {									      \
+    int _len = (Len);							      \
+									      \
+    do									      \
+      {									      \
+	int _this = _len > 16 ? 16 : _len;				      \
+	(P) = MEMPCPY ((P), zeroes, _this * sizeof (CHAR_T));		      \
+	_len -= _this;							      \
+      }									      \
+    while (_len > 0);							      \
+  } while (0)
+#else
+# ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
+#  define memset_space(P, Len) (wmemset ((P), L' ', (Len)), (P) += (Len))
+#  define memset_zero(P, Len) (wmemset ((P), L'0', (Len)), (P) += (Len))
+# else
+#  define memset_space(P, Len) (memset ((P), ' ', (Len)), (P) += (Len))
+#  define memset_zero(P, Len) (memset ((P), '0', (Len)), (P) += (Len))
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#define add(n, f)							      \
+  do									      \
+    {									      \
+      int _n = (n);							      \
+      int _delta = width - _n;						      \
+      int _incr = _n + (_delta > 0 ? _delta : 0);			      \
+      if ((size_t) _incr >= maxsize - i)				      \
+	return 0;							      \
+      if (p)								      \
+	{								      \
+	  if (_delta > 0)						      \
+	    {								      \
+	      if (pad == L_('0'))					      \
+		memset_zero (p, _delta);				      \
+	      else							      \
+		memset_space (p, _delta);				      \
+	    }								      \
+	  f;								      \
+	  p += _n;							      \
+	}								      \
+      i += _incr;							      \
+    } while (0)
+
+#define cpy(n, s) \
+    add ((n),								      \
+	 if (to_lowcase)						      \
+	   memcpy_lowcase (p, (s), _n LOCALE_ARG);			      \
+	 else if (to_uppcase)						      \
+	   memcpy_uppcase (p, (s), _n LOCALE_ARG);			      \
+	 else								      \
+	   MEMCPY ((PTR) p, (const PTR) (s), _n))
+
+#ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
+# ifndef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
+#  undef __mbsrtowcs_l
+#  define __mbsrtowcs_l(d, s, l, st, loc) __mbsrtowcs (d, s, l, st)
+# endif
+# define widen(os, ws, l) \
+  {									      \
+    mbstate_t __st;							      \
+    const char *__s = os;						      \
+    memset (&__st, '\0', sizeof (__st));				      \
+    l = __mbsrtowcs_l (NULL, &__s, 0, &__st, loc);			      \
+    ws = alloca ((l + 1) * sizeof (wchar_t));				      \
+    (void) __mbsrtowcs_l (ws, &__s, l, &__st, loc);			      \
+  }
+#endif
+
+
+#if defined _LIBC && defined USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
+/* We use this code also for the extended locale handling where the
+   function gets as an additional argument the locale which has to be
+   used.  To access the values we have to redefine the _NL_CURRENT
+   macro.  */
+# define strftime		__strftime_l
+# define wcsftime		__wcsftime_l
+# undef _NL_CURRENT
+# define _NL_CURRENT(category, item) \
+  (current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (item)].string)
+# define LOCALE_PARAM , loc
+# define LOCALE_ARG , loc
+# define LOCALE_PARAM_DECL  __locale_t loc;
+# define LOCALE_PARAM_PROTO , __locale_t loc
+# define HELPER_LOCALE_ARG  , current
+#else
+# define LOCALE_PARAM
+# define LOCALE_PARAM_PROTO
+# define LOCALE_ARG
+# define LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
+# ifdef _LIBC
+#  define HELPER_LOCALE_ARG , _NL_CURRENT_DATA (LC_TIME)
+# else
+#  define HELPER_LOCALE_ARG
+# endif
+#endif
+
+#ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
+# ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
+#  define TOUPPER(Ch, L) __towupper_l (Ch, L)
+#  define TOLOWER(Ch, L) __towlower_l (Ch, L)
+# else
+#  define TOUPPER(Ch, L) towupper (Ch)
+#  define TOLOWER(Ch, L) towlower (Ch)
+# endif
+#else
+# ifdef _LIBC
+#  ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
+#   define TOUPPER(Ch, L) __toupper_l (Ch, L)
+#   define TOLOWER(Ch, L) __tolower_l (Ch, L)
+#  else
+#   define TOUPPER(Ch, L) toupper (Ch)
+#   define TOLOWER(Ch, L) tolower (Ch)
+#  endif
+# else
+#  define TOUPPER(Ch, L) (islower (Ch) ? toupper (Ch) : (Ch))
+#  define TOLOWER(Ch, L) (isupper (Ch) ? tolower (Ch) : (Ch))
+# endif
+#endif
+/* We don't use `isdigit' here since the locale dependent
+   interpretation is not what we want here.  We only need to accept
+   the arabic digits in the ASCII range.  One day there is perhaps a
+   more reliable way to accept other sets of digits.  */
+#define ISDIGIT(Ch) ((unsigned int) (Ch) - L_('0') <= 9)
+
+static CHAR_T *memcpy_lowcase __P ((CHAR_T *dest, const CHAR_T *src,
+				    size_t len LOCALE_PARAM_PROTO));
+
+static CHAR_T *
+memcpy_lowcase (dest, src, len LOCALE_PARAM)
+     CHAR_T *dest;
+     const CHAR_T *src;
+     size_t len;
+     LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
+{
+  while (len-- > 0)
+    dest[len] = TOLOWER ((UCHAR_T) src[len], loc);
+  return dest;
+}
+
+static CHAR_T *memcpy_uppcase __P ((CHAR_T *dest, const CHAR_T *src,
+				    size_t len LOCALE_PARAM_PROTO));
+
+static CHAR_T *
+memcpy_uppcase (dest, src, len LOCALE_PARAM)
+     CHAR_T *dest;
+     const CHAR_T *src;
+     size_t len;
+     LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
+{
+  while (len-- > 0)
+    dest[len] = TOUPPER ((UCHAR_T) src[len], loc);
+  return dest;
+}
+
+
+#if ! HAVE_TM_GMTOFF
+/* Yield the difference between *A and *B,
+   measured in seconds, ignoring leap seconds.  */
+# define tm_diff ftime_tm_diff
+static int tm_diff __P ((const struct tm *, const struct tm *));
+static int
+tm_diff (a, b)
+     const struct tm *a;
+     const struct tm *b;
+{
+  /* Compute intervening leap days correctly even if year is negative.
+     Take care to avoid int overflow in leap day calculations,
+     but it's OK to assume that A and B are close to each other.  */
+  int a4 = (a->tm_year >> 2) + (TM_YEAR_BASE >> 2) - ! (a->tm_year & 3);
+  int b4 = (b->tm_year >> 2) + (TM_YEAR_BASE >> 2) - ! (b->tm_year & 3);
+  int a100 = a4 / 25 - (a4 % 25 < 0);
+  int b100 = b4 / 25 - (b4 % 25 < 0);
+  int a400 = a100 >> 2;
+  int b400 = b100 >> 2;
+  int intervening_leap_days = (a4 - b4) - (a100 - b100) + (a400 - b400);
+  int years = a->tm_year - b->tm_year;
+  int days = (365 * years + intervening_leap_days
+	      + (a->tm_yday - b->tm_yday));
+  return (60 * (60 * (24 * days + (a->tm_hour - b->tm_hour))
+		+ (a->tm_min - b->tm_min))
+	  + (a->tm_sec - b->tm_sec));
+}
+#endif /* ! HAVE_TM_GMTOFF */
+
+
+
+/* The number of days from the first day of the first ISO week of this
+   year to the year day YDAY with week day WDAY.  ISO weeks start on
+   Monday; the first ISO week has the year's first Thursday.  YDAY may
+   be as small as YDAY_MINIMUM.  */
+#define ISO_WEEK_START_WDAY 1 /* Monday */
+#define ISO_WEEK1_WDAY 4 /* Thursday */
+#define YDAY_MINIMUM (-366)
+static int iso_week_days __P ((int, int));
+#ifdef __GNUC__
+__inline__
+#endif
+static int
+iso_week_days (yday, wday)
+     int yday;
+     int wday;
+{
+  /* Add enough to the first operand of % to make it nonnegative.  */
+  int big_enough_multiple_of_7 = (-YDAY_MINIMUM / 7 + 2) * 7;
+  return (yday
+	  - (yday - wday + ISO_WEEK1_WDAY + big_enough_multiple_of_7) % 7
+	  + ISO_WEEK1_WDAY - ISO_WEEK_START_WDAY);
+}
+
+
+#if !(defined _NL_CURRENT || HAVE_STRFTIME)
+static CHAR_T const weekday_name[][10] =
+  {
+    L_("Sunday"), L_("Monday"), L_("Tuesday"), L_("Wednesday"),
+    L_("Thursday"), L_("Friday"), L_("Saturday")
+  };
+static CHAR_T const month_name[][10] =
+  {
+    L_("January"), L_("February"), L_("March"), L_("April"), L_("May"),
+    L_("June"), L_("July"), L_("August"), L_("September"), L_("October"),
+    L_("November"), L_("December")
+  };
+#endif
+
+
+#ifdef emacs
+# define my_strftime emacs_strftimeu
+# define ut_argument , ut
+# define ut_argument_spec int ut;
+# define ut_argument_spec_iso , int ut
+#else
+# ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
+#  define my_strftime wcsftime
+#  define nl_get_alt_digit _nl_get_walt_digit
+# else
+#  define my_strftime strftime
+#  define nl_get_alt_digit _nl_get_alt_digit
+# endif
+# define ut_argument
+# define ut_argument_spec
+# define ut_argument_spec_iso
+/* We don't have this information in general.  */
+# define ut 0
+#endif
+
+#if !defined _LIBC && HAVE_TZNAME && HAVE_TZSET
+  /* Solaris 2.5 tzset sometimes modifies the storage returned by localtime.
+     Work around this bug by copying *tp before it might be munged.  */
+  size_t _strftime_copytm __P ((char *, size_t, const char *,
+			        const struct tm * ut_argument_spec_iso));
+  size_t
+  my_strftime (s, maxsize, format, tp ut_argument)
+      CHAR_T *s;
+      size_t maxsize;
+      const CHAR_T *format;
+      const struct tm *tp;
+      ut_argument_spec
+  {
+    struct tm tmcopy;
+    tmcopy = *tp;
+    return _strftime_copytm (s, maxsize, format, &tmcopy ut_argument);
+  }
+# undef my_strftime
+# define my_strftime _strftime_copytm
+#endif
+
+
+/* Write information from TP into S according to the format
+   string FORMAT, writing no more that MAXSIZE characters
+   (including the terminating '\0') and returning number of
+   characters written.  If S is NULL, nothing will be written
+   anywhere, so to determine how many characters would be
+   written, use NULL for S and (size_t) UINT_MAX for MAXSIZE.  */
+size_t
+my_strftime (s, maxsize, format, tp ut_argument LOCALE_PARAM)
+      CHAR_T *s;
+      size_t maxsize;
+      const CHAR_T *format;
+      const struct tm *tp;
+      ut_argument_spec
+      LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
+{
+#if defined _LIBC && defined USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
+  struct locale_data *const current = loc->__locales[LC_TIME];
+#endif
+
+  int hour12 = tp->tm_hour;
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+  /* We cannot make the following values variables since we must delay
+     the evaluation of these values until really needed since some
+     expressions might not be valid in every situation.  The `struct tm'
+     might be generated by a strptime() call that initialized
+     only a few elements.  Dereference the pointers only if the format
+     requires this.  Then it is ok to fail if the pointers are invalid.  */
+# define a_wkday \
+  ((const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(ABDAY_1) + tp->tm_wday))
+# define f_wkday \
+  ((const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(DAY_1) + tp->tm_wday))
+# define a_month \
+  ((const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(ABMON_1) + tp->tm_mon))
+# define f_month \
+  ((const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(MON_1) + tp->tm_mon))
+# define ampm \
+  ((const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, tp->tm_hour > 11		      \
+				 ? NLW(PM_STR) : NLW(AM_STR)))
+
+# define aw_len STRLEN (a_wkday)
+# define am_len STRLEN (a_month)
+# define ap_len STRLEN (ampm)
+#else
+# if !HAVE_STRFTIME
+#  define f_wkday (weekday_name[tp->tm_wday])
+#  define f_month (month_name[tp->tm_mon])
+#  define a_wkday f_wkday
+#  define a_month f_month
+#  define ampm (L_("AMPM") + 2 * (tp->tm_hour > 11))
+
+  size_t aw_len = 3;
+  size_t am_len = 3;
+  size_t ap_len = 2;
+# endif
+#endif
+  const char *zone;
+  size_t i = 0;
+  CHAR_T *p = s;
+  const CHAR_T *f;
+#if DO_MULTIBYTE && !defined COMPILE_WIDE
+  const char *format_end = NULL;
+#endif
+
+  zone = NULL;
+#if HAVE_TM_ZONE
+  /* The POSIX test suite assumes that setting
+     the environment variable TZ to a new value before calling strftime()
+     will influence the result (the %Z format) even if the information in
+     TP is computed with a totally different time zone.
+     This is bogus: though POSIX allows bad behavior like this,
+     POSIX does not require it.  Do the right thing instead.  */
+  zone = (const char *) tp->tm_zone;
+#endif
+#if HAVE_TZNAME
+  if (ut)
+    {
+      if (! (zone && *zone))
+	zone = "GMT";
+    }
+  else
+    {
+      /* POSIX.1 requires that local time zone information is used as
+	 though strftime called tzset.  */
+# if HAVE_TZSET
+      tzset ();
+# endif
+    }
+#endif
+
+  if (hour12 > 12)
+    hour12 -= 12;
+  else
+    if (hour12 == 0)
+      hour12 = 12;
+
+  for (f = format; *f != '\0'; ++f)
+    {
+      int pad = 0;		/* Padding for number ('-', '_', or 0).  */
+      int modifier;		/* Field modifier ('E', 'O', or 0).  */
+      int digits;		/* Max digits for numeric format.  */
+      int number_value; 	/* Numeric value to be printed.  */
+      int negative_number;	/* 1 if the number is negative.  */
+      const CHAR_T *subfmt;
+      CHAR_T *bufp;
+      CHAR_T buf[1 + (sizeof (int) < sizeof (time_t)
+		      ? INT_STRLEN_BOUND (time_t)
+		      : INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int))];
+      int width = -1;
+      int to_lowcase = 0;
+      int to_uppcase = 0;
+      int change_case = 0;
+      int format_char;
+
+#if DO_MULTIBYTE && !defined COMPILE_WIDE
+      switch (*f)
+	{
+	case L_('%'):
+	  break;
+
+	case L_('\b'): case L_('\t'): case L_('\n'):
+	case L_('\v'): case L_('\f'): case L_('\r'):
+	case L_(' '): case L_('!'): case L_('"'): case L_('#'): case L_('&'):
+	case L_('\''): case L_('('): case L_(')'): case L_('*'): case L_('+'):
+	case L_(','): case L_('-'): case L_('.'): case L_('/'): case L_('0'):
+	case L_('1'): case L_('2'): case L_('3'): case L_('4'): case L_('5'):
+	case L_('6'): case L_('7'): case L_('8'): case L_('9'): case L_(':'):
+	case L_(';'): case L_('<'): case L_('='): case L_('>'): case L_('?'):
+	case L_('A'): case L_('B'): case L_('C'): case L_('D'): case L_('E'):
+	case L_('F'): case L_('G'): case L_('H'): case L_('I'): case L_('J'):
+	case L_('K'): case L_('L'): case L_('M'): case L_('N'): case L_('O'):
+	case L_('P'): case L_('Q'): case L_('R'): case L_('S'): case L_('T'):
+	case L_('U'): case L_('V'): case L_('W'): case L_('X'): case L_('Y'):
+	case L_('Z'): case L_('['): case L_('\\'): case L_(']'): case L_('^'):
+	case L_('_'): case L_('a'): case L_('b'): case L_('c'): case L_('d'):
+	case L_('e'): case L_('f'): case L_('g'): case L_('h'): case L_('i'):
+	case L_('j'): case L_('k'): case L_('l'): case L_('m'): case L_('n'):
+	case L_('o'): case L_('p'): case L_('q'): case L_('r'): case L_('s'):
+	case L_('t'): case L_('u'): case L_('v'): case L_('w'): case L_('x'):
+	case L_('y'): case L_('z'): case L_('{'): case L_('|'): case L_('}'):
+	case L_('~'):
+	  /* The C Standard requires these 98 characters (plus '%') to
+	     be in the basic execution character set.  None of these
+	     characters can start a multibyte sequence, so they need
+	     not be analyzed further.  */
+	  add (1, *p = *f);
+	  continue;
+
+	default:
+	  /* Copy this multibyte sequence until we reach its end, find
+	     an error, or come back to the initial shift state.  */
+	  {
+	    mbstate_t mbstate = mbstate_zero;
+	    size_t len = 0;
+	    size_t fsize;
+
+	    if (! format_end)
+	      format_end = f + strlen (f) + 1;
+	    fsize = format_end - f;
+
+	    do
+	      {
+		size_t bytes = mbrlen (f + len, fsize - len, &mbstate);
+
+		if (bytes == 0)
+		  break;
+
+		if (bytes == (size_t) -2)
+		  {
+		    len += strlen (f + len);
+		    break;
+		  }
+
+		if (bytes == (size_t) -1)
+		  {
+		    len++;
+		    break;
+		  }
+
+		len += bytes;
+	      }
+	    while (! mbsinit (&mbstate));
+
+	    cpy (len, f);
+	    f += len - 1;
+	    continue;
+	  }
+	}
+
+#else /* ! DO_MULTIBYTE */
+
+      /* Either multibyte encodings are not supported, they are
+	 safe for formats, so any non-'%' byte can be copied through,
+	 or this is the wide character version.  */
+      if (*f != L_('%'))
+	{
+	  add (1, *p = *f);
+	  continue;
+	}
+
+#endif /* ! DO_MULTIBYTE */
+
+      /* Check for flags that can modify a format.  */
+      while (1)
+	{
+	  switch (*++f)
+	    {
+	      /* This influences the number formats.  */
+	    case L_('_'):
+	    case L_('-'):
+	    case L_('0'):
+	      pad = *f;
+	      continue;
+
+	      /* This changes textual output.  */
+	    case L_('^'):
+	      to_uppcase = 1;
+	      continue;
+	    case L_('#'):
+	      change_case = 1;
+	      continue;
+
+	    default:
+	      break;
+	    }
+	  break;
+	}
+
+      /* As a GNU extension we allow to specify the field width.  */
+      if (ISDIGIT (*f))
+	{
+	  width = 0;
+	  do
+	    {
+	      if (width > INT_MAX / 10
+		  || (width == INT_MAX / 10 && *f - L_('0') > INT_MAX % 10))
+		/* Avoid overflow.  */
+		width = INT_MAX;
+	      else
+		{
+		  width *= 10;
+		  width += *f - L_('0');
+		}
+	      ++f;
+	    }
+	  while (ISDIGIT (*f));
+	}
+
+      /* Check for modifiers.  */
+      switch (*f)
+	{
+	case L_('E'):
+	case L_('O'):
+	  modifier = *f++;
+	  break;
+
+	default:
+	  modifier = 0;
+	  break;
+	}
+
+      /* Now do the specified format.  */
+      format_char = *f;
+      switch (format_char)
+	{
+#define DO_NUMBER(d, v) \
+	  digits = d > width ? d : width;				      \
+	  number_value = v; goto do_number
+#define DO_NUMBER_SPACEPAD(d, v) \
+	  digits = d > width ? d : width;				      \
+	  number_value = v; goto do_number_spacepad
+
+	case L_('%'):
+	  if (modifier != 0)
+	    goto bad_format;
+	  add (1, *p = *f);
+	  break;
+
+	case L_('a'):
+	  if (modifier != 0)
+	    goto bad_format;
+	  if (change_case)
+	    {
+	      to_uppcase = 1;
+	      to_lowcase = 0;
+	    }
+#if defined _NL_CURRENT || !HAVE_STRFTIME
+	  cpy (aw_len, a_wkday);
+	  break;
+#else
+	  goto underlying_strftime;
+#endif
+
+	case 'A':
+	  if (modifier != 0)
+	    goto bad_format;
+	  if (change_case)
+	    {
+	      to_uppcase = 1;
+	      to_lowcase = 0;
+	    }
+#if defined _NL_CURRENT || !HAVE_STRFTIME
+	  cpy (STRLEN (f_wkday), f_wkday);
+	  break;
+#else
+	  goto underlying_strftime;
+#endif
+
+	case L_('b'):
+	case L_('h'):
+	  if (change_case)
+	    {
+	      to_uppcase = 1;
+	      to_lowcase = 0;
+	    }
+	  if (modifier != 0)
+	    goto bad_format;
+#if defined _NL_CURRENT || !HAVE_STRFTIME
+	  cpy (am_len, a_month);
+	  break;
+#else
+	  goto underlying_strftime;
+#endif
+
+	case L_('B'):
+	  if (modifier != 0)
+	    goto bad_format;
+	  if (change_case)
+	    {
+	      to_uppcase = 1;
+	      to_lowcase = 0;
+	    }
+#if defined _NL_CURRENT || !HAVE_STRFTIME
+	  cpy (STRLEN (f_month), f_month);
+	  break;
+#else
+	  goto underlying_strftime;
+#endif
+
+	case L_('c'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('O'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+	  if (! (modifier == 'E'
+		 && (*(subfmt =
+		       (const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME,
+						     NLW(ERA_D_T_FMT)))
+		     != '\0')))
+	    subfmt = (const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(D_T_FMT));
+#else
+# if HAVE_STRFTIME
+	  goto underlying_strftime;
+# else
+	  subfmt = L_("%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Y");
+# endif
+#endif
+
+	subformat:
+	  {
+	    CHAR_T *old_start = p;
+	    size_t len = my_strftime (NULL, (size_t) -1, subfmt,
+				      tp ut_argument LOCALE_ARG);
+	    add (len, my_strftime (p, maxsize - i, subfmt,
+				   tp ut_argument LOCALE_ARG));
+
+	    if (to_uppcase)
+	      while (old_start < p)
+		{
+		  *old_start = TOUPPER ((UCHAR_T) *old_start, loc);
+		  ++old_start;
+		}
+	  }
+	  break;
+
+#if HAVE_STRFTIME && ! (defined _NL_CURRENT && HAVE_STRUCT_ERA_ENTRY)
+	underlying_strftime:
+	  {
+	    /* The relevant information is available only via the
+	       underlying strftime implementation, so use that.  */
+	    char ufmt[4];
+	    char *u = ufmt;
+	    char ubuf[1024]; /* enough for any single format in practice */
+	    size_t len;
+	    /* Make sure we're calling the actual underlying strftime.
+	       In some cases, config.h contains something like
+	       "#define strftime rpl_strftime".  */
+# ifdef strftime
+#  undef strftime
+	    size_t strftime ();
+# endif
+
+	    *u++ = '%';
+	    if (modifier != 0)
+	      *u++ = modifier;
+	    *u++ = format_char;
+	    *u = '\0';
+	    len = strftime (ubuf, sizeof ubuf, ufmt, tp);
+	    if (len == 0 && ubuf[0] != '\0')
+	      return 0;
+	    cpy (len, ubuf);
+	  }
+	  break;
+#endif
+
+	case L_('C'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('O'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    {
+#if HAVE_STRUCT_ERA_ENTRY
+	      struct era_entry *era = _nl_get_era_entry (tp HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
+	      if (era)
+		{
+# ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
+		  size_t len = __wcslen (era->era_wname);
+		  cpy (len, era->era_wname);
+# else
+		  size_t len = strlen (era->era_name);
+		  cpy (len, era->era_name);
+# endif
+		  break;
+		}
+#else
+# if HAVE_STRFTIME
+	      goto underlying_strftime;
+# endif
+#endif
+	    }
+
+	  {
+	    int year = tp->tm_year + TM_YEAR_BASE;
+	    DO_NUMBER (1, year / 100 - (year % 100 < 0));
+	  }
+
+	case L_('x'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('O'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+	  if (! (modifier == L_('E')
+		 && (*(subfmt =
+		       (const CHAR_T *)_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(ERA_D_FMT)))
+		     != L_('\0'))))
+	    subfmt = (const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(D_FMT));
+	  goto subformat;
+#else
+# if HAVE_STRFTIME
+	  goto underlying_strftime;
+# else
+	  /* Fall through.  */
+# endif
+#endif
+	case L_('D'):
+	  if (modifier != 0)
+	    goto bad_format;
+	  subfmt = L_("%m/%d/%y");
+	  goto subformat;
+
+	case L_('d'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+
+	  DO_NUMBER (2, tp->tm_mday);
+
+	case L_('e'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+
+	  DO_NUMBER_SPACEPAD (2, tp->tm_mday);
+
+	  /* All numeric formats set DIGITS and NUMBER_VALUE and then
+	     jump to one of these two labels.  */
+
+	do_number_spacepad:
+	  /* Force `_' flag unless overwritten by `0' or '-' flag.  */
+	  if (pad != L_('0') && pad != L_('-'))
+	    pad = L_('_');
+
+	do_number:
+	  /* Format the number according to the MODIFIER flag.  */
+
+	  if (modifier == L_('O') && 0 <= number_value)
+	    {
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+	      /* Get the locale specific alternate representation of
+		 the number NUMBER_VALUE.  If none exist NULL is returned.  */
+	      const CHAR_T *cp = nl_get_alt_digit (number_value
+						   HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
+
+	      if (cp != NULL)
+		{
+		  size_t digitlen = STRLEN (cp);
+		  if (digitlen != 0)
+		    {
+		      cpy (digitlen, cp);
+		      break;
+		    }
+		}
+#else
+# if HAVE_STRFTIME
+	      goto underlying_strftime;
+# endif
+#endif
+	    }
+	  {
+	    unsigned int u = number_value;
+
+	    bufp = buf + sizeof (buf) / sizeof (buf[0]);
+	    negative_number = number_value < 0;
+
+	    if (negative_number)
+	      u = -u;
+
+	    do
+	      *--bufp = u % 10 + L_('0');
+	    while ((u /= 10) != 0);
+  	  }
+
+	do_number_sign_and_padding:
+	  if (negative_number)
+	    *--bufp = L_('-');
+
+	  if (pad != L_('-'))
+	    {
+	      int padding = digits - (buf + (sizeof (buf) / sizeof (buf[0]))
+				      - bufp);
+
+	      if (padding > 0)
+		{
+		  if (pad == L_('_'))
+		    {
+		      if ((size_t) padding >= maxsize - i)
+			return 0;
+
+		      if (p)
+			memset_space (p, padding);
+		      i += padding;
+		      width = width > padding ? width - padding : 0;
+		    }
+		  else
+		    {
+		      if ((size_t) digits >= maxsize - i)
+			return 0;
+
+		      if (negative_number)
+			{
+			  ++bufp;
+
+			  if (p)
+			    *p++ = L_('-');
+			  ++i;
+			}
+
+		      if (p)
+			memset_zero (p, padding);
+		      i += padding;
+		      width = 0;
+		    }
+		}
+	    }
+
+	  cpy (buf + sizeof (buf) / sizeof (buf[0]) - bufp, bufp);
+	  break;
+
+	case L_('F'):
+	  if (modifier != 0)
+	    goto bad_format;
+	  subfmt = L_("%Y-%m-%d");
+	  goto subformat;
+
+	case L_('H'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+
+	  DO_NUMBER (2, tp->tm_hour);
+
+	case L_('I'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+
+	  DO_NUMBER (2, hour12);
+
+	case L_('k'):		/* GNU extension.  */
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+
+	  DO_NUMBER_SPACEPAD (2, tp->tm_hour);
+
+	case L_('l'):		/* GNU extension.  */
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+
+	  DO_NUMBER_SPACEPAD (2, hour12);
+
+	case L_('j'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+
+	  DO_NUMBER (3, 1 + tp->tm_yday);
+
+	case L_('M'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+
+	  DO_NUMBER (2, tp->tm_min);
+
+	case L_('m'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+
+	  DO_NUMBER (2, tp->tm_mon + 1);
+
+	case L_('n'):
+	  add (1, *p = L_('\n'));
+	  break;
+
+	case L_('P'):
+	  to_lowcase = 1;
+#if !defined _NL_CURRENT && HAVE_STRFTIME
+	  format_char = L_('p');
+#endif
+	  /* FALLTHROUGH */
+
+	case L_('p'):
+	  if (change_case)
+	    {
+	      to_uppcase = 0;
+	      to_lowcase = 1;
+	    }
+#if defined _NL_CURRENT || !HAVE_STRFTIME
+	  cpy (ap_len, ampm);
+	  break;
+#else
+	  goto underlying_strftime;
+#endif
+
+	case L_('R'):
+	  subfmt = L_("%H:%M");
+	  goto subformat;
+
+	case L_('r'):
+#if !defined _NL_CURRENT && HAVE_STRFTIME
+	  goto underlying_strftime;
+#else
+# ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+	  if (*(subfmt = (const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME,
+						       NLW(T_FMT_AMPM)))
+	      == L_('\0'))
+# endif
+	    subfmt = L_("%I:%M:%S %p");
+	  goto subformat;
+#endif
+
+	case L_('S'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+
+	  DO_NUMBER (2, tp->tm_sec);
+
+	case L_('s'):		/* GNU extension.  */
+  	  {
+	    struct tm ltm;
+	    time_t t;
+
+	    ltm = *tp;
+	    t = mktime (&ltm);
+
+	    /* Generate string value for T using time_t arithmetic;
+	       this works even if sizeof (long) < sizeof (time_t).  */
+
+	    bufp = buf + sizeof (buf) / sizeof (buf[0]);
+	    negative_number = t < 0;
+
+	    do
+	      {
+		int d = t % 10;
+		t /= 10;
+
+		if (negative_number)
+		  {
+		    d = -d;
+
+		    /* Adjust if division truncates to minus infinity.  */
+		    if (0 < -1 % 10 && d < 0)
+		      {
+			t++;
+			d += 10;
+		      }
+		  }
+
+		*--bufp = d + L_('0');
+	      }
+	    while (t != 0);
+
+	    digits = 1;
+	    goto do_number_sign_and_padding;
+	  }
+
+	case L_('X'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('O'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+	  if (! (modifier == L_('E')
+		 && (*(subfmt =
+		       (const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(ERA_T_FMT)))
+		     != L_('\0'))))
+	    subfmt = (const CHAR_T *) _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, NLW(T_FMT));
+	  goto subformat;
+#else
+# if HAVE_STRFTIME
+	  goto underlying_strftime;
+# else
+	  /* Fall through.  */
+# endif
+#endif
+	case L_('T'):
+	  subfmt = L_("%H:%M:%S");
+	  goto subformat;
+
+	case L_('t'):
+	  add (1, *p = L_('\t'));
+	  break;
+
+	case L_('u'):
+	  DO_NUMBER (1, (tp->tm_wday - 1 + 7) % 7 + 1);
+
+	case L_('U'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+
+	  DO_NUMBER (2, (tp->tm_yday - tp->tm_wday + 7) / 7);
+
+	case L_('V'):
+	case L_('g'):
+	case L_('G'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+	  {
+	    int year = tp->tm_year + TM_YEAR_BASE;
+	    int days = iso_week_days (tp->tm_yday, tp->tm_wday);
+
+	    if (days < 0)
+	      {
+		/* This ISO week belongs to the previous year.  */
+		year--;
+		days = iso_week_days (tp->tm_yday + (365 + __isleap (year)),
+				      tp->tm_wday);
+	      }
+	    else
+	      {
+		int d = iso_week_days (tp->tm_yday - (365 + __isleap (year)),
+				       tp->tm_wday);
+		if (0 <= d)
+		  {
+		    /* This ISO week belongs to the next year.  */
+		    year++;
+		    days = d;
+		  }
+	      }
+
+	    switch (*f)
+	      {
+	      case L_('g'):
+		DO_NUMBER (2, (year % 100 + 100) % 100);
+
+	      case L_('G'):
+		DO_NUMBER (1, year);
+
+	      default:
+		DO_NUMBER (2, days / 7 + 1);
+	      }
+	  }
+
+	case L_('W'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+
+	  DO_NUMBER (2, (tp->tm_yday - (tp->tm_wday - 1 + 7) % 7 + 7) / 7);
+
+	case L_('w'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+
+	  DO_NUMBER (1, tp->tm_wday);
+
+	case L_('Y'):
+	  if (modifier == 'E')
+	    {
+#if HAVE_STRUCT_ERA_ENTRY
+	      struct era_entry *era = _nl_get_era_entry (tp HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
+	      if (era)
+		{
+# ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
+		  subfmt = era->era_wformat;
+# else
+		  subfmt = era->era_format;
+# endif
+		  goto subformat;
+		}
+#else
+# if HAVE_STRFTIME
+	      goto underlying_strftime;
+# endif
+#endif
+	    }
+	  if (modifier == L_('O'))
+	    goto bad_format;
+	  else
+	    DO_NUMBER (1, tp->tm_year + TM_YEAR_BASE);
+
+	case L_('y'):
+	  if (modifier == L_('E'))
+	    {
+#if HAVE_STRUCT_ERA_ENTRY
+	      struct era_entry *era = _nl_get_era_entry (tp HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
+	      if (era)
+		{
+		  int delta = tp->tm_year - era->start_date[0];
+		  DO_NUMBER (1, (era->offset
+				 + delta * era->absolute_direction));
+		}
+#else
+# if HAVE_STRFTIME
+	      goto underlying_strftime;
+# endif
+#endif
+	    }
+	  DO_NUMBER (2, (tp->tm_year % 100 + 100) % 100);
+
+	case L_('Z'):
+	  if (change_case)
+	    {
+	      to_uppcase = 0;
+	      to_lowcase = 1;
+	    }
+
+#if HAVE_TZNAME
+	  /* The tzset() call might have changed the value.  */
+	  if (!(zone && *zone) && tp->tm_isdst >= 0)
+	    zone = tzname[tp->tm_isdst];
+#endif
+	  if (! zone)
+	    zone = "";
+
+#ifdef COMPILE_WIDE
+	  {
+	    /* The zone string is always given in multibyte form.  We have
+	       to transform it first.  */
+	    wchar_t *wczone;
+	    size_t len;
+	    widen (zone, wczone, len);
+	    cpy (len, wczone);
+	  }
+#else
+	  cpy (strlen (zone), zone);
+#endif
+	  break;
+
+	case L_('z'):
+	  if (tp->tm_isdst < 0)
+	    break;
+
+	  {
+	    int diff;
+#if HAVE_TM_GMTOFF
+	    diff = tp->tm_gmtoff;
+#else
+	    if (ut)
+	      diff = 0;
+	    else
+	      {
+		struct tm gtm;
+		struct tm ltm;
+		time_t lt;
+
+		ltm = *tp;
+		lt = mktime (&ltm);
+
+		if (lt == (time_t) -1)
+		  {
+		    /* mktime returns -1 for errors, but -1 is also a
+		       valid time_t value.  Check whether an error really
+		       occurred.  */
+		    struct tm tm;
+
+		    if (! __localtime_r (&lt, &tm)
+			|| ((ltm.tm_sec ^ tm.tm_sec)
+			    | (ltm.tm_min ^ tm.tm_min)
+			    | (ltm.tm_hour ^ tm.tm_hour)
+			    | (ltm.tm_mday ^ tm.tm_mday)
+			    | (ltm.tm_mon ^ tm.tm_mon)
+			    | (ltm.tm_year ^ tm.tm_year)))
+		      break;
+		  }
+
+		if (! __gmtime_r (&lt, &gtm))
+		  break;
+
+		diff = tm_diff (&ltm, &gtm);
+	      }
+#endif
+
+	    if (diff < 0)
+	      {
+		add (1, *p = L_('-'));
+		diff = -diff;
+	      }
+	    else
+	      add (1, *p = L_('+'));
+
+	    diff /= 60;
+	    DO_NUMBER (4, (diff / 60) * 100 + diff % 60);
+	  }
+
+	case L_('\0'):		/* GNU extension: % at end of format.  */
+	    --f;
+	    /* Fall through.  */
+	default:
+	  /* Unknown format; output the format, including the '%',
+	     since this is most likely the right thing to do if a
+	     multibyte string has been misparsed.  */
+	bad_format:
+	  {
+	    int flen;
+	    for (flen = 1; f[1 - flen] != L_('%'); flen++)
+	      continue;
+	    cpy (flen, &f[1 - flen]);
+	  }
+	  break;
+	}
+    }
+
+  if (p && maxsize != 0)
+    *p = L_('\0');
+  return i;
+}
+#ifdef _LIBC
+libc_hidden_def (my_strftime)
+#endif
+
+
+#ifdef emacs
+/* For Emacs we have a separate interface which corresponds to the normal
+   strftime function and does not have the extra information whether the
+   TP arguments comes from a `gmtime' call or not.  */
+size_t
+emacs_strftime (s, maxsize, format, tp)
+      char *s;
+      size_t maxsize;
+      const char *format;
+      const struct tm *tp;
+{
+  return my_strftime (s, maxsize, format, tp, 0);
+}
+#endif
+
+#if defined _LIBC && !defined COMPILE_WIDE
 weak_alias (__strftime_l, strftime_l)
+#endif
diff --git a/time/strptime.c b/time/strptime.c
index 1edd4ac257..fc3526912d 100644
--- a/time/strptime.c
+++ b/time/strptime.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert a string representation of time to a time value.
-   Copyright (C) 1996-2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1996-2000, 2001, 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1996.
 
@@ -23,1072 +23,18 @@
    some of them in the same format (such as year, week and weekday)
    this is enough information for determining the date.  */
 
-#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
-# include <config.h>
-#endif
-
-#include <ctype.h>
-#include <langinfo.h>
-#include <limits.h>
-#include <string.h>
 #include <time.h>
-
-#ifdef _LIBC
-# include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
-#endif
-
-
-#ifndef __P
-# if defined __GNUC__ || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
-#  define __P(args) args
-# else
-#  define __P(args) ()
-# endif  /* GCC.  */
-#endif  /* Not __P.  */
-
-
-#if ! HAVE_LOCALTIME_R && ! defined localtime_r
-# ifdef _LIBC
-#  define localtime_r __localtime_r
-# else
-/* Approximate localtime_r as best we can in its absence.  */
-#  define localtime_r my_localtime_r
-static struct tm *localtime_r __P ((const time_t *, struct tm *));
-static struct tm *
-localtime_r (t, tp)
-     const time_t *t;
-     struct tm *tp;
-{
-  struct tm *l = localtime (t);
-  if (! l)
-    return 0;
-  *tp = *l;
-  return tp;
-}
-# endif /* ! _LIBC */
-#endif /* ! HAVE_LOCALTIME_R && ! defined (localtime_r) */
-
-
-#define match_char(ch1, ch2) if (ch1 != ch2) return NULL
-#if defined __GNUC__ && __GNUC__ >= 2
-# ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#  define match_string(cs1, s2) \
-  ({ size_t len = strlen (cs1);						      \
-     int result = __strncasecmp_l ((cs1), (s2), len, locale) == 0;	      \
-     if (result) (s2) += len;						      \
-     result; })
-# else
-#  define match_string(cs1, s2) \
-  ({ size_t len = strlen (cs1);						      \
-     int result = strncasecmp ((cs1), (s2), len) == 0;			      \
-     if (result) (s2) += len;						      \
-     result; })
-# endif
-#else
-/* Oh come on.  Get a reasonable compiler.  */
-# define match_string(cs1, s2) \
-  (strncasecmp ((cs1), (s2), strlen (cs1)) ? 0 : ((s2) += strlen (cs1), 1))
-#endif
-/* We intentionally do not use isdigit() for testing because this will
-   lead to problems with the wide character version.  */
-#define get_number(from, to, n) \
-  do {									      \
-    int __n = n;							      \
-    val = 0;								      \
-    while (*rp == ' ')							      \
-      ++rp;								      \
-    if (*rp < '0' || *rp > '9')						      \
-      return NULL;							      \
-    do {								      \
-      val *= 10;							      \
-      val += *rp++ - '0';						      \
-    } while (--__n > 0 && val * 10 <= to && *rp >= '0' && *rp <= '9');	      \
-    if (val < from || val > to)						      \
-      return NULL;							      \
-  } while (0)
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-# define get_alt_number(from, to, n) \
-  ({									      \
-     __label__ do_normal;						      \
-									      \
-     if (*decided != raw)						      \
-       {								      \
-	 val = _nl_parse_alt_digit (&rp HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);		      \
-	 if (val == -1 && *decided != loc)				      \
-	   {								      \
-	     *decided = loc;						      \
-	     goto do_normal;						      \
-	   }								      \
-	if (val < from || val > to)					      \
-	  return NULL;							      \
-       }								      \
-     else								      \
-       {								      \
-       do_normal:							      \
-	 get_number (from, to, n);					      \
-       }								      \
-    0;									      \
-  })
-#else
-# define get_alt_number(from, to, n) \
-  /* We don't have the alternate representation.  */			      \
-  get_number(from, to, n)
-#endif
-#define recursive(new_fmt) \
-  (*(new_fmt) != '\0'							      \
-   && (rp = strptime_internal (rp, (new_fmt), tm,			      \
-			       decided, era_cnt LOCALE_ARG)) != NULL)
-
-
-#ifdef _LIBC
-/* This is defined in locale/C-time.c in the GNU libc.  */
-extern const struct locale_data _nl_C_LC_TIME attribute_hidden;
-
-# define weekday_name (&_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (DAY_1)].string)
-# define ab_weekday_name \
-  (&_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (ABDAY_1)].string)
-# define month_name (&_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (MON_1)].string)
-# define ab_month_name (&_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (ABMON_1)].string)
-# define HERE_D_T_FMT (_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (D_T_FMT)].string)
-# define HERE_D_FMT (_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (D_FMT)].string)
-# define HERE_AM_STR (_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (AM_STR)].string)
-# define HERE_PM_STR (_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (PM_STR)].string)
-# define HERE_T_FMT_AMPM \
-  (_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (T_FMT_AMPM)].string)
-# define HERE_T_FMT (_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (T_FMT)].string)
-
-# define strncasecmp(s1, s2, n) __strncasecmp (s1, s2, n)
-#else
-static char const weekday_name[][10] =
-  {
-    "Sunday", "Monday", "Tuesday", "Wednesday",
-    "Thursday", "Friday", "Saturday"
-  };
-static char const ab_weekday_name[][4] =
-  {
-    "Sun", "Mon", "Tue", "Wed", "Thu", "Fri", "Sat"
-  };
-static char const month_name[][10] =
-  {
-    "January", "February", "March", "April", "May", "June",
-    "July", "August", "September", "October", "November", "December"
-  };
-static char const ab_month_name[][4] =
-  {
-    "Jan", "Feb", "Mar", "Apr", "May", "Jun",
-    "Jul", "Aug", "Sep", "Oct", "Nov", "Dec"
-  };
-# define HERE_D_T_FMT "%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Y"
-# define HERE_D_FMT "%m/%d/%y"
-# define HERE_AM_STR "AM"
-# define HERE_PM_STR "PM"
-# define HERE_T_FMT_AMPM "%I:%M:%S %p"
-# define HERE_T_FMT "%H:%M:%S"
-
-static const unsigned short int __mon_yday[2][13] =
-  {
-    /* Normal years.  */
-    { 0, 31, 59, 90, 120, 151, 181, 212, 243, 273, 304, 334, 365 },
-    /* Leap years.  */
-    { 0, 31, 60, 91, 121, 152, 182, 213, 244, 274, 305, 335, 366 }
-  };
-#endif
-
-#if defined _LIBC && defined USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-/* We use this code also for the extended locale handling where the
-   function gets as an additional argument the locale which has to be
-   used.  To access the values we have to redefine the _NL_CURRENT
-   macro.  */
-# define strptime		__strptime_l
-# undef _NL_CURRENT
-# define _NL_CURRENT(category, item) \
-  (current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (item)].string)
-# undef _NL_CURRENT_WORD
-# define _NL_CURRENT_WORD(category, item) \
-  (current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (item)].word)
-# define LOCALE_PARAM , locale
-# define LOCALE_ARG , locale
-# define LOCALE_PARAM_PROTO , __locale_t locale
-# define LOCALE_PARAM_DECL __locale_t locale;
-# define HELPER_LOCALE_ARG , current
-# define ISSPACE(Ch) __isspace_l (Ch, locale)
-#else
-# define LOCALE_PARAM
-# define LOCALE_ARG
-# define LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
-# define LOCALE_PARAM_PROTO
-# ifdef _LIBC
-#  define HELPER_LOCALE_ARG , _NL_CURRENT_DATA (LC_TIME)
-# else
-#  define HELPER_LOCALE_ARG
-# endif
-# define ISSPACE(Ch) isspace (Ch)
-#endif
-
-
-/* Status of lookup: do we use the locale data or the raw data?  */
-enum locale_status { not, loc, raw };
-
-
-#ifndef __isleap
-/* Nonzero if YEAR is a leap year (every 4 years,
-   except every 100th isn't, and every 400th is).  */
-# define __isleap(year)	\
-  ((year) % 4 == 0 && ((year) % 100 != 0 || (year) % 400 == 0))
-#endif
-
-/* Compute the day of the week.  */
-static void
-day_of_the_week (struct tm *tm)
-{
-  /* We know that January 1st 1970 was a Thursday (= 4).  Compute the
-     the difference between this data in the one on TM and so determine
-     the weekday.  */
-  int corr_year = 1900 + tm->tm_year - (tm->tm_mon < 2);
-  int wday = (-473
-	      + (365 * (tm->tm_year - 70))
-	      + (corr_year / 4)
-	      - ((corr_year / 4) / 25) + ((corr_year / 4) % 25 < 0)
-	      + (((corr_year / 4) / 25) / 4)
-	      + __mon_yday[0][tm->tm_mon]
-	      + tm->tm_mday - 1);
-  tm->tm_wday = ((wday % 7) + 7) % 7;
-}
-
-/* Compute the day of the year.  */
-static void
-day_of_the_year (struct tm *tm)
-{
-  tm->tm_yday = (__mon_yday[__isleap (1900 + tm->tm_year)][tm->tm_mon]
-		 + (tm->tm_mday - 1));
-}
-
-
-static char *
-#ifdef _LIBC
-internal_function
-#endif
-strptime_internal __P ((const char *rp, const char *fmt, struct tm *tm,
-			enum locale_status *decided, int era_cnt
-			LOCALE_PARAM_PROTO));
-
-static char *
-#ifdef _LIBC
-internal_function
-#endif
-strptime_internal (rp, fmt, tm, decided, era_cnt LOCALE_PARAM)
-     const char *rp;
-     const char *fmt;
-     struct tm *tm;
-     enum locale_status *decided;
-     int era_cnt;
-     LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
-{
-#if defined _LIBC && defined USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-  struct locale_data *const current = locale->__locales[LC_TIME];
-#endif
-
-  const char *rp_backup;
-  int cnt;
-  size_t val;
-  int have_I, is_pm;
-  int century, want_century;
-  int want_era;
-  int have_wday, want_xday;
-  int have_yday;
-  int have_mon, have_mday;
-  int have_uweek, have_wweek;
-  int week_no;
-  size_t num_eras;
-  struct era_entry *era;
-
-  have_I = is_pm = 0;
-  century = -1;
-  want_century = 0;
-  want_era = 0;
-  era = NULL;
-  week_no = 0;
-
-  have_wday = want_xday = have_yday = have_mon = have_mday = have_uweek = 0;
-  have_wweek = 0;
-
-  while (*fmt != '\0')
-    {
-      /* A white space in the format string matches 0 more or white
-	 space in the input string.  */
-      if (ISSPACE (*fmt))
-	{
-	  while (ISSPACE (*rp))
-	    ++rp;
-	  ++fmt;
-	  continue;
-	}
-
-      /* Any character but `%' must be matched by the same character
-	 in the iput string.  */
-      if (*fmt != '%')
-	{
-	  match_char (*fmt++, *rp++);
-	  continue;
-	}
-
-      ++fmt;
-#ifndef _NL_CURRENT
-      /* We need this for handling the `E' modifier.  */
-    start_over:
-#endif
-
-      /* Make back up of current processing pointer.  */
-      rp_backup = rp;
-
-      switch (*fmt++)
-	{
-	case '%':
-	  /* Match the `%' character itself.  */
-	  match_char ('%', *rp++);
-	  break;
-	case 'a':
-	case 'A':
-	  /* Match day of week.  */
-	  for (cnt = 0; cnt < 7; ++cnt)
-	    {
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-	      if (*decided !=raw)
-		{
-		  if (match_string (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, DAY_1 + cnt), rp))
-		    {
-		      if (*decided == not
-			  && strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, DAY_1 + cnt),
-				     weekday_name[cnt]))
-			*decided = loc;
-		      break;
-		    }
-		  if (match_string (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, ABDAY_1 + cnt), rp))
-		    {
-		      if (*decided == not
-			  && strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, ABDAY_1 + cnt),
-				     ab_weekday_name[cnt]))
-			*decided = loc;
-		      break;
-		    }
-		}
-#endif
-	      if (*decided != loc
-		  && (match_string (weekday_name[cnt], rp)
-		      || match_string (ab_weekday_name[cnt], rp)))
-		{
-		  *decided = raw;
-		  break;
-		}
-	    }
-	  if (cnt == 7)
-	    /* Does not match a weekday name.  */
-	    return NULL;
-	  tm->tm_wday = cnt;
-	  have_wday = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'b':
-	case 'B':
-	case 'h':
-	  /* Match month name.  */
-	  for (cnt = 0; cnt < 12; ++cnt)
-	    {
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-	      if (*decided !=raw)
-		{
-		  if (match_string (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, MON_1 + cnt), rp))
-		    {
-		      if (*decided == not
-			  && strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, MON_1 + cnt),
-				     month_name[cnt]))
-			*decided = loc;
-		      break;
-		    }
-		  if (match_string (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, ABMON_1 + cnt), rp))
-		    {
-		      if (*decided == not
-			  && strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, ABMON_1 + cnt),
-				     ab_month_name[cnt]))
-			*decided = loc;
-		      break;
-		    }
-		}
-#endif
-	      if (match_string (month_name[cnt], rp)
-		  || match_string (ab_month_name[cnt], rp))
-		{
-		  *decided = raw;
-		  break;
-		}
-	    }
-	  if (cnt == 12)
-	    /* Does not match a month name.  */
-	    return NULL;
-	  tm->tm_mon = cnt;
-	  want_xday = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'c':
-	  /* Match locale's date and time format.  */
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-	  if (*decided != raw)
-	    {
-	      if (!recursive (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, D_T_FMT)))
-		{
-		  if (*decided == loc)
-		    return NULL;
-		  else
-		    rp = rp_backup;
-		}
-	      else
-		{
-		  if (*decided == not &&
-		      strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, D_T_FMT), HERE_D_T_FMT))
-		    *decided = loc;
-		  want_xday = 1;
-		  break;
-		}
-	      *decided = raw;
-	    }
-#endif
-	  if (!recursive (HERE_D_T_FMT))
-	    return NULL;
-	  want_xday = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'C':
-	  /* Match century number.  */
-	match_century:
-	  get_number (0, 99, 2);
-	  century = val;
-	  want_xday = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'd':
-	case 'e':
-	  /* Match day of month.  */
-	  get_number (1, 31, 2);
-	  tm->tm_mday = val;
-	  have_mday = 1;
-	  want_xday = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'F':
-	  if (!recursive ("%Y-%m-%d"))
-	    return NULL;
-	  want_xday = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'x':
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-	  if (*decided != raw)
-	    {
-	      if (!recursive (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, D_FMT)))
-		{
-		  if (*decided == loc)
-		    return NULL;
-		  else
-		    rp = rp_backup;
-		}
-	      else
-		{
-		  if (*decided == not
-		      && strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, D_FMT), HERE_D_FMT))
-		    *decided = loc;
-		  want_xday = 1;
-		  break;
-		}
-	      *decided = raw;
-	    }
-#endif
-	  /* Fall through.  */
-	case 'D':
-	  /* Match standard day format.  */
-	  if (!recursive (HERE_D_FMT))
-	    return NULL;
-	  want_xday = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'k':
-	case 'H':
-	  /* Match hour in 24-hour clock.  */
-	  get_number (0, 23, 2);
-	  tm->tm_hour = val;
-	  have_I = 0;
-	  break;
-	case 'l':
-	  /* Match hour in 12-hour clock.  GNU extension.  */
-	case 'I':
-	  /* Match hour in 12-hour clock.  */
-	  get_number (1, 12, 2);
-	  tm->tm_hour = val % 12;
-	  have_I = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'j':
-	  /* Match day number of year.  */
-	  get_number (1, 366, 3);
-	  tm->tm_yday = val - 1;
-	  have_yday = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'm':
-	  /* Match number of month.  */
-	  get_number (1, 12, 2);
-	  tm->tm_mon = val - 1;
-	  have_mon = 1;
-	  want_xday = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'M':
-	  /* Match minute.  */
-	  get_number (0, 59, 2);
-	  tm->tm_min = val;
-	  break;
-	case 'n':
-	case 't':
-	  /* Match any white space.  */
-	  while (ISSPACE (*rp))
-	    ++rp;
-	  break;
-	case 'p':
-	  /* Match locale's equivalent of AM/PM.  */
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-	  if (*decided != raw)
-	    {
-	      if (match_string (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, AM_STR), rp))
-		{
-		  if (strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, AM_STR), HERE_AM_STR))
-		    *decided = loc;
-		  break;
-		}
-	      if (match_string (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, PM_STR), rp))
-		{
-		  if (strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, PM_STR), HERE_PM_STR))
-		    *decided = loc;
-		  is_pm = 1;
-		  break;
-		}
-	      *decided = raw;
-	    }
-#endif
-	  if (!match_string (HERE_AM_STR, rp))
-	    if (match_string (HERE_PM_STR, rp))
-	      is_pm = 1;
-	    else
-	      return NULL;
-	  break;
-	case 'r':
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-	  if (*decided != raw)
-	    {
-	      if (!recursive (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, T_FMT_AMPM)))
-		{
-		  if (*decided == loc)
-		    return NULL;
-		  else
-		    rp = rp_backup;
-		}
-	      else
-		{
-		  if (*decided == not &&
-		      strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, T_FMT_AMPM),
-			      HERE_T_FMT_AMPM))
-		    *decided = loc;
-		  break;
-		}
-	      *decided = raw;
-	    }
-#endif
-	  if (!recursive (HERE_T_FMT_AMPM))
-	    return NULL;
-	  break;
-	case 'R':
-	  if (!recursive ("%H:%M"))
-	    return NULL;
-	  break;
-	case 's':
-	  {
-	    /* The number of seconds may be very high so we cannot use
-	       the `get_number' macro.  Instead read the number
-	       character for character and construct the result while
-	       doing this.  */
-	    time_t secs = 0;
-	    if (*rp < '0' || *rp > '9')
-	      /* We need at least one digit.  */
-	      return NULL;
-
-	    do
-	      {
-		secs *= 10;
-		secs += *rp++ - '0';
-	      }
-	    while (*rp >= '0' && *rp <= '9');
-
-	    if (localtime_r (&secs, tm) == NULL)
-	      /* Error in function.  */
-	      return NULL;
-	  }
-	  break;
-	case 'S':
-	  get_number (0, 61, 2);
-	  tm->tm_sec = val;
-	  break;
-	case 'X':
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-	  if (*decided != raw)
-	    {
-	      if (!recursive (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, T_FMT)))
-		{
-		  if (*decided == loc)
-		    return NULL;
-		  else
-		    rp = rp_backup;
-		}
-	      else
-		{
-		  if (strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, T_FMT), HERE_T_FMT))
-		    *decided = loc;
-		  break;
-		}
-	      *decided = raw;
-	    }
-#endif
-	  /* Fall through.  */
-	case 'T':
-	  if (!recursive (HERE_T_FMT))
-	    return NULL;
-	  break;
-	case 'u':
-	  get_number (1, 7, 1);
-	  tm->tm_wday = val % 7;
-	  have_wday = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'g':
-	  get_number (0, 99, 2);
-	  /* XXX This cannot determine any field in TM.  */
-	  break;
-	case 'G':
-	  if (*rp < '0' || *rp > '9')
-	    return NULL;
-	  /* XXX Ignore the number since we would need some more
-	     information to compute a real date.  */
-	  do
-	    ++rp;
-	  while (*rp >= '0' && *rp <= '9');
-	  break;
-	case 'U':
-	  get_number (0, 53, 2);
-	  week_no = val;
-	  have_uweek = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'W':
-	  get_number (0, 53, 2);
-	  week_no = val;
-	  have_wweek = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'V':
-	  get_number (0, 53, 2);
-	  /* XXX This cannot determine any field in TM without some
-	     information.  */
-	  break;
-	case 'w':
-	  /* Match number of weekday.  */
-	  get_number (0, 6, 1);
-	  tm->tm_wday = val;
-	  have_wday = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'y':
-	match_year_in_century:
-	  /* Match year within century.  */
-	  get_number (0, 99, 2);
-	  /* The "Year 2000: The Millennium Rollover" paper suggests that
-	     values in the range 69-99 refer to the twentieth century.  */
-	  tm->tm_year = val >= 69 ? val : val + 100;
-	  /* Indicate that we want to use the century, if specified.  */
-	  want_century = 1;
-	  want_xday = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'Y':
-	  /* Match year including century number.  */
-	  get_number (0, 9999, 4);
-	  tm->tm_year = val - 1900;
-	  want_century = 0;
-	  want_xday = 1;
-	  break;
-	case 'Z':
-	  /* XXX How to handle this?  */
-	  break;
-	case 'E':
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-	  switch (*fmt++)
-	    {
-	    case 'c':
-	      /* Match locale's alternate date and time format.  */
-	      if (*decided != raw)
-		{
-		  const char *fmt = _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, ERA_D_T_FMT);
-
-		  if (*fmt == '\0')
-		    fmt = _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, D_T_FMT);
-
-		  if (!recursive (fmt))
-		    {
-		      if (*decided == loc)
-			return NULL;
-		      else
-			rp = rp_backup;
-		    }
-		  else
-		    {
-		      if (strcmp (fmt, HERE_D_T_FMT))
-			*decided = loc;
-		      want_xday = 1;
-		      break;
-		    }
-		  *decided = raw;
-		}
-	      /* The C locale has no era information, so use the
-		 normal representation.  */
-	      if (!recursive (HERE_D_T_FMT))
-		return NULL;
-	      want_xday = 1;
-	      break;
-	    case 'C':
-	      if (*decided != raw)
-		{
-		  if (era_cnt >= 0)
-		    {
-		      era = _nl_select_era_entry (era_cnt HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
-		      if (era != NULL && match_string (era->era_name, rp))
-			{
-			  *decided = loc;
-			  break;
-			}
-		      else
-			return NULL;
-		    }
-		  else
-		    {
-		      num_eras = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_TIME,
-						   _NL_TIME_ERA_NUM_ENTRIES);
-		      for (era_cnt = 0; era_cnt < (int) num_eras;
-			   ++era_cnt, rp = rp_backup)
-			{
-			  era = _nl_select_era_entry (era_cnt
-						      HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
-			  if (era != NULL && match_string (era->era_name, rp))
-			    {
-			      *decided = loc;
-			      break;
-			    }
-			}
-		      if (era_cnt == (int) num_eras)
-			{
-			  era_cnt = -1;
-			  if (*decided == loc)
-			    return NULL;
-			}
-		      else
-			break;
-		    }
-
-		  *decided = raw;
-		}
-	      /* The C locale has no era information, so use the
-		 normal representation.  */
-	      goto match_century;
- 	    case 'y':
-	      if (*decided == raw)
-		goto match_year_in_century;
-
-	      get_number(0, 9999, 4);
-	      tm->tm_year = val;
-	      want_era = 1;
-	      want_xday = 1;
-	      want_century = 1;
-	      break;
-	    case 'Y':
-	      if (*decided != raw)
-		{
-		  num_eras = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_TIME,
-					       _NL_TIME_ERA_NUM_ENTRIES);
-		  for (era_cnt = 0; era_cnt < (int) num_eras;
-		       ++era_cnt, rp = rp_backup)
-		    {
-		      era = _nl_select_era_entry (era_cnt HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
-		      if (era != NULL && recursive (era->era_format))
-			break;
-		    }
-		  if (era_cnt == (int) num_eras)
-		    {
-		      era_cnt = -1;
-		      if (*decided == loc)
-			return NULL;
-		      else
-			rp = rp_backup;
-		    }
-		  else
-		    {
-		      *decided = loc;
-		      era_cnt = -1;
-		      break;
-		    }
-
-		  *decided = raw;
-		}
-	      get_number (0, 9999, 4);
-	      tm->tm_year = val - 1900;
-	      want_century = 0;
-	      want_xday = 1;
-	      break;
-	    case 'x':
-	      if (*decided != raw)
-		{
-		  const char *fmt = _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, ERA_D_FMT);
-
-		  if (*fmt == '\0')
-		    fmt = _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, D_FMT);
-
-		  if (!recursive (fmt))
-		    {
-		      if (*decided == loc)
-			return NULL;
-		      else
-			rp = rp_backup;
-		    }
-		  else
-		    {
-		      if (strcmp (fmt, HERE_D_FMT))
-			*decided = loc;
-		      break;
-		    }
-		  *decided = raw;
-		}
-	      if (!recursive (HERE_D_FMT))
-		return NULL;
-	      break;
-	    case 'X':
-	      if (*decided != raw)
-		{
-		  const char *fmt = _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, ERA_T_FMT);
-
-		  if (*fmt == '\0')
-		    fmt = _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, T_FMT);
-
-		  if (!recursive (fmt))
-		    {
-		      if (*decided == loc)
-			return NULL;
-		      else
-			rp = rp_backup;
-		    }
-		  else
-		    {
-		      if (strcmp (fmt, HERE_T_FMT))
-			*decided = loc;
-		      break;
-		    }
-		  *decided = raw;
-		}
-	      if (!recursive (HERE_T_FMT))
-		return NULL;
-	      break;
-	    default:
-	      return NULL;
-	    }
-	  break;
-#else
-	  /* We have no information about the era format.  Just use
-	     the normal format.  */
-	  if (*fmt != 'c' && *fmt != 'C' && *fmt != 'y' && *fmt != 'Y'
-	      && *fmt != 'x' && *fmt != 'X')
-	    /* This is an illegal format.  */
-	    return NULL;
-
-	  goto start_over;
-#endif
-	case 'O':
-	  switch (*fmt++)
-	    {
-	    case 'd':
-	    case 'e':
-	      /* Match day of month using alternate numeric symbols.  */
-	      get_alt_number (1, 31, 2);
-	      tm->tm_mday = val;
-	      have_mday = 1;
-	      want_xday = 1;
-	      break;
-	    case 'H':
-	      /* Match hour in 24-hour clock using alternate numeric
-		 symbols.  */
-	      get_alt_number (0, 23, 2);
-	      tm->tm_hour = val;
-	      have_I = 0;
-	      break;
-	    case 'I':
-	      /* Match hour in 12-hour clock using alternate numeric
-		 symbols.  */
-	      get_alt_number (1, 12, 2);
-	      tm->tm_hour = val % 12;
-	      have_I = 1;
-	      break;
-	    case 'm':
-	      /* Match month using alternate numeric symbols.  */
-	      get_alt_number (1, 12, 2);
-	      tm->tm_mon = val - 1;
-	      have_mon = 1;
-	      want_xday = 1;
-	      break;
-	    case 'M':
-	      /* Match minutes using alternate numeric symbols.  */
-	      get_alt_number (0, 59, 2);
-	      tm->tm_min = val;
-	      break;
-	    case 'S':
-	      /* Match seconds using alternate numeric symbols.  */
-	      get_alt_number (0, 61, 2);
-	      tm->tm_sec = val;
-	      break;
-	    case 'U':
-	      get_alt_number (0, 53, 2);
-	      week_no = val;
-	      have_uweek = 1;
-	      break;
-	    case 'W':
-	      get_alt_number (0, 53, 2);
-	      week_no = val;
-	      have_wweek = 1;
-	      break;
-	    case 'V':
-	      get_alt_number (0, 53, 2);
-	      /* XXX This cannot determine any field in TM without
-		 further information.  */
-	      break;
-	    case 'w':
-	      /* Match number of weekday using alternate numeric symbols.  */
-	      get_alt_number (0, 6, 1);
-	      tm->tm_wday = val;
-	      have_wday = 1;
-	      break;
-	    case 'y':
-	      /* Match year within century using alternate numeric symbols.  */
-	      get_alt_number (0, 99, 2);
-	      tm->tm_year = val >= 69 ? val : val + 100;
-	      want_xday = 1;
-	      break;
-	    default:
-	      return NULL;
-	    }
-	  break;
-	default:
-	  return NULL;
-	}
-    }
-
-  if (have_I && is_pm)
-    tm->tm_hour += 12;
-
-  if (century != -1)
-    {
-      if (want_century)
-	tm->tm_year = tm->tm_year % 100 + (century - 19) * 100;
-      else
-	/* Only the century, but not the year.  Strange, but so be it.  */
-	tm->tm_year = (century - 19) * 100;
-    }
-
-  if (era_cnt != -1)
-    {
-      era = _nl_select_era_entry (era_cnt HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
-      if (era == NULL)
-	return NULL;
-      if (want_era)
-	tm->tm_year = (era->start_date[0]
-		       + ((tm->tm_year - era->offset)
-			  * era->absolute_direction));
-      else
-	/* Era start year assumed.  */
-	tm->tm_year = era->start_date[0];
-    }
-  else
-    if (want_era)
-      {
-	/* No era found but we have seen an E modifier.  Rectify some
-	   values.  */
-	if (want_century && century == -1 && tm->tm_year < 69)
-	  tm->tm_year += 100;
-      }
-
-  if (want_xday && !have_wday)
-    {
-      if ( !(have_mon && have_mday) && have_yday)
-	{
-	  /* We don't have tm_mon and/or tm_mday, compute them.  */
-	  int t_mon = 0;
-	  while (__mon_yday[__isleap(1900 + tm->tm_year)][t_mon] <= tm->tm_yday)
-	      t_mon++;
-	  if (!have_mon)
-	      tm->tm_mon = t_mon - 1;
-	  if (!have_mday)
-	      tm->tm_mday =
-		(tm->tm_yday
-		 - __mon_yday[__isleap(1900 + tm->tm_year)][t_mon - 1] + 1);
-	}
-      day_of_the_week (tm);
-    }
-
-  if (want_xday && !have_yday)
-    day_of_the_year (tm);
-
-  if ((have_uweek || have_wweek) && have_wday)
-    {
-      int save_wday = tm->tm_wday;
-      int save_mday = tm->tm_mday;
-      int save_mon = tm->tm_mon;
-      int w_offset = have_uweek ? 0 : 1;
-
-      tm->tm_mday = 1;
-      tm->tm_mon = 0;
-      day_of_the_week (tm);
-      if (have_mday)
-	tm->tm_mday = save_mday;
-      if (have_mon)
-	tm->tm_mon = save_mon;
-
-      if (!have_yday)
-	tm->tm_yday = ((7 - (tm->tm_wday - w_offset)) % 7
-		       + (week_no - 1) *7
-		       + save_wday - w_offset);
-
-      if (!have_mday || !have_mon)
-	{
-	  int t_mon = 0;
-	  while (__mon_yday[__isleap(1900 + tm->tm_year)][t_mon]
-		 <= tm->tm_yday)
-	    t_mon++;
-	  if (!have_mon)
-	    tm->tm_mon = t_mon - 1;
-	  if (!have_mday)
-	      tm->tm_mday =
-		(tm->tm_yday
-		 - __mon_yday[__isleap(1900 + tm->tm_year)][t_mon - 1] + 1);
-	}
-
-      tm->tm_wday = save_wday;
-    }
-
-  return (char *) rp;
-}
+#include <locale/localeinfo.h>
 
 
 char *
-strptime (buf, format, tm LOCALE_PARAM)
+strptime (buf, format, tm)
      const char *buf;
      const char *format;
      struct tm *tm;
-     LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
 {
-  enum locale_status decided;
-
-#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
-  decided = not;
-#else
-  decided = raw;
-#endif
-  return strptime_internal (buf, format, tm, &decided, -1 LOCALE_ARG);
+  enum ptime_locale_status decided = not;
+  return __strptime_internal (buf, format, tm, &decided, -1,
+			      _NL_CURRENT_LOCALE);
 }
-#if defined _LIBC && !defined USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
 libc_hidden_def (strptime)
-#endif
diff --git a/time/strptime_l.c b/time/strptime_l.c
index 681386003d..b95f0982e8 100644
--- a/time/strptime_l.c
+++ b/time/strptime_l.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
 
    The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
@@ -16,7 +16,1053 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL 1
-#include <strptime.c>
+#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+# include <config.h>
+#endif
 
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <langinfo.h>
+#include <limits.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <time.h>
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+# include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
+#endif
+
+
+#ifndef __P
+# if defined __GNUC__ || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
+#  define __P(args) args
+# else
+#  define __P(args) ()
+# endif  /* GCC.  */
+#endif  /* Not __P.  */
+
+
+#if ! HAVE_LOCALTIME_R && ! defined localtime_r
+# ifdef _LIBC
+#  define localtime_r __localtime_r
+# else
+/* Approximate localtime_r as best we can in its absence.  */
+#  define localtime_r my_localtime_r
+static struct tm *localtime_r __P ((const time_t *, struct tm *));
+static struct tm *
+localtime_r (t, tp)
+     const time_t *t;
+     struct tm *tp;
+{
+  struct tm *l = localtime (t);
+  if (! l)
+    return 0;
+  *tp = *l;
+  return tp;
+}
+# endif /* ! _LIBC */
+#endif /* ! HAVE_LOCALTIME_R && ! defined (localtime_r) */
+
+
+#define match_char(ch1, ch2) if (ch1 != ch2) return NULL
+#if defined __GNUC__ && __GNUC__ >= 2
+# define match_string(cs1, s2) \
+  ({ size_t len = strlen (cs1);						      \
+     int result = __strncasecmp_l ((cs1), (s2), len, locale) == 0;	      \
+     if (result) (s2) += len;						      \
+     result; })
+#else
+/* Oh come on.  Get a reasonable compiler.  */
+# define match_string(cs1, s2) \
+  (strncasecmp ((cs1), (s2), strlen (cs1)) ? 0 : ((s2) += strlen (cs1), 1))
+#endif
+/* We intentionally do not use isdigit() for testing because this will
+   lead to problems with the wide character version.  */
+#define get_number(from, to, n) \
+  do {									      \
+    int __n = n;							      \
+    val = 0;								      \
+    while (*rp == ' ')							      \
+      ++rp;								      \
+    if (*rp < '0' || *rp > '9')						      \
+      return NULL;							      \
+    do {								      \
+      val *= 10;							      \
+      val += *rp++ - '0';						      \
+    } while (--__n > 0 && val * 10 <= to && *rp >= '0' && *rp <= '9');	      \
+    if (val < from || val > to)						      \
+      return NULL;							      \
+  } while (0)
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+# define get_alt_number(from, to, n) \
+  ({									      \
+     __label__ do_normal;						      \
+									      \
+     if (*decided != raw)						      \
+       {								      \
+	 val = _nl_parse_alt_digit (&rp HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);		      \
+	 if (val == -1 && *decided != loc)				      \
+	   {								      \
+	     *decided = loc;						      \
+	     goto do_normal;						      \
+	   }								      \
+	if (val < from || val > to)					      \
+	  return NULL;							      \
+       }								      \
+     else								      \
+       {								      \
+       do_normal:							      \
+	 get_number (from, to, n);					      \
+       }								      \
+    0;									      \
+  })
+#else
+# define get_alt_number(from, to, n) \
+  /* We don't have the alternate representation.  */			      \
+  get_number(from, to, n)
+#endif
+#define recursive(new_fmt) \
+  (*(new_fmt) != '\0'							      \
+   && (rp = __strptime_internal (rp, (new_fmt), tm,			      \
+				 decided, era_cnt LOCALE_ARG)) != NULL)
+
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+/* This is defined in locale/C-time.c in the GNU libc.  */
+extern const struct locale_data _nl_C_LC_TIME attribute_hidden;
+
+# define weekday_name (&_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (DAY_1)].string)
+# define ab_weekday_name \
+  (&_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (ABDAY_1)].string)
+# define month_name (&_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (MON_1)].string)
+# define ab_month_name (&_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (ABMON_1)].string)
+# define HERE_D_T_FMT (_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (D_T_FMT)].string)
+# define HERE_D_FMT (_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (D_FMT)].string)
+# define HERE_AM_STR (_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (AM_STR)].string)
+# define HERE_PM_STR (_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (PM_STR)].string)
+# define HERE_T_FMT_AMPM \
+  (_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (T_FMT_AMPM)].string)
+# define HERE_T_FMT (_nl_C_LC_TIME.values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (T_FMT)].string)
+
+# define strncasecmp(s1, s2, n) __strncasecmp (s1, s2, n)
+#else
+static char const weekday_name[][10] =
+  {
+    "Sunday", "Monday", "Tuesday", "Wednesday",
+    "Thursday", "Friday", "Saturday"
+  };
+static char const ab_weekday_name[][4] =
+  {
+    "Sun", "Mon", "Tue", "Wed", "Thu", "Fri", "Sat"
+  };
+static char const month_name[][10] =
+  {
+    "January", "February", "March", "April", "May", "June",
+    "July", "August", "September", "October", "November", "December"
+  };
+static char const ab_month_name[][4] =
+  {
+    "Jan", "Feb", "Mar", "Apr", "May", "Jun",
+    "Jul", "Aug", "Sep", "Oct", "Nov", "Dec"
+  };
+# define HERE_D_T_FMT "%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Y"
+# define HERE_D_FMT "%m/%d/%y"
+# define HERE_AM_STR "AM"
+# define HERE_PM_STR "PM"
+# define HERE_T_FMT_AMPM "%I:%M:%S %p"
+# define HERE_T_FMT "%H:%M:%S"
+
+static const unsigned short int __mon_yday[2][13] =
+  {
+    /* Normal years.  */
+    { 0, 31, 59, 90, 120, 151, 181, 212, 243, 273, 304, 334, 365 },
+    /* Leap years.  */
+    { 0, 31, 60, 91, 121, 152, 182, 213, 244, 274, 305, 335, 366 }
+  };
+#endif
+
+#if defined _LIBC
+/* We use this code also for the extended locale handling where the
+   function gets as an additional argument the locale which has to be
+   used.  To access the values we have to redefine the _NL_CURRENT
+   macro.  */
+# define strptime		__strptime_l
+# undef _NL_CURRENT
+# define _NL_CURRENT(category, item) \
+  (current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (item)].string)
+# undef _NL_CURRENT_WORD
+# define _NL_CURRENT_WORD(category, item) \
+  (current->values[_NL_ITEM_INDEX (item)].word)
+# define LOCALE_PARAM , locale
+# define LOCALE_ARG , locale
+# define LOCALE_PARAM_PROTO , __locale_t locale
+# define LOCALE_PARAM_DECL __locale_t locale;
+# define HELPER_LOCALE_ARG , current
+# define ISSPACE(Ch) __isspace_l (Ch, locale)
+#else
+# define LOCALE_PARAM
+# define LOCALE_ARG
+# define LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
+# define LOCALE_PARAM_PROTO
+# define HELPER_LOCALE_ARG
+# define ISSPACE(Ch) isspace (Ch)
+#endif
+
+
+
+
+#ifndef __isleap
+/* Nonzero if YEAR is a leap year (every 4 years,
+   except every 100th isn't, and every 400th is).  */
+# define __isleap(year)	\
+  ((year) % 4 == 0 && ((year) % 100 != 0 || (year) % 400 == 0))
+#endif
+
+/* Compute the day of the week.  */
+static void
+day_of_the_week (struct tm *tm)
+{
+  /* We know that January 1st 1970 was a Thursday (= 4).  Compute the
+     the difference between this data in the one on TM and so determine
+     the weekday.  */
+  int corr_year = 1900 + tm->tm_year - (tm->tm_mon < 2);
+  int wday = (-473
+	      + (365 * (tm->tm_year - 70))
+	      + (corr_year / 4)
+	      - ((corr_year / 4) / 25) + ((corr_year / 4) % 25 < 0)
+	      + (((corr_year / 4) / 25) / 4)
+	      + __mon_yday[0][tm->tm_mon]
+	      + tm->tm_mday - 1);
+  tm->tm_wday = ((wday % 7) + 7) % 7;
+}
+
+/* Compute the day of the year.  */
+static void
+day_of_the_year (struct tm *tm)
+{
+  tm->tm_yday = (__mon_yday[__isleap (1900 + tm->tm_year)][tm->tm_mon]
+		 + (tm->tm_mday - 1));
+}
+
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
+char *
+internal_function
+#else
+static char *
+#endif
+__strptime_internal (rp, fmt, tm, decided, era_cnt LOCALE_PARAM)
+     const char *rp;
+     const char *fmt;
+     struct tm *tm;
+     enum ptime_locale_status *decided;
+     int era_cnt;
+     LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
+{
+#ifdef _LIBC
+  struct locale_data *const current = locale->__locales[LC_TIME];
+#endif
+
+  const char *rp_backup;
+  int cnt;
+  size_t val;
+  int have_I, is_pm;
+  int century, want_century;
+  int want_era;
+  int have_wday, want_xday;
+  int have_yday;
+  int have_mon, have_mday;
+  int have_uweek, have_wweek;
+  int week_no;
+  size_t num_eras;
+  struct era_entry *era;
+
+  have_I = is_pm = 0;
+  century = -1;
+  want_century = 0;
+  want_era = 0;
+  era = NULL;
+  week_no = 0;
+
+  have_wday = want_xday = have_yday = have_mon = have_mday = have_uweek = 0;
+  have_wweek = 0;
+
+  while (*fmt != '\0')
+    {
+      /* A white space in the format string matches 0 more or white
+	 space in the input string.  */
+      if (ISSPACE (*fmt))
+	{
+	  while (ISSPACE (*rp))
+	    ++rp;
+	  ++fmt;
+	  continue;
+	}
+
+      /* Any character but `%' must be matched by the same character
+	 in the iput string.  */
+      if (*fmt != '%')
+	{
+	  match_char (*fmt++, *rp++);
+	  continue;
+	}
+
+      ++fmt;
+#ifndef _NL_CURRENT
+      /* We need this for handling the `E' modifier.  */
+    start_over:
+#endif
+
+      /* Make back up of current processing pointer.  */
+      rp_backup = rp;
+
+      switch (*fmt++)
+	{
+	case '%':
+	  /* Match the `%' character itself.  */
+	  match_char ('%', *rp++);
+	  break;
+	case 'a':
+	case 'A':
+	  /* Match day of week.  */
+	  for (cnt = 0; cnt < 7; ++cnt)
+	    {
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+	      if (*decided !=raw)
+		{
+		  if (match_string (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, DAY_1 + cnt), rp))
+		    {
+		      if (*decided == not
+			  && strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, DAY_1 + cnt),
+				     weekday_name[cnt]))
+			*decided = loc;
+		      break;
+		    }
+		  if (match_string (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, ABDAY_1 + cnt), rp))
+		    {
+		      if (*decided == not
+			  && strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, ABDAY_1 + cnt),
+				     ab_weekday_name[cnt]))
+			*decided = loc;
+		      break;
+		    }
+		}
+#endif
+	      if (*decided != loc
+		  && (match_string (weekday_name[cnt], rp)
+		      || match_string (ab_weekday_name[cnt], rp)))
+		{
+		  *decided = raw;
+		  break;
+		}
+	    }
+	  if (cnt == 7)
+	    /* Does not match a weekday name.  */
+	    return NULL;
+	  tm->tm_wday = cnt;
+	  have_wday = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'b':
+	case 'B':
+	case 'h':
+	  /* Match month name.  */
+	  for (cnt = 0; cnt < 12; ++cnt)
+	    {
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+	      if (*decided !=raw)
+		{
+		  if (match_string (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, MON_1 + cnt), rp))
+		    {
+		      if (*decided == not
+			  && strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, MON_1 + cnt),
+				     month_name[cnt]))
+			*decided = loc;
+		      break;
+		    }
+		  if (match_string (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, ABMON_1 + cnt), rp))
+		    {
+		      if (*decided == not
+			  && strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, ABMON_1 + cnt),
+				     ab_month_name[cnt]))
+			*decided = loc;
+		      break;
+		    }
+		}
+#endif
+	      if (match_string (month_name[cnt], rp)
+		  || match_string (ab_month_name[cnt], rp))
+		{
+		  *decided = raw;
+		  break;
+		}
+	    }
+	  if (cnt == 12)
+	    /* Does not match a month name.  */
+	    return NULL;
+	  tm->tm_mon = cnt;
+	  want_xday = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'c':
+	  /* Match locale's date and time format.  */
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+	  if (*decided != raw)
+	    {
+	      if (!recursive (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, D_T_FMT)))
+		{
+		  if (*decided == loc)
+		    return NULL;
+		  else
+		    rp = rp_backup;
+		}
+	      else
+		{
+		  if (*decided == not &&
+		      strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, D_T_FMT), HERE_D_T_FMT))
+		    *decided = loc;
+		  want_xday = 1;
+		  break;
+		}
+	      *decided = raw;
+	    }
+#endif
+	  if (!recursive (HERE_D_T_FMT))
+	    return NULL;
+	  want_xday = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'C':
+	  /* Match century number.  */
+	match_century:
+	  get_number (0, 99, 2);
+	  century = val;
+	  want_xday = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'd':
+	case 'e':
+	  /* Match day of month.  */
+	  get_number (1, 31, 2);
+	  tm->tm_mday = val;
+	  have_mday = 1;
+	  want_xday = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'F':
+	  if (!recursive ("%Y-%m-%d"))
+	    return NULL;
+	  want_xday = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'x':
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+	  if (*decided != raw)
+	    {
+	      if (!recursive (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, D_FMT)))
+		{
+		  if (*decided == loc)
+		    return NULL;
+		  else
+		    rp = rp_backup;
+		}
+	      else
+		{
+		  if (*decided == not
+		      && strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, D_FMT), HERE_D_FMT))
+		    *decided = loc;
+		  want_xday = 1;
+		  break;
+		}
+	      *decided = raw;
+	    }
+#endif
+	  /* Fall through.  */
+	case 'D':
+	  /* Match standard day format.  */
+	  if (!recursive (HERE_D_FMT))
+	    return NULL;
+	  want_xday = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'k':
+	case 'H':
+	  /* Match hour in 24-hour clock.  */
+	  get_number (0, 23, 2);
+	  tm->tm_hour = val;
+	  have_I = 0;
+	  break;
+	case 'l':
+	  /* Match hour in 12-hour clock.  GNU extension.  */
+	case 'I':
+	  /* Match hour in 12-hour clock.  */
+	  get_number (1, 12, 2);
+	  tm->tm_hour = val % 12;
+	  have_I = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'j':
+	  /* Match day number of year.  */
+	  get_number (1, 366, 3);
+	  tm->tm_yday = val - 1;
+	  have_yday = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'm':
+	  /* Match number of month.  */
+	  get_number (1, 12, 2);
+	  tm->tm_mon = val - 1;
+	  have_mon = 1;
+	  want_xday = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'M':
+	  /* Match minute.  */
+	  get_number (0, 59, 2);
+	  tm->tm_min = val;
+	  break;
+	case 'n':
+	case 't':
+	  /* Match any white space.  */
+	  while (ISSPACE (*rp))
+	    ++rp;
+	  break;
+	case 'p':
+	  /* Match locale's equivalent of AM/PM.  */
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+	  if (*decided != raw)
+	    {
+	      if (match_string (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, AM_STR), rp))
+		{
+		  if (strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, AM_STR), HERE_AM_STR))
+		    *decided = loc;
+		  break;
+		}
+	      if (match_string (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, PM_STR), rp))
+		{
+		  if (strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, PM_STR), HERE_PM_STR))
+		    *decided = loc;
+		  is_pm = 1;
+		  break;
+		}
+	      *decided = raw;
+	    }
+#endif
+	  if (!match_string (HERE_AM_STR, rp))
+	    if (match_string (HERE_PM_STR, rp))
+	      is_pm = 1;
+	    else
+	      return NULL;
+	  break;
+	case 'r':
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+	  if (*decided != raw)
+	    {
+	      if (!recursive (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, T_FMT_AMPM)))
+		{
+		  if (*decided == loc)
+		    return NULL;
+		  else
+		    rp = rp_backup;
+		}
+	      else
+		{
+		  if (*decided == not &&
+		      strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, T_FMT_AMPM),
+			      HERE_T_FMT_AMPM))
+		    *decided = loc;
+		  break;
+		}
+	      *decided = raw;
+	    }
+#endif
+	  if (!recursive (HERE_T_FMT_AMPM))
+	    return NULL;
+	  break;
+	case 'R':
+	  if (!recursive ("%H:%M"))
+	    return NULL;
+	  break;
+	case 's':
+	  {
+	    /* The number of seconds may be very high so we cannot use
+	       the `get_number' macro.  Instead read the number
+	       character for character and construct the result while
+	       doing this.  */
+	    time_t secs = 0;
+	    if (*rp < '0' || *rp > '9')
+	      /* We need at least one digit.  */
+	      return NULL;
+
+	    do
+	      {
+		secs *= 10;
+		secs += *rp++ - '0';
+	      }
+	    while (*rp >= '0' && *rp <= '9');
+
+	    if (localtime_r (&secs, tm) == NULL)
+	      /* Error in function.  */
+	      return NULL;
+	  }
+	  break;
+	case 'S':
+	  get_number (0, 61, 2);
+	  tm->tm_sec = val;
+	  break;
+	case 'X':
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+	  if (*decided != raw)
+	    {
+	      if (!recursive (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, T_FMT)))
+		{
+		  if (*decided == loc)
+		    return NULL;
+		  else
+		    rp = rp_backup;
+		}
+	      else
+		{
+		  if (strcmp (_NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, T_FMT), HERE_T_FMT))
+		    *decided = loc;
+		  break;
+		}
+	      *decided = raw;
+	    }
+#endif
+	  /* Fall through.  */
+	case 'T':
+	  if (!recursive (HERE_T_FMT))
+	    return NULL;
+	  break;
+	case 'u':
+	  get_number (1, 7, 1);
+	  tm->tm_wday = val % 7;
+	  have_wday = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'g':
+	  get_number (0, 99, 2);
+	  /* XXX This cannot determine any field in TM.  */
+	  break;
+	case 'G':
+	  if (*rp < '0' || *rp > '9')
+	    return NULL;
+	  /* XXX Ignore the number since we would need some more
+	     information to compute a real date.  */
+	  do
+	    ++rp;
+	  while (*rp >= '0' && *rp <= '9');
+	  break;
+	case 'U':
+	  get_number (0, 53, 2);
+	  week_no = val;
+	  have_uweek = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'W':
+	  get_number (0, 53, 2);
+	  week_no = val;
+	  have_wweek = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'V':
+	  get_number (0, 53, 2);
+	  /* XXX This cannot determine any field in TM without some
+	     information.  */
+	  break;
+	case 'w':
+	  /* Match number of weekday.  */
+	  get_number (0, 6, 1);
+	  tm->tm_wday = val;
+	  have_wday = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'y':
+	match_year_in_century:
+	  /* Match year within century.  */
+	  get_number (0, 99, 2);
+	  /* The "Year 2000: The Millennium Rollover" paper suggests that
+	     values in the range 69-99 refer to the twentieth century.  */
+	  tm->tm_year = val >= 69 ? val : val + 100;
+	  /* Indicate that we want to use the century, if specified.  */
+	  want_century = 1;
+	  want_xday = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'Y':
+	  /* Match year including century number.  */
+	  get_number (0, 9999, 4);
+	  tm->tm_year = val - 1900;
+	  want_century = 0;
+	  want_xday = 1;
+	  break;
+	case 'Z':
+	  /* XXX How to handle this?  */
+	  break;
+	case 'E':
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+	  switch (*fmt++)
+	    {
+	    case 'c':
+	      /* Match locale's alternate date and time format.  */
+	      if (*decided != raw)
+		{
+		  const char *fmt = _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, ERA_D_T_FMT);
+
+		  if (*fmt == '\0')
+		    fmt = _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, D_T_FMT);
+
+		  if (!recursive (fmt))
+		    {
+		      if (*decided == loc)
+			return NULL;
+		      else
+			rp = rp_backup;
+		    }
+		  else
+		    {
+		      if (strcmp (fmt, HERE_D_T_FMT))
+			*decided = loc;
+		      want_xday = 1;
+		      break;
+		    }
+		  *decided = raw;
+		}
+	      /* The C locale has no era information, so use the
+		 normal representation.  */
+	      if (!recursive (HERE_D_T_FMT))
+		return NULL;
+	      want_xday = 1;
+	      break;
+	    case 'C':
+	      if (*decided != raw)
+		{
+		  if (era_cnt >= 0)
+		    {
+		      era = _nl_select_era_entry (era_cnt HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
+		      if (era != NULL && match_string (era->era_name, rp))
+			{
+			  *decided = loc;
+			  break;
+			}
+		      else
+			return NULL;
+		    }
+		  else
+		    {
+		      num_eras = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_TIME,
+						   _NL_TIME_ERA_NUM_ENTRIES);
+		      for (era_cnt = 0; era_cnt < (int) num_eras;
+			   ++era_cnt, rp = rp_backup)
+			{
+			  era = _nl_select_era_entry (era_cnt
+						      HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
+			  if (era != NULL && match_string (era->era_name, rp))
+			    {
+			      *decided = loc;
+			      break;
+			    }
+			}
+		      if (era_cnt == (int) num_eras)
+			{
+			  era_cnt = -1;
+			  if (*decided == loc)
+			    return NULL;
+			}
+		      else
+			break;
+		    }
+
+		  *decided = raw;
+		}
+	      /* The C locale has no era information, so use the
+		 normal representation.  */
+	      goto match_century;
+ 	    case 'y':
+	      if (*decided == raw)
+		goto match_year_in_century;
+
+	      get_number(0, 9999, 4);
+	      tm->tm_year = val;
+	      want_era = 1;
+	      want_xday = 1;
+	      want_century = 1;
+	      break;
+	    case 'Y':
+	      if (*decided != raw)
+		{
+		  num_eras = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_TIME,
+					       _NL_TIME_ERA_NUM_ENTRIES);
+		  for (era_cnt = 0; era_cnt < (int) num_eras;
+		       ++era_cnt, rp = rp_backup)
+		    {
+		      era = _nl_select_era_entry (era_cnt HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
+		      if (era != NULL && recursive (era->era_format))
+			break;
+		    }
+		  if (era_cnt == (int) num_eras)
+		    {
+		      era_cnt = -1;
+		      if (*decided == loc)
+			return NULL;
+		      else
+			rp = rp_backup;
+		    }
+		  else
+		    {
+		      *decided = loc;
+		      era_cnt = -1;
+		      break;
+		    }
+
+		  *decided = raw;
+		}
+	      get_number (0, 9999, 4);
+	      tm->tm_year = val - 1900;
+	      want_century = 0;
+	      want_xday = 1;
+	      break;
+	    case 'x':
+	      if (*decided != raw)
+		{
+		  const char *fmt = _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, ERA_D_FMT);
+
+		  if (*fmt == '\0')
+		    fmt = _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, D_FMT);
+
+		  if (!recursive (fmt))
+		    {
+		      if (*decided == loc)
+			return NULL;
+		      else
+			rp = rp_backup;
+		    }
+		  else
+		    {
+		      if (strcmp (fmt, HERE_D_FMT))
+			*decided = loc;
+		      break;
+		    }
+		  *decided = raw;
+		}
+	      if (!recursive (HERE_D_FMT))
+		return NULL;
+	      break;
+	    case 'X':
+	      if (*decided != raw)
+		{
+		  const char *fmt = _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, ERA_T_FMT);
+
+		  if (*fmt == '\0')
+		    fmt = _NL_CURRENT (LC_TIME, T_FMT);
+
+		  if (!recursive (fmt))
+		    {
+		      if (*decided == loc)
+			return NULL;
+		      else
+			rp = rp_backup;
+		    }
+		  else
+		    {
+		      if (strcmp (fmt, HERE_T_FMT))
+			*decided = loc;
+		      break;
+		    }
+		  *decided = raw;
+		}
+	      if (!recursive (HERE_T_FMT))
+		return NULL;
+	      break;
+	    default:
+	      return NULL;
+	    }
+	  break;
+#else
+	  /* We have no information about the era format.  Just use
+	     the normal format.  */
+	  if (*fmt != 'c' && *fmt != 'C' && *fmt != 'y' && *fmt != 'Y'
+	      && *fmt != 'x' && *fmt != 'X')
+	    /* This is an illegal format.  */
+	    return NULL;
+
+	  goto start_over;
+#endif
+	case 'O':
+	  switch (*fmt++)
+	    {
+	    case 'd':
+	    case 'e':
+	      /* Match day of month using alternate numeric symbols.  */
+	      get_alt_number (1, 31, 2);
+	      tm->tm_mday = val;
+	      have_mday = 1;
+	      want_xday = 1;
+	      break;
+	    case 'H':
+	      /* Match hour in 24-hour clock using alternate numeric
+		 symbols.  */
+	      get_alt_number (0, 23, 2);
+	      tm->tm_hour = val;
+	      have_I = 0;
+	      break;
+	    case 'I':
+	      /* Match hour in 12-hour clock using alternate numeric
+		 symbols.  */
+	      get_alt_number (1, 12, 2);
+	      tm->tm_hour = val % 12;
+	      have_I = 1;
+	      break;
+	    case 'm':
+	      /* Match month using alternate numeric symbols.  */
+	      get_alt_number (1, 12, 2);
+	      tm->tm_mon = val - 1;
+	      have_mon = 1;
+	      want_xday = 1;
+	      break;
+	    case 'M':
+	      /* Match minutes using alternate numeric symbols.  */
+	      get_alt_number (0, 59, 2);
+	      tm->tm_min = val;
+	      break;
+	    case 'S':
+	      /* Match seconds using alternate numeric symbols.  */
+	      get_alt_number (0, 61, 2);
+	      tm->tm_sec = val;
+	      break;
+	    case 'U':
+	      get_alt_number (0, 53, 2);
+	      week_no = val;
+	      have_uweek = 1;
+	      break;
+	    case 'W':
+	      get_alt_number (0, 53, 2);
+	      week_no = val;
+	      have_wweek = 1;
+	      break;
+	    case 'V':
+	      get_alt_number (0, 53, 2);
+	      /* XXX This cannot determine any field in TM without
+		 further information.  */
+	      break;
+	    case 'w':
+	      /* Match number of weekday using alternate numeric symbols.  */
+	      get_alt_number (0, 6, 1);
+	      tm->tm_wday = val;
+	      have_wday = 1;
+	      break;
+	    case 'y':
+	      /* Match year within century using alternate numeric symbols.  */
+	      get_alt_number (0, 99, 2);
+	      tm->tm_year = val >= 69 ? val : val + 100;
+	      want_xday = 1;
+	      break;
+	    default:
+	      return NULL;
+	    }
+	  break;
+	default:
+	  return NULL;
+	}
+    }
+
+  if (have_I && is_pm)
+    tm->tm_hour += 12;
+
+  if (century != -1)
+    {
+      if (want_century)
+	tm->tm_year = tm->tm_year % 100 + (century - 19) * 100;
+      else
+	/* Only the century, but not the year.  Strange, but so be it.  */
+	tm->tm_year = (century - 19) * 100;
+    }
+
+  if (era_cnt != -1)
+    {
+      era = _nl_select_era_entry (era_cnt HELPER_LOCALE_ARG);
+      if (era == NULL)
+	return NULL;
+      if (want_era)
+	tm->tm_year = (era->start_date[0]
+		       + ((tm->tm_year - era->offset)
+			  * era->absolute_direction));
+      else
+	/* Era start year assumed.  */
+	tm->tm_year = era->start_date[0];
+    }
+  else
+    if (want_era)
+      {
+	/* No era found but we have seen an E modifier.  Rectify some
+	   values.  */
+	if (want_century && century == -1 && tm->tm_year < 69)
+	  tm->tm_year += 100;
+      }
+
+  if (want_xday && !have_wday)
+    {
+      if ( !(have_mon && have_mday) && have_yday)
+	{
+	  /* We don't have tm_mon and/or tm_mday, compute them.  */
+	  int t_mon = 0;
+	  while (__mon_yday[__isleap(1900 + tm->tm_year)][t_mon] <= tm->tm_yday)
+	      t_mon++;
+	  if (!have_mon)
+	      tm->tm_mon = t_mon - 1;
+	  if (!have_mday)
+	      tm->tm_mday =
+		(tm->tm_yday
+		 - __mon_yday[__isleap(1900 + tm->tm_year)][t_mon - 1] + 1);
+	}
+      day_of_the_week (tm);
+    }
+
+  if (want_xday && !have_yday)
+    day_of_the_year (tm);
+
+  if ((have_uweek || have_wweek) && have_wday)
+    {
+      int save_wday = tm->tm_wday;
+      int save_mday = tm->tm_mday;
+      int save_mon = tm->tm_mon;
+      int w_offset = have_uweek ? 0 : 1;
+
+      tm->tm_mday = 1;
+      tm->tm_mon = 0;
+      day_of_the_week (tm);
+      if (have_mday)
+	tm->tm_mday = save_mday;
+      if (have_mon)
+	tm->tm_mon = save_mon;
+
+      if (!have_yday)
+	tm->tm_yday = ((7 - (tm->tm_wday - w_offset)) % 7
+		       + (week_no - 1) *7
+		       + save_wday - w_offset);
+
+      if (!have_mday || !have_mon)
+	{
+	  int t_mon = 0;
+	  while (__mon_yday[__isleap(1900 + tm->tm_year)][t_mon]
+		 <= tm->tm_yday)
+	    t_mon++;
+	  if (!have_mon)
+	    tm->tm_mon = t_mon - 1;
+	  if (!have_mday)
+	      tm->tm_mday =
+		(tm->tm_yday
+		 - __mon_yday[__isleap(1900 + tm->tm_year)][t_mon - 1] + 1);
+	}
+
+      tm->tm_wday = save_wday;
+    }
+
+  return (char *) rp;
+}
+
+
+char *
+strptime (buf, format, tm LOCALE_PARAM)
+     const char *buf;
+     const char *format;
+     struct tm *tm;
+     LOCALE_PARAM_DECL
+{
+  enum ptime_locale_status decided;
+
+#ifdef _NL_CURRENT
+  decided = not;
+#else
+  decided = raw;
+#endif
+  return __strptime_internal (buf, format, tm, &decided, -1 LOCALE_ARG);
+}
+
+#ifdef _LIBC
 weak_alias (__strptime_l, strptime_l)
+#endif
diff --git a/time/wcsftime.c b/time/wcsftime.c
index 17bb53ede6..dcda6be18e 100644
--- a/time/wcsftime.c
+++ b/time/wcsftime.c
@@ -1,4 +1,30 @@
-#include <wctype.h>
+/* Copyright (C) 1991-1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004
+   Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   This file is part of the GNU C Library.
+
+   The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+   modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public
+   License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
+   version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
+
+   The GNU C Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
+   Lesser General Public License for more details.
+
+   You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public
+   License along with the GNU C Library; if not, write to the Free
+   Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
+   02111-1307 USA.  */
+
 #include <wchar.h>
-#define COMPILE_WIDE	1
-#include "strftime.c"
+#include <locale/localeinfo.h>
+
+
+size_t
+wcsftime (wchar_t *s, size_t maxsize, const wchar_t *format,
+	  const struct tm *tp)
+{
+  return __wcsftime_l (s, maxsize, format, tp, _NL_CURRENT_LOCALE);
+}
+libc_hidden_def (wcsftime)
diff --git a/time/wcsftime_l.c b/time/wcsftime_l.c
index 969289710c..e9443ef64e 100644
--- a/time/wcsftime_l.c
+++ b/time/wcsftime_l.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
 
    The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
@@ -16,7 +16,11 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
+#include <wchar.h>
+#include <wctype.h>
+
 #define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL 1
-#include <wcsftime.c>
+#define COMPILE_WIDE	1
+#include "strftime_l.c"
 
 weak_alias (__wcsftime_l, wcsftime_l)
diff --git a/wcsmbs/wcscoll.c b/wcsmbs/wcscoll.c
index 40bd584e8b..ed6db06e4e 100644
--- a/wcsmbs/wcscoll.c
+++ b/wcsmbs/wcscoll.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 1996,1997,1999,2000,2001,2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1996.
 
@@ -22,17 +22,8 @@
 
 #define STRING_TYPE wchar_t
 #define USTRING_TYPE wint_t
-#ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-# define STRCOLL __wcscoll_l
-#else
-# define STRCOLL __wcscoll
-#endif
-#define STRCMP wcscmp
-#define STRLEN __wcslen
-#define WEIGHT_H "../locale/weightwc.h"
-#define SUFFIX	WC
-#define L(arg) L##arg
-#define WIDE_CHAR_VERSION 1
+#define STRCOLL __wcscoll
+#define STRCOLL_L __wcscoll_l
 
 #include "../string/strcoll.c"
 
diff --git a/wcsmbs/wcscoll_l.c b/wcsmbs/wcscoll_l.c
index 20007b29c9..04b0bf3649 100644
--- a/wcsmbs/wcscoll_l.c
+++ b/wcsmbs/wcscoll_l.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1996.
 
@@ -17,7 +17,20 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
-#include <wcscoll.c>
+
+#include <wchar.h>
+#include "../locale/coll-lookup.h"
+
+#define STRING_TYPE wchar_t
+#define USTRING_TYPE wint_t
+#define STRCOLL __wcscoll_l
+#define STRCMP wcscmp
+#define STRLEN __wcslen
+#define WEIGHT_H "../locale/weightwc.h"
+#define SUFFIX	WC
+#define L(arg) L##arg
+#define WIDE_CHAR_VERSION 1
+
+#include "../string/strcoll_l.c"
 
 weak_alias (__wcscoll_l, wcscoll_l)
diff --git a/wcsmbs/wcstod.c b/wcsmbs/wcstod.c
index 5a39091c25..74fd557db6 100644
--- a/wcsmbs/wcstod.c
+++ b/wcsmbs/wcstod.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1996.
 
@@ -17,9 +17,13 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <xlocale.h>
 
-/* The actual implementation for all floating point sizes is in strtod.c.  */
 
 #define	USE_WIDE_CHAR	1
 
+extern double ____wcstod_l_internal (const wchar_t *, wchar_t **, int,
+				     __locale_t);
+
 #include <stdlib/strtod.c>
diff --git a/wcsmbs/wcstod_l.c b/wcsmbs/wcstod_l.c
index 87f3a8f7bc..86ec18e6d5 100644
--- a/wcsmbs/wcstod_l.c
+++ b/wcsmbs/wcstod_l.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert string representing a number to integer value, using given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1997, 1998, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1997, 1998, 2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1997.
 
@@ -18,11 +18,9 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define __need_wchar_t
 #include <stddef.h>
-#include <locale.h>
+#include <xlocale.h>
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
 
 extern double ____wcstod_l_internal (const wchar_t *, wchar_t **, int,
 				     __locale_t);
@@ -30,6 +28,6 @@ extern unsigned long long int ____wcstoull_l_internal (const wchar_t *,
 						       wchar_t **, int, int,
 						       __locale_t);
 
-#include <wcstod.c>
+#define	USE_WIDE_CHAR	1
 
-weak_alias (__wcstod_l, wcstod_l)
+#include <stdlib/strtod_l.c>
diff --git a/wcsmbs/wcstof.c b/wcsmbs/wcstof.c
index 02f91ef904..2d2fca3fde 100644
--- a/wcsmbs/wcstof.c
+++ b/wcsmbs/wcstof.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1996.
 
@@ -17,27 +17,12 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <xlocale.h>
 
-/* The actual implementation for all floating point sizes is in strtod.c.
-   These macros tell it to produce the `float' version, `wcstof'.  */
-
-#define	FLOAT		float
-#define	FLT		FLT
-#ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-# define STRTOF		__wcstof_l
-#else
-# define STRTOF		wcstof
-#endif
-#define	MPN2FLOAT	__mpn_construct_float
-#define	FLOAT_HUGE_VAL	HUGE_VALF
 #define	USE_WIDE_CHAR	1
-#define SET_MANTISSA(flt, mant) \
-  do { union ieee754_float u;						      \
-       u.f = (flt);							      \
-       if ((mant & 0x7fffff) == 0)					      \
-	 mant = 0x400000;						      \
-       u.ieee.mantissa = (mant) & 0x7fffff;				      \
-       (flt) = u.f;							      \
-  } while (0)
 
-#include <stdlib/strtod.c>
+extern float ____wcstof_l_internal (const wchar_t *, wchar_t **, int,
+				    __locale_t);
+
+#include <stdlib/strtof.c>
diff --git a/wcsmbs/wcstof_l.c b/wcsmbs/wcstof_l.c
index 542961e1fe..0ed31e0c7b 100644
--- a/wcsmbs/wcstof_l.c
+++ b/wcsmbs/wcstof_l.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert string representing a number to integer value, using given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1997,98,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1997,98,2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1997.
 
@@ -18,11 +18,11 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define __need_wchar_t
 #include <stddef.h>
-#include <locale.h>
+#include <xlocale.h>
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
+
+#define	USE_WIDE_CHAR	1
 
 extern float ____wcstof_l_internal (const wchar_t *, wchar_t **, int,
 				    __locale_t);
@@ -30,6 +30,4 @@ extern unsigned long long int ____wcstoull_l_internal (const wchar_t *,
 						       wchar_t **, int, int,
 						       __locale_t);
 
-#include <wcstof.c>
-
-weak_alias (__wcstof_l, wcstof_l)
+#include <stdlib/strtof_l.c>
diff --git a/wcsmbs/wcstold.c b/wcsmbs/wcstold.c
index 5c58aa69e6..d99b7278b9 100644
--- a/wcsmbs/wcstold.c
+++ b/wcsmbs/wcstold.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 1998 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 1998, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1996.
 
@@ -17,46 +17,12 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#include <math.h>
-#include <wchar.h>
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <xlocale.h>
 
-#ifndef __NO_LONG_DOUBLE_MATH
-/* The actual implementation for all floating point sizes is in strtod.c.
-   These macros tell it to produce the `long double' version, `wcstold'.  */
+#define USE_WIDE_CHAR	1
 
-# define FLOAT		long double
-# define FLT		LDBL
-# ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-#  define STRTOF	__wcstold_l
-# else
-#  define STRTOF	wcstold
-# endif
-# define MPN2FLOAT	__mpn_construct_long_double
-# define FLOAT_HUGE_VAL	HUGE_VALL
-# define USE_WIDE_CHAR	1
-# define SET_MANTISSA(flt, mant) \
-  do { union ieee854_long_double u;					      \
-       u.d = (flt);							      \
-       if ((mant & 0x7fffffffffffffffULL) == 0)				      \
-	 mant = 0x4000000000000000ULL;					      \
-       u.ieee.mantissa0 = (((mant) >> 32) & 0x7fffffff) | 0x80000000;	      \
-       u.ieee.mantissa1 = (mant) & 0xffffffff;				      \
-       (flt) = u.d;							      \
-  } while (0)
+extern long double ____wcstold_l_internal (const wchar_t *, wchar_t **, int,
+					   __locale_t);
 
-# include <stdlib/strtod.c>
-#else
-/* There is no `long double' type, use the `double' implementations.  */
-long double
-__wcstold_internal (const wchar_t *nptr, wchar_t **endptr, int group)
-{
-  return __wcstod_internal (nptr, endptr, group);
-}
-libc_hidden_def (__wcstold_internal)
-
-long double
-wcstold (const wchar_t *nptr, wchar_t **endptr)
-{
-  return __wcstod_internal (nptr, endptr, 0);
-}
-#endif
+#include <stdlib/strtold.c>
diff --git a/wcsmbs/wcstold_l.c b/wcsmbs/wcstold_l.c
index 91a92124cf..9526645f10 100644
--- a/wcsmbs/wcstold_l.c
+++ b/wcsmbs/wcstold_l.c
@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
 /* Convert string representing a number to integer value, using given locale.
-   Copyright (C) 1997,98,99,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+   Copyright (C) 1997,98,99,2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1997.
 
@@ -18,15 +18,10 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define __need_wchar_t
-#include <math.h>
 #include <stddef.h>
-#include <locale.h>
-#include <wchar.h>
+#include <xlocale.h>
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
-
-#ifndef __NO_LONG_DOUBLE_MATH
+#define USE_WIDE_CHAR	1
 
 extern long double ____wcstold_l_internal (const wchar_t *, wchar_t **, int,
 					   __locale_t);
@@ -34,23 +29,4 @@ extern unsigned long long int ____wcstoull_l_internal (const wchar_t *,
 						       wchar_t **, int, int,
 						       __locale_t);
 
-# include <wcstold.c>
-#else
-/* There is no `long double' type, use the `double' implementations.  */
-extern double ____wcstod_l_internal (const wchar_t *, wchar_t **, int,
-				     __locale_t);
-long double
-____wcstold_l_internal (const wchar_t *nptr, wchar_t **endptr, int group,
-			__locale_t loc)
-{
-  return ____wcstod_l_internal (nptr, endptr, group, loc);
-}
-
-long double
-__wcstold_l (const wchar_t *nptr, wchar_t **endptr, __locale_t loc)
-{
-  return ____wcstod_l_internal (nptr, endptr, 0, loc);
-}
-#endif
-
-weak_alias (__wcstold_l, wcstold_l)
+#include <strtold_l.c>
diff --git a/wcsmbs/wcsxfrm.c b/wcsmbs/wcsxfrm.c
index 10f3d72673..9e7d10389b 100644
--- a/wcsmbs/wcsxfrm.c
+++ b/wcsmbs/wcsxfrm.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 1996-2000, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1996.
 
@@ -21,18 +21,7 @@
 #include "../locale/coll-lookup.h"
 
 #define STRING_TYPE wchar_t
-#define USTRING_TYPE wint_t
-#ifdef USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL
-# define STRXFRM __wcsxfrm_l
-#else
-# define STRXFRM wcsxfrm
-#endif
-#define STRCMP wcscmp
-#define STRLEN __wcslen
-#define STPNCPY __wcpncpy
-#define WEIGHT_H "../locale/weightwc.h"
-#define SUFFIX	WC
-#define L(arg) L##arg
-#define WIDE_CHAR_VERSION 1
+#define STRXFRM wcsxfrm
+#define STRXFRM_L __wcsxfrm_l
 
 #include "../string/strxfrm.c"
diff --git a/wcsmbs/wcsxfrm_l.c b/wcsmbs/wcsxfrm_l.c
index 13046237a9..de9fc93153 100644
--- a/wcsmbs/wcsxfrm_l.c
+++ b/wcsmbs/wcsxfrm_l.c
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
-/* Copyright (C) 1996,97,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+/* Copyright (C) 1996,97,2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
    This file is part of the GNU C Library.
    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1996.
 
@@ -17,7 +17,20 @@
    Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
    02111-1307 USA.  */
 
-#define USE_IN_EXTENDED_LOCALE_MODEL	1
-#include <wcsxfrm.c>
+#include <wchar.h>
+#include "../locale/coll-lookup.h"
+
+#define STRING_TYPE wchar_t
+#define USTRING_TYPE wint_t
+#define STRXFRM __wcsxfrm_l
+#define STRCMP wcscmp
+#define STRLEN __wcslen
+#define STPNCPY __wcpncpy
+#define WEIGHT_H "../locale/weightwc.h"
+#define SUFFIX  WC
+#define L(arg) L##arg
+#define WIDE_CHAR_VERSION 1
+
+#include "../string/strxfrm_l.c"
 
 weak_alias (__wcsxfrm_l, wcsxfrm_l)